Public Act 095-0707
 
SB0783 Re-Enrolled LRB095 05523 BDD 25613 b

    AN ACT concerning State government.
 
    Be it enacted by the People of the State of Illinois,
represented in the General Assembly:
 
ARTICLE 1. SHORT TITLE; PURPOSE

 
    Section 1-1. Short title. This Act may be cited as the
FY2008 Budget Implementation Act.
 
    Section 1-5. Purpose. It is the purpose of this Act to make
changes in State programs that are necessary to implement the
FY2008 budget.
 
ARTICLE 3. STATE SERVICES ASSURANCE ACT FOR 2008

 
    Section 3-1. Short title. This Article may be cited as the
State Services Assurance Act for FY2008, and references in this
Article to "this Act" mean this Article.
 
    Section 3-5. Definitions. For the purposes of this Act:
    "Frontline staff" means State employees in the RC 6, RC 9,
RC 10, RC 14, RC 28, RC 42, RC 62, RC 63, and CU 500 bargaining
units in titles represented by AFSCME as of June 1, 2007.
    "On-board frontline staff" means frontline staff in paid
status.
 
    Section 3-10. Legislative intent and policy. The General
Assembly finds that State government delivers a myriad of
services that are necessary for the health, welfare, safety,
and quality of life of all Illinois residents. Because State
services are used by many Illinois citizens who cannot speak
the English language fluently, there is a need for bilingual
State employees. The number of workers in State government who
speak a language other than English is inadequate, leaving
those workers who do speak another language overworked and
incapable of meeting the rising demand for their services.
    In response to this crisis, it is the intent of the General
Assembly in FY 2008 to ensure the hiring and retention of
additional bilingual frontline staff in State agencies where
public services are most used. These additions take into
account our State's current revenue crisis, and are a first
step. Raising bilingual staffing to meet higher national
standards to fully ensure the effective delivery of essential
services is the long-term goal of the General Assembly.
 
    Section 3-15. Staffing standards. On or before July 1, 2008
each named agency shall increase and maintain the number of
bilingual on-board frontline staff over the levels that it
maintained on June 30, 2007 as follows:
        (1) The Department of Corrections shall have at least
    40 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (2) Mental health and developmental centers operated
    by the Department of Human Services shall have at least 20
    additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (3) Family and Community Resource Centers operated by
    the Department of Human Services shall have at least 100
    additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (4) The Department of Children and Family Services
    shall have at least 40 additional bilingual on-board
    frontline staff.
        (5) The Department of Veterans Affairs shall have at
    least 5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (6) The Environmental Protection Agency shall have at
    least 5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (7) The Department of Employment Security shall have at
    least 10 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (8) The Department of Natural Resources shall have at
    least 5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (9) The Department of Public Health shall have at least
    5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (10) The Department of State Police shall have at least
    5 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
        (11) The Department of Juvenile Justice shall have at
    least 25 additional bilingual on-board frontline staff.
 
    Section 3-20. Accountability. On or before April 1, 2008
and each year thereafter, each executive branch agency, board,
and commission shall prepare and submit a report to the General
Assembly on the staffing level of bilingual employees. The
report shall provide data from the previous month, including
but not limited to each employees name, job title, job
description, and languages spoken.
 
ARTICLE 5. AMENDATORY PROVISIONS

 
    Section 5-1. The State Employees Group Insurance Act of
1971 is amended by changing Section 10 as follows:
 
    (5 ILCS 375/10)  (from Ch. 127, par. 530)
    Sec. 10. Payments by State; premiums.
    (a) The State shall pay the cost of basic non-contributory
group life insurance and, subject to member paid contributions
set by the Department or required by this Section, the basic
program of group health benefits on each eligible member,
except a member, not otherwise covered by this Act, who has
retired as a participating member under Article 2 of the
Illinois Pension Code but is ineligible for the retirement
annuity under Section 2-119 of the Illinois Pension Code, and
part of each eligible member's and retired member's premiums
for health insurance coverage for enrolled dependents as
provided by Section 9. The State shall pay the cost of the
basic program of group health benefits only after benefits are
reduced by the amount of benefits covered by Medicare for all
members and dependents who are eligible for benefits under
Social Security or the Railroad Retirement system or who had
sufficient Medicare-covered government employment, except that
such reduction in benefits shall apply only to those members
and dependents who (1) first become eligible for such Medicare
coverage on or after July 1, 1992; or (2) are Medicare-eligible
members or dependents of a local government unit which began
participation in the program on or after July 1, 1992; or (3)
remain eligible for, but no longer receive Medicare coverage
which they had been receiving on or after July 1, 1992. The
Department may determine the aggregate level of the State's
contribution on the basis of actual cost of medical services
adjusted for age, sex or geographic or other demographic
characteristics which affect the costs of such programs.
    The cost of participation in the basic program of group
health benefits for the dependent or survivor of a living or
deceased retired employee who was formerly employed by the
University of Illinois in the Cooperative Extension Service and
would be an annuitant but for the fact that he or she was made
ineligible to participate in the State Universities Retirement
System by clause (4) of subsection (a) of Section 15-107 of the
Illinois Pension Code shall not be greater than the cost of
participation that would otherwise apply to that dependent or
survivor if he or she were the dependent or survivor of an
annuitant under the State Universities Retirement System.
    (a-1) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who
becomes a new SERS annuitant and participates in the basic
program of group health benefits, the State shall contribute
toward the cost of the annuitant's coverage under the basic
program of group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that
cost for each full year of creditable service upon which the
annuitant's retirement annuity is based, up to a maximum of
100% for an annuitant with 20 or more years of creditable
service. The remainder of the cost of a new SERS annuitant's
coverage under the basic program of group health benefits shall
be the responsibility of the annuitant. In the case of a new
SERS annuitant who has elected to receive an alternative
retirement cancellation payment under Section 14-108.5 of the
Illinois Pension Code in lieu of an annuity, for the purposes
of this subsection the annuitant shall be deemed to be
receiving a retirement annuity based on the number of years of
creditable service that the annuitant had established at the
time of his or her termination of service under SERS.
    (a-2) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who
becomes a new SERS survivor and participates in the basic
program of group health benefits, the State shall contribute
toward the cost of the survivor's coverage under the basic
program of group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that
cost for each full year of the deceased employee's or deceased
annuitant's creditable service in the State Employees'
Retirement System of Illinois on the date of death, up to a
maximum of 100% for a survivor of an employee or annuitant with
20 or more years of creditable service. The remainder of the
cost of the new SERS survivor's coverage under the basic
program of group health benefits shall be the responsibility of
the survivor. In the case of a new SERS survivor who was the
dependent of an annuitant who elected to receive an alternative
retirement cancellation payment under Section 14-108.5 of the
Illinois Pension Code in lieu of an annuity, for the purposes
of this subsection the deceased annuitant's creditable service
shall be determined as of the date of termination of service
rather than the date of death.
    (a-3) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who
becomes a new SURS annuitant and participates in the basic
program of group health benefits, the State shall contribute
toward the cost of the annuitant's coverage under the basic
program of group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that
cost for each full year of creditable service upon which the
annuitant's retirement annuity is based, up to a maximum of
100% for an annuitant with 20 or more years of creditable
service. The remainder of the cost of a new SURS annuitant's
coverage under the basic program of group health benefits shall
be the responsibility of the annuitant.
    (a-4) (Blank).
    (a-5) Beginning January 1, 1998, for each person who
becomes a new SURS survivor and participates in the basic
program of group health benefits, the State shall contribute
toward the cost of the survivor's coverage under the basic
program of group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that
cost for each full year of the deceased employee's or deceased
annuitant's creditable service in the State Universities
Retirement System on the date of death, up to a maximum of 100%
for a survivor of an employee or annuitant with 20 or more
years of creditable service. The remainder of the cost of the
new SURS survivor's coverage under the basic program of group
health benefits shall be the responsibility of the survivor.
    (a-6) Beginning July 1, 1998, for each person who becomes a
new TRS State annuitant and participates in the basic program
of group health benefits, the State shall contribute toward the
cost of the annuitant's coverage under the basic program of
group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that cost for
each full year of creditable service as a teacher as defined in
paragraph (2), (3), or (5) of Section 16-106 of the Illinois
Pension Code upon which the annuitant's retirement annuity is
based, up to a maximum of 100%; except that the State
contribution shall be 12.5% per year (rather than 5%) for each
full year of creditable service as a regional superintendent or
assistant regional superintendent of schools. The remainder of
the cost of a new TRS State annuitant's coverage under the
basic program of group health benefits shall be the
responsibility of the annuitant.
    (a-7) Beginning July 1, 1998, for each person who becomes a
new TRS State survivor and participates in the basic program of
group health benefits, the State shall contribute toward the
cost of the survivor's coverage under the basic program of
group health benefits an amount equal to 5% of that cost for
each full year of the deceased employee's or deceased
annuitant's creditable service as a teacher as defined in
paragraph (2), (3), or (5) of Section 16-106 of the Illinois
Pension Code on the date of death, up to a maximum of 100%;
except that the State contribution shall be 12.5% per year
(rather than 5%) for each full year of the deceased employee's
or deceased annuitant's creditable service as a regional
superintendent or assistant regional superintendent of
schools. The remainder of the cost of the new TRS State
survivor's coverage under the basic program of group health
benefits shall be the responsibility of the survivor.
    (a-8) A new SERS annuitant, new SERS survivor, new SURS
annuitant, new SURS survivor, new TRS State annuitant, or new
TRS State survivor may waive or terminate coverage in the
program of group health benefits. Any such annuitant or
survivor who has waived or terminated coverage may enroll or
re-enroll in the program of group health benefits only during
the annual benefit choice period, as determined by the
Director; except that in the event of termination of coverage
due to nonpayment of premiums, the annuitant or survivor may
not re-enroll in the program.
    (a-9) No later than May 1 of each calendar year, the
Director of Central Management Services shall certify in
writing to the Executive Secretary of the State Employees'
Retirement System of Illinois the amounts of the Medicare
supplement health care premiums and the amounts of the health
care premiums for all other retirees who are not Medicare
eligible.
    A separate calculation of the premiums based upon the
actual cost of each health care plan shall be so certified.
    The Director of Central Management Services shall provide
to the Executive Secretary of the State Employees' Retirement
System of Illinois such information, statistics, and other data
as he or she may require to review the premium amounts
certified by the Director of Central Management Services.
    The Department of Healthcare and Family Services, or any
successor agency designated to procure healthcare contracts
pursuant to this Act, is authorized to establish funds,
separate accounts provided by any bank or banks as defined by
the Illinois Banking Act, or separate accounts provided by any
savings and loan association or associations as defined by the
Illinois Savings and Loan Act of 1985 to be held by the
Director, outside the State treasury, for the purpose of
receiving the transfer of moneys from the Local Government
Health Insurance Reserve Fund. The Department may promulgate
rules further defining the methodology for the transfers. Any
interest earned by moneys in the funds or accounts shall inure
to the Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund. The
transferred moneys, and interest accrued thereon, shall be used
exclusively for transfers to administrative service
organizations or their financial institutions for payments of
claims to claimants and providers under the self-insurance
health plan. The transferred moneys, and interest accrued
thereon, shall not be used for any other purpose including, but
not limited to, reimbursement of administration fees due the
administrative service organization pursuant to its contract
or contracts with the Department.
    (b) State employees who become eligible for this program on
or after January 1, 1980 in positions normally requiring actual
performance of duty not less than 1/2 of a normal work period
but not equal to that of a normal work period, shall be given
the option of participating in the available program. If the
employee elects coverage, the State shall contribute on behalf
of such employee to the cost of the employee's benefit and any
applicable dependent supplement, that sum which bears the same
percentage as that percentage of time the employee regularly
works when compared to normal work period.
    (c) The basic non-contributory coverage from the basic
program of group health benefits shall be continued for each
employee not in pay status or on active service by reason of
(1) leave of absence due to illness or injury, (2) authorized
educational leave of absence or sabbatical leave, or (3)
military leave with pay and benefits. This coverage shall
continue until expiration of authorized leave and return to
active service, but not to exceed 24 months for leaves under
item (1) or (2). This 24-month limitation and the requirement
of returning to active service shall not apply to persons
receiving ordinary or accidental disability benefits or
retirement benefits through the appropriate State retirement
system or benefits under the Workers' Compensation or
Occupational Disease Act.
    (d) The basic group life insurance coverage shall continue,
with full State contribution, where such person is (1) absent
from active service by reason of disability arising from any
cause other than self-inflicted, (2) on authorized educational
leave of absence or sabbatical leave, or (3) on military leave
with pay and benefits.
    (e) Where the person is in non-pay status for a period in
excess of 30 days or on leave of absence, other than by reason
of disability, educational or sabbatical leave, or military
leave with pay and benefits, such person may continue coverage
only by making personal payment equal to the amount normally
contributed by the State on such person's behalf. Such payments
and coverage may be continued: (1) until such time as the
person returns to a status eligible for coverage at State
expense, but not to exceed 24 months, (2) until such person's
employment or annuitant status with the State is terminated, or
(3) for a maximum period of 4 years for members on military
leave with pay and benefits and military leave without pay and
benefits (exclusive of any additional service imposed pursuant
to law).
    (f) The Department shall establish by rule the extent to
which other employee benefits will continue for persons in
non-pay status or who are not in active service.
    (g) The State shall not pay the cost of the basic
non-contributory group life insurance, program of health
benefits and other employee benefits for members who are
survivors as defined by paragraphs (1) and (2) of subsection
(q) of Section 3 of this Act. The costs of benefits for these
survivors shall be paid by the survivors or by the University
of Illinois Cooperative Extension Service, or any combination
thereof. However, the State shall pay the amount of the
reduction in the cost of participation, if any, resulting from
the amendment to subsection (a) made by this amendatory Act of
the 91st General Assembly.
    (h) Those persons occupying positions with any department
as a result of emergency appointments pursuant to Section 8b.8
of the Personnel Code who are not considered employees under
this Act shall be given the option of participating in the
programs of group life insurance, health benefits and other
employee benefits. Such persons electing coverage may
participate only by making payment equal to the amount normally
contributed by the State for similarly situated employees. Such
amounts shall be determined by the Director. Such payments and
coverage may be continued until such time as the person becomes
an employee pursuant to this Act or such person's appointment
is terminated.
    (i) Any unit of local government within the State of
Illinois may apply to the Director to have its employees,
annuitants, and their dependents provided group health
coverage under this Act on a non-insured basis. To participate,
a unit of local government must agree to enroll all of its
employees, who may select coverage under either the State group
health benefits plan or a health maintenance organization that
has contracted with the State to be available as a health care
provider for employees as defined in this Act. A unit of local
government must remit the entire cost of providing coverage
under the State group health benefits plan or, for coverage
under a health maintenance organization, an amount determined
by the Director based on an analysis of the sex, age,
geographic location, or other relevant demographic variables
for its employees, except that the unit of local government
shall not be required to enroll those of its employees who are
covered spouses or dependents under this plan or another group
policy or plan providing health benefits as long as (1) an
appropriate official from the unit of local government attests
that each employee not enrolled is a covered spouse or
dependent under this plan or another group policy or plan, and
(2) at least 85% of the employees are enrolled and the unit of
local government remits the entire cost of providing coverage
to those employees, except that a participating school district
must have enrolled at least 85% of its full-time employees who
have not waived coverage under the district's group health plan
by participating in a component of the district's cafeteria
plan. A participating school district is not required to enroll
a full-time employee who has waived coverage under the
district's health plan, provided that an appropriate official
from the participating school district attests that the
full-time employee has waived coverage by participating in a
component of the district's cafeteria plan. For the purposes of
this subsection, "participating school district" includes a
unit of local government whose primary purpose is education as
defined by the Department's rules.
    Employees of a participating unit of local government who
are not enrolled due to coverage under another group health
policy or plan may enroll in the event of a qualifying change
in status, special enrollment, special circumstance as defined
by the Director, or during the annual Benefit Choice Period. A
participating unit of local government may also elect to cover
its annuitants. Dependent coverage shall be offered on an
optional basis, with the costs paid by the unit of local
government, its employees, or some combination of the two as
determined by the unit of local government. The unit of local
government shall be responsible for timely collection and
transmission of dependent premiums.
    The Director shall annually determine monthly rates of
payment, subject to the following constraints:
        (1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be
    equal to the amount normally charged to State employees for
    elected optional coverages or for enrolled dependents
    coverages or other contributory coverages, or contributed
    by the State for basic insurance coverages on behalf of its
    employees, adjusted for differences between State
    employees and employees of the local government in age,
    sex, geographic location or other relevant demographic
    variables, plus an amount sufficient to pay for the
    additional administrative costs of providing coverage to
    employees of the unit of local government and their
    dependents.
        (2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be
    made to reflect the actual prior years' claims experience
    of the employees of the unit of local government.
    In the case of coverage of local government employees under
a health maintenance organization, the Director shall annually
determine for each participating unit of local government the
maximum monthly amount the unit may contribute toward that
coverage, based on an analysis of (i) the age, sex, geographic
location, and other relevant demographic variables of the
unit's employees and (ii) the cost to cover those employees
under the State group health benefits plan. The Director may
similarly determine the maximum monthly amount each unit of
local government may contribute toward coverage of its
employees' dependents under a health maintenance organization.
    Monthly payments by the unit of local government or its
employees for group health benefits plan or health maintenance
organization coverage shall be deposited in the Local
Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund.
    The Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund is
hereby created as a nonappropriated trust fund to be held
outside the State Treasury, with the State Treasurer as
custodian. The Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund
shall be a continuing fund not subject to fiscal year
limitations. All revenues arising from the administration of
the health benefits program established under this Section
shall be deposited into the Local Government Health Insurance
Reserve Fund. Any interest earned on moneys in the Local
Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund shall be deposited
into the Fund. All expenditures from this Fund shall be used
for payments for health care benefits for local government and
rehabilitation facility employees, annuitants, and dependents,
and to reimburse the Department or its administrative service
organization for all expenses incurred in the administration of
benefits. No other State funds may be used for these purposes.
    A local government employer's participation or desire to
participate in a program created under this subsection shall
not limit that employer's duty to bargain with the
representative of any collective bargaining unit of its
employees.
    (j) Any rehabilitation facility within the State of
Illinois may apply to the Director to have its employees,
annuitants, and their eligible dependents provided group
health coverage under this Act on a non-insured basis. To
participate, a rehabilitation facility must agree to enroll all
of its employees and remit the entire cost of providing such
coverage for its employees, except that the rehabilitation
facility shall not be required to enroll those of its employees
who are covered spouses or dependents under this plan or
another group policy or plan providing health benefits as long
as (1) an appropriate official from the rehabilitation facility
attests that each employee not enrolled is a covered spouse or
dependent under this plan or another group policy or plan, and
(2) at least 85% of the employees are enrolled and the
rehabilitation facility remits the entire cost of providing
coverage to those employees. Employees of a participating
rehabilitation facility who are not enrolled due to coverage
under another group health policy or plan may enroll in the
event of a qualifying change in status, special enrollment,
special circumstance as defined by the Director, or during the
annual Benefit Choice Period. A participating rehabilitation
facility may also elect to cover its annuitants. Dependent
coverage shall be offered on an optional basis, with the costs
paid by the rehabilitation facility, its employees, or some
combination of the 2 as determined by the rehabilitation
facility. The rehabilitation facility shall be responsible for
timely collection and transmission of dependent premiums.
    The Director shall annually determine quarterly rates of
payment, subject to the following constraints:
        (1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be
    equal to the amount normally charged to State employees for
    elected optional coverages or for enrolled dependents
    coverages or other contributory coverages on behalf of its
    employees, adjusted for differences between State
    employees and employees of the rehabilitation facility in
    age, sex, geographic location or other relevant
    demographic variables, plus an amount sufficient to pay for
    the additional administrative costs of providing coverage
    to employees of the rehabilitation facility and their
    dependents.
        (2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be
    made to reflect the actual prior years' claims experience
    of the employees of the rehabilitation facility.
    Monthly payments by the rehabilitation facility or its
employees for group health benefits shall be deposited in the
Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund.
    (k) Any domestic violence shelter or service within the
State of Illinois may apply to the Director to have its
employees, annuitants, and their dependents provided group
health coverage under this Act on a non-insured basis. To
participate, a domestic violence shelter or service must agree
to enroll all of its employees and pay the entire cost of
providing such coverage for its employees. A participating
domestic violence shelter may also elect to cover its
annuitants. Dependent coverage shall be offered on an optional
basis, with employees, or some combination of the 2 as
determined by the domestic violence shelter or service. The
domestic violence shelter or service shall be responsible for
timely collection and transmission of dependent premiums.
    The Director shall annually determine rates of payment,
subject to the following constraints:
        (1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be
    equal to the amount normally charged to State employees for
    elected optional coverages or for enrolled dependents
    coverages or other contributory coverages on behalf of its
    employees, adjusted for differences between State
    employees and employees of the domestic violence shelter or
    service in age, sex, geographic location or other relevant
    demographic variables, plus an amount sufficient to pay for
    the additional administrative costs of providing coverage
    to employees of the domestic violence shelter or service
    and their dependents.
        (2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be
    made to reflect the actual prior years' claims experience
    of the employees of the domestic violence shelter or
    service.
    Monthly payments by the domestic violence shelter or
service or its employees for group health insurance shall be
deposited in the Local Government Health Insurance Reserve
Fund.
    (l) A public community college or entity organized pursuant
to the Public Community College Act may apply to the Director
initially to have only annuitants not covered prior to July 1,
1992 by the district's health plan provided health coverage
under this Act on a non-insured basis. The community college
must execute a 2-year contract to participate in the Local
Government Health Plan. Any annuitant may enroll in the event
of a qualifying change in status, special enrollment, special
circumstance as defined by the Director, or during the annual
Benefit Choice Period.
    The Director shall annually determine monthly rates of
payment subject to the following constraints: for those
community colleges with annuitants only enrolled, first year
rates shall be equal to the average cost to cover claims for a
State member adjusted for demographics, Medicare
participation, and other factors; and in the second year, a
further adjustment of rates shall be made to reflect the actual
first year's claims experience of the covered annuitants.
    (l-5) The provisions of subsection (l) become inoperative
on July 1, 1999.
    (m) The Director shall adopt any rules deemed necessary for
implementation of this amendatory Act of 1989 (Public Act
86-978).
    (n) Any child advocacy center within the State of Illinois
may apply to the Director to have its employees, annuitants,
and their dependents provided group health coverage under this
Act on a non-insured basis. To participate, a child advocacy
center must agree to enroll all of its employees and pay the
entire cost of providing coverage for its employees. A
participating child advocacy center may also elect to cover its
annuitants. Dependent coverage shall be offered on an optional
basis, with the costs paid by the child advocacy center, its
employees, or some combination of the 2 as determined by the
child advocacy center. The child advocacy center shall be
responsible for timely collection and transmission of
dependent premiums.
    The Director shall annually determine rates of payment,
subject to the following constraints:
        (1) In the first year of coverage, the rates shall be
    equal to the amount normally charged to State employees for
    elected optional coverages or for enrolled dependents
    coverages or other contributory coverages on behalf of its
    employees, adjusted for differences between State
    employees and employees of the child advocacy center in
    age, sex, geographic location, or other relevant
    demographic variables, plus an amount sufficient to pay for
    the additional administrative costs of providing coverage
    to employees of the child advocacy center and their
    dependents.
        (2) In subsequent years, a further adjustment shall be
    made to reflect the actual prior years' claims experience
    of the employees of the child advocacy center.
    Monthly payments by the child advocacy center or its
employees for group health insurance shall be deposited into
the Local Government Health Insurance Reserve Fund.
(Source: P.A. 94-839, eff. 6-6-06; 94-860, eff. 6-16-06;
95-331, eff. 8-21-07; 95-632, eff. 9-25-07.)
 
    Section 5-5. The Mental Health and Developmental
Disabilities Administrative Act is amended by changing
Sections 18.4, 18.5, and 57.5 as follows:
 
    (20 ILCS 1705/18.4)
    Sec. 18.4. Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund;
reimbursement.
    (a) The Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund is
hereby created in the State Treasury.
    (b) Amounts Except as otherwise provided in this Section,
following repayment of interfund transfers under subsection
(b-1), amounts paid to the State during each State fiscal year
by the federal government under Title XIX or Title XXI of the
Social Security Act for services delivered by community mental
health providers, and any interest earned thereon, shall be
deposited as follows:
        (1) The first $75,000,000 shall be deposited directly
    into the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund to be
    used for the purchase of community mental health services;
        (2) The next $4,500,000 shall be deposited directly
    into the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund to be
    used by the Department of Human Services' Division of
    Mental Health for the oversight and administration of
    community mental health services and up to $1,000,000 of
    this amount may be used for support of community mental
    health service initiatives; and
        (3) The next $3,500,000 shall be deposited directly
    into the General Revenue Fund;
        (4) Any additional amounts shall be deposited 50% into
    the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund to be used
    for the purchase of community mental health services and
    50% into the General Revenue Fund.
    (b-1) For State fiscal year 2005, the first $73,000,000 in
any funds paid to the State by the federal government under
Title XIX or Title XXI of the Social Security Act for services
delivered by community mental health services providers, and
any interest earned thereon, shall be deposited directly into
the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund before any
deposits are made into the General Revenue Fund. The next
$25,000,000, less any deposits made prior to the effective date
of this amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly, shall be
deposited into the General Revenue Fund. Amounts received in
excess of $98,000,000 shall be deposited 50% into the General
Revenue Fund and 50% into the Community Mental Health Medicaid
Trust Fund. At the direction of the Director of Healthcare and
Family Services, on April 1, 2005, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer
shall transfer amounts not to exceed $14,000,000 into the
Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund from the Public Aid
Recoveries Trust Fund.
    (b-2) For State fiscal year 2006, and in subsequent fiscal
years until any transfers under subsection (b-1) are repaid,
the first $73,000,000 in any funds paid to the State by the
federal government under Title XIX or Title XXI of the Social
Security Act for services delivered by community mental health
providers, and any interest earned thereon, shall be deposited
directly into the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund.
Then the next $14,000,000, or such amount as was transferred
under subsection (b-1) at the direction of the Director of
Healthcare and Family Services, shall be deposited into the
Public Aid Recoveries Trust Fund. Any additional amounts
received shall be deposited in accordance with subsection (b).
    (c) The Department shall reimburse community mental health
providers for services provided to eligible individuals.
Moneys in the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund may
be used for that purpose.
    (d) As used in this Section:
    "Community mental health provider" means a community
agency that is funded by the Department to provide a service.
    "Service" means a mental health service provided pursuant
to the provisions of administrative rules adopted by the
Department and funded by the Department of Human Services'
Division of Mental Health.
(Source: P.A. 93-841, eff. 7-30-04; 94-58, eff. 6-17-05;
94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (20 ILCS 1705/18.5)
    Sec. 18.5. Community Developmental Disability Services
Medicaid Trust Fund; reimbursement.
    (a) The Community Developmental Disability Services
Medicaid Trust Fund is hereby created in the State treasury.
    (b) Except as provided in subsection (b-5), any Any funds
in excess of $16,700,000 in any fiscal year paid to the State
by the federal government under Title XIX or Title XXI of the
Social Security Act for services delivered by community
developmental disability services providers for services
relating to Developmental Training and Community Integrated
Living Arrangements as a result of the conversion of such
providers from a grant payment methodology to a fee-for-service
payment methodology, or any other funds paid to the State for
any subsequent revenue maximization initiatives performed by
such providers, and any interest earned thereon, shall be
deposited directly into the Community Developmental Disability
Services Medicaid Trust Fund. One-third of this amount shall be
used only to pay for Medicaid-reimbursed community
developmental disability services provided to eligible
individuals, and the remainder shall be transferred to the
General Revenue Fund.
    (b-5) Beginning in State fiscal year 2008, any funds paid
to the State by the federal government under Title XIX or Title
XXI of the Social Security Act for services delivered through
the Children's Residential Waiver and the Children's In-Home
Support Waiver shall be deposited directly into the Community
Developmental Disability Services Medicaid Trust Fund and
shall not be subject to the transfer provisions of subsection
(b).
    (c) For purposes of this Section:
    "Medicaid-reimbursed developmental disability services"
means services provided by a community developmental
disability provider under an agreement with the Department that
is eligible for reimbursement under the federal Title XIX
program or Title XXI program.
    "Provider" means a qualified entity as defined in the
State's Home and Community-Based Services Waiver for Persons
with Developmental Disabilities that is funded by the
Department to provide a Medicaid-reimbursed service.
    "Revenue maximization alternatives" do not include
increases in funds paid to the State as a result of growth in
spending through service expansion or rate increases.
(Source: P.A. 93-841, eff. 7-30-04.)
 
    (20 ILCS 1705/57.5)
    Sec. 57.5. Autism diagnosis education program.
    (a) Subject to appropriations, the Department shall
contract to establish an autism diagnosis education program for
young children. The Department shall establish the program at 3
different sites in the State. The program shall have the
following goals:
        (1) Providing, to medical professionals and others
    statewide, a systems development initiative that promotes
    best practice standards for the diagnosis and treatment
    planning for young children who have autism spectrum
    disorders, for the purpose of helping existing systems of
    care to build solid circles of expertise within their
    ranks.
        (2) Educating medical practitioners, school personnel,
    day care providers, parents, and community service
    providers (including, but not limited to, early
    intervention and developmental disabilities providers)
    throughout the State on appropriate diagnosis and
    treatment of autism.
        (3) Supporting systems of care for young children with
    autism spectrum disorders.
        (4) Working together with universities and
    developmental disabilities providers to identify unmet
    needs and resources.
        (5) Encouraging and supporting research on optional
    services for young children with autism spectrum
    disorders.
    In addition to the aforementioned items, on January 1,
2008, The Autism Program shall expand training and direct
services by deploying additional regional centers, outreach
centers, and community planning and network development
initiatives. The expanded Autism Program Service Network shall
consist of a comprehensive program of outreach and center
development utilizing model programs developed by The Autism
Program. This expansion shall span Illinois and support
consensus building, outreach, and service provision for
children with autism spectrums disorders and their families.
    (b) Before January 1, 2006, the Department shall report to
the Governor and the General Assembly concerning the progress
of the autism diagnosis education program established under
this Section.
(Source: P.A. 93-395, eff. 7-29-03.)
 
    Section 5-7. The Hospital Basic Services Preservation Act
is amended by changing Sections 5 and 20 as follows:
 
    (20 ILCS 4050/5)
    Sec. 5. Definitions. As used in this Act:
    "Basic services" means emergency room and obstetrical
services provided within a hospital. "Basic services" is
limited to the emergency and obstetric units and services
provided by those units.
    "Eligible expenses" means expenses for expanding
obstetrical or emergency units, updating equipment, repairing
essential equipment, and purchasing new equipment that will
increase the quality of basic services provided. "Eligible
expenses" does not include expenses related to cosmetic
upgrades, staff expansion or salary, or structural expansion of
any unit or department of a hospital other than obstetrical or
emergency units.
    "Essential community hospital provider" means a facility
meeting criteria established by rule by the State Treasurer.
(Source: P.A. 94-648, eff. 1-1-06.)
 
    (20 ILCS 4050/20)
    Sec. 20. Responsibility of hospitals. Each hospital that
receives a loan collateralized under this Act shall take the
necessary measures, as defined by the State Treasurer by rule,
to account for all moneys and to ensure that they are spent on
the basic services for which the loan was approved. Any
hospital receiving a loan collateralized under this Act is not
eligible for collateralization of another basic services loan
under this Act within 10 years after the deposit of funds
awarded under the first collateralized loan.
(Source: P.A. 94-648, eff. 1-1-06.)
 
    Section 5-10. The State Finance Act is amended by changing
Sections 6z-65.5, 6z-66, 6z-67, 8.3, 8.27, 8g, 13.2, and 14.1
and by adding Sections 5.675, 5.676, 5.677, 5.678, 6z-69,
6z-70, and 25.5 as follows:
 
    (30 ILCS 105/5.675 new)
    Sec. 5.675. The Human Services Priority Capital Program
Fund.
 
    (30 ILCS 105/5.676 new)
    Sec. 5.676. The Predatory Lending Database Program Fund.
 
    (30 ILCS 105/5.677 new)
    Sec. 5.677. The Secretary of State Identification Security
and Theft Prevention Fund.
 
    (30 ILCS 105/5.678 new)
    Sec. 5.678. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty
Administration Fund.
 
    (30 ILCS 105/6z-65.5)
    Sec. 6z-65.5. SBE Federal Department of Education Fund. The
SBE Federal Department of Education Fund is created as a
federal trust fund in the State treasury. This fund is
established to receive funds from the federal Department of
Education, including non-indirect cost administrative funds
recovered from federal programs, for the specific purposes
established by the terms and conditions of federal awards.
Moneys in the SBE Federal Department of Education Fund shall be
used, subject to appropriation by the General Assembly, for
grants and contracts to local education agencies, colleges and
universities, and other State agencies and for administrative
expenses of the State Board of Education. However,
non-appropriated spending is allowed for the refund of
unexpended grant moneys to the federal government. The SBE
Federal Department of Education Fund shall serve as the
successor fund to the National Center for Education Statistics
Fund, and any balance remaining in the National Center for
Education Statistics Fund on the effective date of this
amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly must be transferred
to the SBE Federal Department of Education Fund by the State
Treasurer. Any future deposits that would otherwise be made
into the National Center for Education Statistics Fund must
instead be made into the SBE Federal Department of Education
Fund.
    On or after July 1, 2007, the State Board of Education
shall notify the State Comptroller of the amount of indirect
federal funds in the SBE Federal Department of Education Fund
to be transferred to the State Board of Education Special
Purpose Trust Fund. The State Comptroller shall direct and the
State Treasurer shall transfer this amount to the State Board
of Education Special Purpose Trust Fund as soon as practical
thereafter.
(Source: P.A. 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69, eff. 7-1-05.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/6z-66)
    Sec. 6z-66. SBE Federal Agency Services Fund. The SBE
Federal Agency Services Fund is created as a federal trust fund
in the State treasury. This fund is established to receive
funds from all federal departments and agencies except the
Departments of Education and Agriculture (including among
others the Departments of Health and Human Services, Defense,
and Labor and the Corporation for National and Community
Service), including non-indirect cost administrative funds
recovered from federal programs, for the specific purposes
established by the terms and conditions of federal awards.
Moneys in the SBE Federal Agency Services Fund shall be used,
subject to appropriation by the General Assembly, for grants
and contracts to local education agencies, colleges and
universities, and other State agencies and for administrative
expenses of the State Board of Education. However,
non-appropriated spending is allowed for the refund of
unexpended grant moneys to the federal government. The SBE
Federal Agency Services Fund shall serve as the successor fund
to the SBE Department of Health and Human Services Fund, the
SBE Federal Department of Labor Federal Trust Fund, and the SBE
Federal National Community Service Fund; and any balance
remaining in the SBE Department of Health and Human Services
Fund, the SBE Federal Department of Labor Federal Trust Fund,
or the SBE Federal National Community Service Fund on the
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 94th General
Assembly must be transferred to the SBE Federal Agency Services
Fund by the State Treasurer. Any future deposits that would
otherwise be made into the SBE Department of Health and Human
Services Fund, the SBE Federal Department of Labor Federal
Trust Fund, or the SBE Federal National Community Service Fund
must instead be made into the SBE Federal Agency Services Fund.
    On or after July 1, 2007, the State Board of Education
shall notify the State Comptroller of the amount of indirect
federal funds in the SBE Federal Agency Services Fund to be
transferred to the State Board of Education Special Purpose
Trust Fund. The State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer this amount to the State Board of
Education Special Purpose Trust Fund as soon as practical
thereafter.
(Source: P.A. 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69, eff. 7-1-05.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/6z-67)
    Sec. 6z-67. SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund. The
SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund is created as a
federal trust fund in the State treasury. This fund is
established to receive funds from the federal Department of
Agriculture, including non-indirect cost administrative funds
recovered from federal programs, for the specific purposes
established by the terms and conditions of federal awards.
Moneys in the SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund shall
be used, subject to appropriation by the General Assembly, for
grants and contracts to local education agencies, colleges and
universities, and other State agencies and for administrative
expenses of the State Board of Education. However,
non-appropriated spending is allowed for the refund of
unexpended grant moneys to the federal government.
    On or after July 1, 2007, the State Board of Education
shall notify the State Comptroller of the amount of indirect
federal funds in the SBE Federal Department of Agriculture Fund
to be transferred to the State Board of Education Special
Purpose Trust Fund. The State Comptroller shall direct and the
State Treasurer shall transfer this amount to the State Board
of Education Special Purpose Trust Fund as soon as practical
thereafter.
(Source: P.A. 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69, eff. 7-1-05; 94-835,
eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/6z-69 new)
    Sec. 6z-69. Human Services Priority Capital Program Fund.
The Human Services Priority Capital Program Fund is created as
a special fund in the State treasury. Subject to appropriation,
the Department of Human Services shall use moneys in the Human
Services Priority Capital Program Fund to make grants to the
Illinois Facilities Fund, a not-for-profit corporation, to
make long term below market rate loans to nonprofit human
service providers working under contract to the State of
Illinois to assist those providers in meeting their capital
needs. The loans shall be for the purpose of such capital
needs, including but not limited to special use facilities,
requirements for serving the disabled, mentally ill, or
substance abusers, and medical and technology equipment. Loan
repayments shall be deposited into the Human Services Priority
Capital Program Fund. Interest income may be used to cover
expenses of the program. The Illinois Facilities Fund shall
report to the Department of Human Services and the General
Assembly by April 1, 2008 as to the use and earnings of the
program.
 
    (30 ILCS 105/6z-70 new)
    Sec. 6z-70. The Secretary of State Identification Security
and Theft Prevention Fund.
    (a) The Secretary of State Identification Security and
Theft Prevention Fund is created as a special fund in the State
treasury. The Fund shall consist of any fund transfers, grants,
fees, or moneys from other sources received for the purpose of
funding identification security and theft prevention measures.
    (b) All moneys in the Secretary of State Identification
Security and Theft Prevention Fund shall be used, subject to
appropriation, for any costs related to implementing
identification security and theft prevention measures.
    (c) Notwithstanding any other provision of State law to the
contrary, on or after July 1, 2007, and until June 30, 2008, in
addition to any other transfers that may be provided for by
law, at the direction of and upon notification of the Secretary
of State, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts into the Secretary of State
Identification Security and Theft Prevention Fund from the
designated funds not exceeding the following totals:
    Lobbyist Registration Administration Fund.......$100,000
    Registered Limited Liability Partnership Fund....$75,000
    Securities Investors Education Fund.............$500,000
    Securities Audit and Enforcement Fund.........$5,725,000
    Department of Business Services
    Special Operations Fund.......................$3,000,000
    Corporate Franchise Tax Refund Fund..........$3,000,000.
 
    (30 ILCS 105/8.3)  (from Ch. 127, par. 144.3)
    Sec. 8.3. Money in the Road Fund shall, if and when the
State of Illinois incurs any bonded indebtedness for the
construction of permanent highways, be set aside and used for
the purpose of paying and discharging annually the principal
and interest on that bonded indebtedness then due and payable,
and for no other purpose. The surplus, if any, in the Road Fund
after the payment of principal and interest on that bonded
indebtedness then annually due shall be used as follows:
        first -- to pay the cost of administration of Chapters
    2 through 10 of the Illinois Vehicle Code, except the cost
    of administration of Articles I and II of Chapter 3 of that
    Code; and
        secondly -- for expenses of the Department of
    Transportation for construction, reconstruction,
    improvement, repair, maintenance, operation, and
    administration of highways in accordance with the
    provisions of laws relating thereto, or for any purpose
    related or incident to and connected therewith, including
    the separation of grades of those highways with railroads
    and with highways and including the payment of awards made
    by the Illinois Workers' Compensation Commission under the
    terms of the Workers' Compensation Act or Workers'
    Occupational Diseases Act for injury or death of an
    employee of the Division of Highways in the Department of
    Transportation; or for the acquisition of land and the
    erection of buildings for highway purposes, including the
    acquisition of highway right-of-way or for investigations
    to determine the reasonably anticipated future highway
    needs; or for making of surveys, plans, specifications and
    estimates for and in the construction and maintenance of
    flight strips and of highways necessary to provide access
    to military and naval reservations, to defense industries
    and defense-industry sites, and to the sources of raw
    materials and for replacing existing highways and highway
    connections shut off from general public use at military
    and naval reservations and defense-industry sites, or for
    the purchase of right-of-way, except that the State shall
    be reimbursed in full for any expense incurred in building
    the flight strips; or for the operating and maintaining of
    highway garages; or for patrolling and policing the public
    highways and conserving the peace; or for the operating
    expenses of the Department relating to the administration
    of public transportation programs; or for any of those
    purposes or any other purpose that may be provided by law.
    Appropriations for any of those purposes are payable from
the Road Fund. Appropriations may also be made from the Road
Fund for the administrative expenses of any State agency that
are related to motor vehicles or arise from the use of motor
vehicles.
    Beginning with fiscal year 1980 and thereafter, no Road
Fund monies shall be appropriated to the following Departments
or agencies of State government for administration, grants, or
operations; but this limitation is not a restriction upon
appropriating for those purposes any Road Fund monies that are
eligible for federal reimbursement;
        1. Department of Public Health;
        2. Department of Transportation, only with respect to
    subsidies for one-half fare Student Transportation and
    Reduced Fare for Elderly;
        3. Department of Central Management Services, except
    for expenditures incurred for group insurance premiums of
    appropriate personnel;
        4. Judicial Systems and Agencies.
    Beginning with fiscal year 1981 and thereafter, no Road
Fund monies shall be appropriated to the following Departments
or agencies of State government for administration, grants, or
operations; but this limitation is not a restriction upon
appropriating for those purposes any Road Fund monies that are
eligible for federal reimbursement:
        1. Department of State Police, except for expenditures
    with respect to the Division of Operations;
        2. Department of Transportation, only with respect to
    Intercity Rail Subsidies and Rail Freight Services.
    Beginning with fiscal year 1982 and thereafter, no Road
Fund monies shall be appropriated to the following Departments
or agencies of State government for administration, grants, or
operations; but this limitation is not a restriction upon
appropriating for those purposes any Road Fund monies that are
eligible for federal reimbursement: Department of Central
Management Services, except for awards made by the Illinois
Workers' Compensation Commission under the terms of the
Workers' Compensation Act or Workers' Occupational Diseases
Act for injury or death of an employee of the Division of
Highways in the Department of Transportation.
    Beginning with fiscal year 1984 and thereafter, no Road
Fund monies shall be appropriated to the following Departments
or agencies of State government for administration, grants, or
operations; but this limitation is not a restriction upon
appropriating for those purposes any Road Fund monies that are
eligible for federal reimbursement:
        1. Department of State Police, except not more than 40%
    of the funds appropriated for the Division of Operations;
        2. State Officers.
    Beginning with fiscal year 1984 and thereafter, no Road
Fund monies shall be appropriated to any Department or agency
of State government for administration, grants, or operations
except as provided hereafter; but this limitation is not a
restriction upon appropriating for those purposes any Road Fund
monies that are eligible for federal reimbursement. It shall
not be lawful to circumvent the above appropriation limitations
by governmental reorganization or other methods.
Appropriations shall be made from the Road Fund only in
accordance with the provisions of this Section.
    Money in the Road Fund shall, if and when the State of
Illinois incurs any bonded indebtedness for the construction of
permanent highways, be set aside and used for the purpose of
paying and discharging during each fiscal year the principal
and interest on that bonded indebtedness as it becomes due and
payable as provided in the Transportation Bond Act, and for no
other purpose. The surplus, if any, in the Road Fund after the
payment of principal and interest on that bonded indebtedness
then annually due shall be used as follows:
        first -- to pay the cost of administration of Chapters
    2 through 10 of the Illinois Vehicle Code; and
        secondly -- no Road Fund monies derived from fees,
    excises, or license taxes relating to registration,
    operation and use of vehicles on public highways or to
    fuels used for the propulsion of those vehicles, shall be
    appropriated or expended other than for costs of
    administering the laws imposing those fees, excises, and
    license taxes, statutory refunds and adjustments allowed
    thereunder, administrative costs of the Department of
    Transportation, including, but not limited to, the
    operating expenses of the Department relating to the
    administration of public transportation programs, payment
    of debts and liabilities incurred in construction and
    reconstruction of public highways and bridges, acquisition
    of rights-of-way for and the cost of construction,
    reconstruction, maintenance, repair, and operation of
    public highways and bridges under the direction and
    supervision of the State, political subdivision, or
    municipality collecting those monies, and the costs for
    patrolling and policing the public highways (by State,
    political subdivision, or municipality collecting that
    money) for enforcement of traffic laws. The separation of
    grades of such highways with railroads and costs associated
    with protection of at-grade highway and railroad crossing
    shall also be permissible.
    Appropriations for any of such purposes are payable from
the Road Fund or the Grade Crossing Protection Fund as provided
in Section 8 of the Motor Fuel Tax Law.
    Except as provided in this paragraph, beginning with fiscal
year 1991 and thereafter, no Road Fund monies shall be
appropriated to the Department of State Police for the purposes
of this Section in excess of its total fiscal year 1990 Road
Fund appropriations for those purposes unless otherwise
provided in Section 5g of this Act. For fiscal years 2003,
2004, 2005, 2006, and 2007 only, no Road Fund monies shall be
appropriated to the Department of State Police for the purposes
of this Section in excess of $97,310,000. For fiscal year 2008
only, no Road Fund monies shall be appropriated to the
Department of State Police for the purposes of this Section in
excess of $106,100,000. It shall not be lawful to circumvent
this limitation on appropriations by governmental
reorganization or other methods unless otherwise provided in
Section 5g of this Act.
    In fiscal year 1994, no Road Fund monies shall be
appropriated to the Secretary of State for the purposes of this
Section in excess of the total fiscal year 1991 Road Fund
appropriations to the Secretary of State for those purposes,
plus $9,800,000. It shall not be lawful to circumvent this
limitation on appropriations by governmental reorganization or
other method.
    Beginning with fiscal year 1995 and thereafter, no Road
Fund monies shall be appropriated to the Secretary of State for
the purposes of this Section in excess of the total fiscal year
1994 Road Fund appropriations to the Secretary of State for
those purposes. It shall not be lawful to circumvent this
limitation on appropriations by governmental reorganization or
other methods.
    Beginning with fiscal year 2000, total Road Fund
appropriations to the Secretary of State for the purposes of
this Section shall not exceed the amounts specified for the
following fiscal years:
        Fiscal Year 2000$80,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2001$80,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2002$80,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2003$130,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2004$130,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2005$130,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2006 $130,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2007 $130,500,000;
        Fiscal Year 2008 and$130,500,000; $30,500,000.
        Fiscal Year 2009 and each year thereafter
    It shall not be lawful to circumvent this limitation on
appropriations by governmental reorganization or other
methods.
    No new program may be initiated in fiscal year 1991 and
thereafter that is not consistent with the limitations imposed
by this Section for fiscal year 1984 and thereafter, insofar as
appropriation of Road Fund monies is concerned.
    Nothing in this Section prohibits transfers from the Road
Fund to the State Construction Account Fund under Section 5e of
this Act; nor to the General Revenue Fund, as authorized by
this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly.
    The additional amounts authorized for expenditure in this
Section by Public Acts 92-0600, 93-0025, 93-0839, and 94-91
shall be repaid to the Road Fund from the General Revenue Fund
in the next succeeding fiscal year that the General Revenue
Fund has a positive budgetary balance, as determined by
generally accepted accounting principles applicable to
government.
    The additional amounts authorized for expenditure by the
Secretary of State and the Department of State Police in this
Section by this amendatory Act of the 94th General Assembly
shall be repaid to the Road Fund from the General Revenue Fund
in the next succeeding fiscal year that the General Revenue
Fund has a positive budgetary balance, as determined by
generally accepted accounting principles applicable to
government.
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-721, eff. 1-1-05; 93-839,
eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/8.27)  (from Ch. 127, par. 144.27)
    Sec. 8.27. All receipts from federal financial
participation in the Foster Care and Adoption Services program
under Title IV-E of the federal Social Security Act, including
receipts for related indirect costs, shall be deposited in the
DCFS Children's Services Fund.
    Eighty percent of the federal funds received by the
Illinois Department of Human Services under the Title IV-A
Emergency Assistance program as reimbursement for expenditures
made from the Illinois Department of Children and Family
Services appropriations for the costs of services in behalf of
Department of Children and Family Services clients shall be
deposited into the DCFS Children's Services Fund.
    All receipts from federal financial participation in the
Child Welfare Services program under Title IV-B of the federal
Social Security Act, including receipts for related indirect
costs, shall be deposited into the DCFS Children's Services
Fund for those moneys received as reimbursement for services
provided on or after July 1, 1994.
    In addition, as soon as may be practicable after the first
day of November, 1994, the Department of Children and Family
Services shall request the Comptroller to order transferred and
the Treasurer shall transfer the unexpended balance of the
Child Welfare Services Fund to the DCFS Children's Services
Fund. Upon completion of the transfer, the Child Welfare
Services Fund will be considered dissolved and any outstanding
obligations or liabilities of that fund will pass to the DCFS
Children's Services Fund.
    For services provided on or after July 1, 2007, all federal
funds received pursuant to the John H. Chafee Foster Care
Independence Program shall be deposited into the DCFS
Children's Services Fund.
    Monies in the Fund may be used by the Department, pursuant
to appropriation by the General Assembly, for the ordinary and
contingent expenses of the Department.
    In fiscal year 1988 and in each fiscal year thereafter
through fiscal year 2000, the Comptroller shall order
transferred and the Treasurer shall transfer an amount of
$16,100,000 from the DCFS Children's Services Fund to the
General Revenue Fund in the following manner: As soon as may be
practicable after the 15th day of September, December, March
and June, the Comptroller shall order transferred and the
Treasurer shall transfer, to the extent that funds are
available, 1/4 of $16,100,000, plus any cumulative
deficiencies in such transfers for prior transfer dates during
such fiscal year. In no event shall any such transfer reduce
the available balance in the DCFS Children's Services Fund
below $350,000.
    In accordance with subsection (q) of Section 5 of the
Children and Family Services Act, disbursements from
individual children's accounts shall be deposited into the DCFS
Children's Services Fund.
    Receipts from public and unsolicited private grants, fees
for training, and royalties earned from the publication of
materials owned by or licensed to the Department of Children
and Family Services shall be deposited into the DCFS Children's
Services Fund.
    As soon as may be practical after September 1, 2005, upon
the request of the Department of Children and Family Services,
the Comptroller shall order transferred and the Treasurer shall
transfer the unexpended balance of the Department of Children
and Family Services Training Fund into the DCFS Children's
Services Fund. Upon completion of the transfer, the Department
of Children and Family Services Training Fund is dissolved and
any outstanding obligations or liabilities of that Fund pass to
the DCFS Children's Services Fund.
(Source: P.A. 94-91, eff. 7-1-05.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/8g)
    Sec. 8g. Fund transfers.
    (a) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, as soon as may be practical after the effective
date of this amendatory Act of the 91st General Assembly, the
State Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall
transfer the sum of $10,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund
to the Motor Vehicle License Plate Fund created by Senate Bill
1028 of the 91st General Assembly.
    (b) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, as soon as may be practical after the effective
date of this amendatory Act of the 91st General Assembly, the
State Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall
transfer the sum of $25,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund
to the Fund for Illinois' Future created by Senate Bill 1066 of
the 91st General Assembly.
    (c) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on August 30 of each fiscal year's license period,
the Illinois Liquor Control Commission shall direct and the
State Comptroller and State Treasurer shall transfer from the
General Revenue Fund to the Youth Alcoholism and Substance
Abuse Prevention Fund an amount equal to the number of retail
liquor licenses issued for that fiscal year multiplied by $50.
    (d) The payments to programs required under subsection (d)
of Section 28.1 of the Horse Racing Act of 1975 shall be made,
pursuant to appropriation, from the special funds referred to
in the statutes cited in that subsection, rather than directly
from the General Revenue Fund.
    Beginning January 1, 2000, on the first day of each month,
or as soon as may be practical thereafter, the State
Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer
from the General Revenue Fund to each of the special funds from
which payments are to be made under Section 28.1(d) of the
Horse Racing Act of 1975 an amount equal to 1/12 of the annual
amount required for those payments from that special fund,
which annual amount shall not exceed the annual amount for
those payments from that special fund for the calendar year
1998. The special funds to which transfers shall be made under
this subsection (d) include, but are not necessarily limited
to, the Agricultural Premium Fund; the Metropolitan Exposition
Auditorium and Office Building Fund; the Fair and Exposition
Fund; the Standardbred Breeders Fund; the Thoroughbred
Breeders Fund; and the Illinois Veterans' Rehabilitation Fund.
    (e) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, as soon as may be practical after the effective
date of this amendatory Act of the 91st General Assembly, but
in no event later than June 30, 2000, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$15,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Fund for
Illinois' Future.
    (f) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, as soon as may be practical after the effective
date of this amendatory Act of the 91st General Assembly, but
in no event later than June 30, 2000, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$70,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Long-Term Care
Provider Fund.
    (f-1) In fiscal year 2002, in addition to any other
transfers that may be provided for by law, at the direction of
and upon notification from the Governor, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer amounts not
exceeding a total of $160,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund
to the Long-Term Care Provider Fund.
    (g) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2001, or as soon thereafter as may be
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,200,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
    (h) In each of fiscal years 2002 through 2004, but not
thereafter, in addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, the State Comptroller shall direct and the
State Treasurer shall transfer $5,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Tourism Promotion Fund.
    (i) On or after July 1, 2001 and until May 1, 2002, in
addition to any other transfers that may be provided for by
law, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
re-transferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2002.
    (i-1) On or after July 1, 2002 and until May 1, 2003, in
addition to any other transfers that may be provided for by
law, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
re-transferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2003.
    (j) On or after July 1, 2001 and no later than June 30,
2002, in addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not to exceed the following
sums into the Statistical Services Revolving Fund:
    From the General Revenue Fund.................$8,450,000
    From the Public Utility Fund..................1,700,000
    From the Transportation Regulatory Fund.......2,650,000
    From the Title III Social Security and
     Employment Fund..............................3,700,000
    From the Professions Indirect Cost Fund.......4,050,000
    From the Underground Storage Tank Fund........550,000
    From the Agricultural Premium Fund............750,000
    From the State Pensions Fund..................200,000
    From the Road Fund............................2,000,000
    From the Health Facilities
     Planning Fund................................1,000,000
    From the Savings and Residential Finance
     Regulatory Fund..............................130,800
    From the Appraisal Administration Fund........28,600
    From the Pawnbroker Regulation Fund...........3,600
    From the Auction Regulation
     Administration Fund..........................35,800
    From the Bank and Trust Company Fund..........634,800
    From the Real Estate License
     Administration Fund..........................313,600
    (k) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, as soon as may be practical after the effective
date of this amendatory Act of the 92nd General Assembly, the
State Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall
transfer the sum of $2,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to
the Teachers Health Insurance Security Fund.
    (k-1) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2002, or as soon as may be
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $2,000,000 from
the General Revenue Fund to the Teachers Health Insurance
Security Fund.
    (k-2) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2003, or as soon as may be
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $2,000,000 from
the General Revenue Fund to the Teachers Health Insurance
Security Fund.
    (k-3) On or after July 1, 2002 and no later than June 30,
2003, in addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not to exceed the following
sums into the Statistical Services Revolving Fund:
    Appraisal Administration Fund.................$150,000
    General Revenue Fund..........................10,440,000
    Savings and Residential Finance
        Regulatory Fund...........................200,000
    State Pensions Fund...........................100,000
    Bank and Trust Company Fund...................100,000
    Professions Indirect Cost Fund................3,400,000
    Public Utility Fund...........................2,081,200
    Real Estate License Administration Fund.......150,000
    Title III Social Security and
        Employment Fund...........................1,000,000
    Transportation Regulatory Fund................3,052,100
    Underground Storage Tank Fund.................50,000
    (l) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2002, or as soon as may be practical
thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating
Fund.
    (m) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2002 and on the effective date of this
amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly, or as soon
thereafter as may be practical, the State Comptroller shall
direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$1,200,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Violence
Prevention Fund.
    (n) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2003, or as soon thereafter as may be
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $6,800,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the DHS Recoveries Trust Fund.
    (o) On or after July 1, 2003, and no later than June 30,
2004, in addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not to exceed the following
sums into the Vehicle Inspection Fund:
    From the Underground Storage Tank Fund .......$35,000,000.
    (p) On or after July 1, 2003 and until May 1, 2004, in
addition to any other transfers that may be provided for by
law, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
re-transferred from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the
General Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification
from the Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2004.
    (q) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2003, or as soon as may be practical
thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $5,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Illinois Military Family Relief Fund.
    (r) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2003, or as soon as may be practical
thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,922,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating
Fund.
    (s) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on or after July 1, 2003, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$4,800,000 from the Statewide Economic Development Fund to the
General Revenue Fund.
    (t) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on or after July 1, 2003, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of
$50,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Budget
Stabilization Fund.
    (u) On or after July 1, 2004 and until May 1, 2005, in
addition to any other transfers that may be provided for by
law, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
retransferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2005.
    (v) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2004, or as soon thereafter as may be
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,200,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
    (w) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2004, or as soon thereafter as may be
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $6,445,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating
Fund.
    (x) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on January 15, 2005, or as soon thereafter as may
be practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer to the General Revenue Fund the
following sums:
        From the State Crime Laboratory Fund, $200,000;
        From the State Police Wireless Service Emergency Fund,
    $200,000;
        From the State Offender DNA Identification System
    Fund, $800,000; and
        From the State Police Whistleblower Reward and
    Protection Fund, $500,000.
    (y) Notwithstanding any other provision of law to the
contrary, in addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law on June 30, 2005, or as soon as may be
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and
the State Treasurer shall transfer the remaining balance from
the designated funds into the General Revenue Fund and any
future deposits that would otherwise be made into these funds
must instead be made into the General Revenue Fund:
        (1) the Keep Illinois Beautiful Fund;
        (2) the Metropolitan Fair and Exposition Authority
    Reconstruction Fund;
        (3) the New Technology Recovery Fund;
        (4) the Illinois Rural Bond Bank Trust Fund;
        (5) the ISBE School Bus Driver Permit Fund;
        (6) the Solid Waste Management Revolving Loan Fund;
        (7) the State Postsecondary Review Program Fund;
        (8) the Tourism Attraction Development Matching Grant
    Fund;
        (9) the Patent and Copyright Fund;
        (10) the Credit Enhancement Development Fund;
        (11) the Community Mental Health and Developmental
    Disabilities Services Provider Participation Fee Trust
    Fund;
        (12) the Nursing Home Grant Assistance Fund;
        (13) the By-product Material Safety Fund;
        (14) the Illinois Student Assistance Commission Higher
    EdNet Fund;
        (15) the DORS State Project Fund;
        (16) the School Technology Revolving Fund;
        (17) the Energy Assistance Contribution Fund;
        (18) the Illinois Building Commission Revolving Fund;
        (19) the Illinois Aquaculture Development Fund;
        (20) the Homelessness Prevention Fund;
        (21) the DCFS Refugee Assistance Fund;
        (22) the Illinois Century Network Special Purposes
    Fund; and
        (23) the Build Illinois Purposes Fund.
    (z) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2005, or as soon as may be practical
thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,200,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
    (aa) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2005, or as soon as may be
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $9,000,000 from
the General Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum
Operating Fund.
    (bb) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2005, or as soon as may be
practical thereafter, the State Comptroller shall direct and
the State Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $6,803,600 from
the General Revenue Fund to the Securities Audit and
Enforcement Fund.
    (cc) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on or after July 1, 2005 and until May 1,
2006, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
re-transferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2006.
    (dd) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on April 1, 2005, or as soon thereafter as
may be practical, at the direction of the Director of Public
Aid (now Director of Healthcare and Family Services), the State
Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer
from the Public Aid Recoveries Trust Fund amounts not to exceed
$14,000,000 to the Community Mental Health Medicaid Trust Fund.
    (ee) Notwithstanding any other provision of law, on July 1,
2006, or as soon thereafter as practical, the State Comptroller
shall direct and the State Treasurer shall transfer the
remaining balance from the Illinois Civic Center Bond Fund to
the Illinois Civic Center Bond Retirement and Interest Fund.
    (ff) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until June
30, 2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Director of the Governor's Office of Management and Budget, the
State Comptroller shall direct and the State Treasurer shall
transfer amounts not exceeding a total of $1,900,000 from the
General Revenue Fund to the Illinois Capital Revolving Loan
Fund.
    (gg) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until May 1,
2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
retransferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2007.
    (hh) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until June
30, 2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts from the Illinois Affordable
Housing Trust Fund to the designated funds not exceeding the
following amounts:
    DCFS Children's Services Fund.................$2,200,000
    Department of Corrections Reimbursement
        and Education Fund........................$1,500,000
    Supplemental Low-Income Energy
        Assistance Fund..............................$75,000
    (ii) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on or before August 31, 2006, the Governor
and the State Comptroller may agree to transfer the surplus
cash balance from the General Revenue Fund to the Budget
Stabilization Fund and the Pension Stabilization Fund in equal
proportions. The determination of the amount of the surplus
cash balance shall be made by the Governor, with the
concurrence of the State Comptroller, after taking into account
the June 30, 2006 balances in the general funds and the actual
or estimated spending from the general funds during the lapse
period. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the maximum amount that
may be transferred under this subsection (ii) is $50,000,000.
    (jj) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $8,250,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating
Fund.
    (kk) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,400,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
    (ll) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on the first day of each calendar quarter
of the fiscal year beginning July 1, 2006, or as soon
thereafter as practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and
the State Treasurer shall transfer from the General Revenue
Fund amounts equal to one-fourth of $20,000,000 to the
Renewable Energy Resources Trust Fund.
    (mm) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,320,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the I-FLY Fund.
    (nn) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the African-American HIV/AIDS Response Fund.
    (oo) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2006 and until June
30, 2007, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts identified as net receipts
from the sale of all or part of the Illinois Student Assistance
Commission loan portfolio from the Student Loan Operating Fund
to the General Revenue Fund. The maximum amount that may be
transferred pursuant to this Section is $38,800,000. In
addition, no transfer may be made pursuant to this Section that
would have the effect of reducing the available balance in the
Student Loan Operating Fund to an amount less than the amount
remaining unexpended and unreserved from the total
appropriations from the Fund estimated to be expended for the
fiscal year. The State Treasurer and Comptroller shall transfer
the amounts designated under this Section as soon as may be
practical after receiving the direction to transfer from the
Governor.
    (pp) (ee) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2006, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $2,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Illinois Veterans Assistance Fund.
    (qq) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2007 and until May 1,
2008, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts not exceeding a total of
$80,000,000 from the General Revenue Fund to the Tobacco
Settlement Recovery Fund. Any amounts so transferred shall be
retransferred by the State Comptroller and the State Treasurer
from the Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund to the General
Revenue Fund at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, but in any event on or before June 30, 2008.
    (rr) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on and after July 1, 2007 and until June
30, 2008, at the direction of and upon notification from the
Governor, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer amounts from the Illinois Affordable
Housing Trust Fund to the designated funds not exceeding the
following amounts:
    DCFS Children's Services Fund.................$2,200,000
    Department of Corrections Reimbursement
        and Education Fund........................$1,500,000
    Supplemental Low-Income Energy
        Assistance Fund..............................$75,000
    (ss) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $8,250,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Presidential Library and Museum Operating
Fund.
    (tt) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,400,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Violence Prevention Fund.
    (uu) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $1,320,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the I-FLY Fund.
    (vv) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the African-American HIV/AIDS Response Fund.
    (ww) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,500,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Predatory Lending Database Program Fund.
    (xx) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $5,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Digital Divide Elimination Fund.
    (yy) In addition to any other transfers that may be
provided for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $4,000,000 from the General
Revenue Fund to the Digital Divide Elimination Infrastructure
Fund.
(Source: P.A. 93-32, eff. 6-20-03; 93-648, eff. 1-8-04; 93-839,
eff. 7-30-04; 93-1067, eff. 1-15-05; 94-58, eff. 6-17-05;
94-91, eff. 7-1-05; 94-816, eff. 5-30-06; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06;
revised 8-3-06.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/13.2)  (from Ch. 127, par. 149.2)
    Sec. 13.2. Transfers among line item appropriations.
    (a) Transfers among line item appropriations from the same
treasury fund for the objects specified in this Section may be
made in the manner provided in this Section when the balance
remaining in one or more such line item appropriations is
insufficient for the purpose for which the appropriation was
made.
    (a-1) No transfers may be made from one agency to another
agency, nor may transfers be made from one institution of
higher education to another institution of higher education.
    (a-2) Except as otherwise provided in this Section,
transfers may be made only among the objects of expenditure
enumerated in this Section, except that no funds may be
transferred from any appropriation for personal services, from
any appropriation for State contributions to the State
Employees' Retirement System, from any separate appropriation
for employee retirement contributions paid by the employer, nor
from any appropriation for State contribution for employee
group insurance. During State fiscal year 2005, an agency may
transfer amounts among its appropriations within the same
treasury fund for personal services, employee retirement
contributions paid by employer, and State Contributions to
retirement systems; notwithstanding and in addition to the
transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this Section, the
fiscal year 2005 transfers authorized in this sentence may be
made in an amount not to exceed 2% of the aggregate amount
appropriated to an agency within the same treasury fund. During
State fiscal year 2007, the Departments of Children and Family
Services, Corrections, Human Services, and Juvenile Justice
may transfer amounts among their respective appropriations
within the same treasury fund for personal services, employee
retirement contributions paid by employer, and State
contributions to retirement systems. Notwithstanding, and in
addition to, the transfers authorized in subsection (c) of this
Section, these transfers may be made in an amount not to exceed
2% of the aggregate amount appropriated to an agency within the
same treasury fund.
    (a-3) Further, if an agency receives a separate
appropriation for employee retirement contributions paid by
the employer, any transfer by that agency into an appropriation
for personal services must be accompanied by a corresponding
transfer into the appropriation for employee retirement
contributions paid by the employer, in an amount sufficient to
meet the employer share of the employee contributions required
to be remitted to the retirement system.
    (b) In addition to the general transfer authority provided
under subsection (c), the following agencies have the specific
transfer authority granted in this subsection:
    The Department of Healthcare and Family Services is
authorized to make transfers representing savings attributable
to not increasing grants due to the births of additional
children from line items for payments of cash grants to line
items for payments for employment and social services for the
purposes outlined in subsection (f) of Section 4-2 of the
Illinois Public Aid Code.
    The Department of Children and Family Services is
authorized to make transfers not exceeding 2% of the aggregate
amount appropriated to it within the same treasury fund for the
following line items among these same line items: Foster Home
and Specialized Foster Care and Prevention, Institutions and
Group Homes and Prevention, and Purchase of Adoption and
Guardianship Services.
    The Department on Aging is authorized to make transfers not
exceeding 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated to it within
the same treasury fund for the following Community Care Program
line items among these same line items: Homemaker and Senior
Companion Services, Alternative Senior Services, Case
Coordination Units, and Adult Day Care Services.
    The State Treasurer is authorized to make transfers among
line item appropriations from the Capital Litigation Trust
Fund, with respect to costs incurred in fiscal years 2002 and
2003 only, when the balance remaining in one or more such line
item appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which
the appropriation was made, provided that no such transfer may
be made unless the amount transferred is no longer required for
the purpose for which that appropriation was made.
    The State Board of Education is authorized to make
transfers from line item appropriations within the same
treasury fund for General State Aid and General State Aid -
Hold Harmless, provided that no such transfer may be made
unless the amount transferred is no longer required for the
purpose for which that appropriation was made, to the line item
appropriation for Transitional Assistance when the balance
remaining in such line item appropriation is insufficient for
the purpose for which the appropriation was made.
    The State Board of Education is authorized to make
transfers between the following line item appropriations
within the same treasury fund: Disabled Student
Services/Materials (Section 14-13.01 of the School Code),
Disabled Student Transportation Reimbursement (Section
14-13.01 of the School Code), Disabled Student Tuition -
Private Tuition (Section 14-7.02 of the School Code),
Extraordinary Special Education (Section 14-7.02b of the
School Code), Reimbursement for Free Lunch/Breakfast Program,
Summer School Payments (Section 18-4.3 of the School Code), and
Transportation - Regular/Vocational Reimbursement (Section
29-5 of the School Code). Such transfers shall be made only
when the balance remaining in one or more such line item
appropriations is insufficient for the purpose for which the
appropriation was made and provided that no such transfer may
be made unless the amount transferred is no longer required for
the purpose for which that appropriation was made.
    (c) The sum of such transfers for an agency in a fiscal
year shall not exceed 2% of the aggregate amount appropriated
to it within the same treasury fund for the following objects:
Personal Services; Extra Help; Student and Inmate
Compensation; State Contributions to Retirement Systems; State
Contributions to Social Security; State Contribution for
Employee Group Insurance; Contractual Services; Travel;
Commodities; Printing; Equipment; Electronic Data Processing;
Operation of Automotive Equipment; Telecommunications
Services; Travel and Allowance for Committed, Paroled and
Discharged Prisoners; Library Books; Federal Matching Grants
for Student Loans; Refunds; Workers' Compensation,
Occupational Disease, and Tort Claims; and, in appropriations
to institutions of higher education, Awards and Grants.
Notwithstanding the above, any amounts appropriated for
payment of workers' compensation claims to an agency to which
the authority to evaluate, administer and pay such claims has
been delegated by the Department of Central Management Services
may be transferred to any other expenditure object where such
amounts exceed the amount necessary for the payment of such
claims.
    (c-1) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2003.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section to the
contrary, for State fiscal year 2003 only, transfers among line
item appropriations to an agency from the same treasury fund
may be made provided that the sum of such transfers for an
agency in State fiscal year 2003 shall not exceed 3% of the
aggregate amount appropriated to that State agency for State
fiscal year 2003 for the following objects: personal services,
except that no transfer may be approved which reduces the
aggregate appropriations for personal services within an
agency; extra help; student and inmate compensation; State
contributions to retirement systems; State contributions to
social security; State contributions for employee group
insurance; contractual services; travel; commodities;
printing; equipment; electronic data processing; operation of
automotive equipment; telecommunications services; travel and
allowance for committed, paroled, and discharged prisoners;
library books; federal matching grants for student loans;
refunds; workers' compensation, occupational disease, and tort
claims; and, in appropriations to institutions of higher
education, awards and grants.
    (c-2) Special provisions for State fiscal year 2005.
Notwithstanding subsections (a), (a-2), and (c), for State
fiscal year 2005 only, transfers may be made among any line
item appropriations from the same or any other treasury fund
for any objects or purposes, without limitation, when the
balance remaining in one or more such line item appropriations
is insufficient for the purpose for which the appropriation was
made, provided that the sum of those transfers by a State
agency shall not exceed 4% of the aggregate amount appropriated
to that State agency for fiscal year 2005.
    (d) Transfers among appropriations made to agencies of the
Legislative and Judicial departments and to the
constitutionally elected officers in the Executive branch
require the approval of the officer authorized in Section 10 of
this Act to approve and certify vouchers. Transfers among
appropriations made to the University of Illinois, Southern
Illinois University, Chicago State University, Eastern
Illinois University, Governors State University, Illinois
State University, Northeastern Illinois University, Northern
Illinois University, Western Illinois University, the Illinois
Mathematics and Science Academy and the Board of Higher
Education require the approval of the Board of Higher Education
and the Governor. Transfers among appropriations to all other
agencies require the approval of the Governor.
    The officer responsible for approval shall certify that the
transfer is necessary to carry out the programs and purposes
for which the appropriations were made by the General Assembly
and shall transmit to the State Comptroller a certified copy of
the approval which shall set forth the specific amounts
transferred so that the Comptroller may change his records
accordingly. The Comptroller shall furnish the Governor with
information copies of all transfers approved for agencies of
the Legislative and Judicial departments and transfers
approved by the constitutionally elected officials of the
Executive branch other than the Governor, showing the amounts
transferred and indicating the dates such changes were entered
on the Comptroller's records.
    (e) The State Board of Education, in consultation with the
State Comptroller, may transfer line item appropriations for
General State Aid from the Common School Fund to the Education
Assistance Fund.
(Source: P.A. 93-680, eff. 7-1-04; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04;
94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/14.1)   (from Ch. 127, par. 150.1)
    Sec. 14.1. Appropriations for State contributions to the
State Employees' Retirement System; payroll requirements.
    (a) Appropriations for State contributions to the State
Employees' Retirement System of Illinois shall be expended in
the manner provided in this Section. Except as otherwise
provided in subsection (a-1), at the time of each payment of
salary to an employee under the personal services line item,
payment shall be made to the State Employees' Retirement
System, from the amount appropriated for State contributions to
the State Employees' Retirement System, of an amount calculated
at the rate certified for the applicable fiscal year by the
Board of Trustees of the State Employees' Retirement System
under Section 14-135.08 of the Illinois Pension Code. If a line
item appropriation to an employer for this purpose is exhausted
or is unavailable due to any limitation on appropriations that
may apply, (including, but not limited to, limitations on
appropriations from the Road Fund under Section 8.3 of the
State Finance Act), the amounts shall be paid under the
continuing appropriation for this purpose contained in the
State Pension Funds Continuing Appropriation Act.
    (a-1) Beginning on the effective date of this amendatory
Act of the 93rd General Assembly through the payment of the
final payroll from fiscal year 2004 appropriations,
appropriations for State contributions to the State Employees'
Retirement System of Illinois shall be expended in the manner
provided in this subsection (a-1). At the time of each payment
of salary to an employee under the personal services line item
from a fund other than the General Revenue Fund, payment shall
be made for deposit into the General Revenue Fund from the
amount appropriated for State contributions to the State
Employees' Retirement System of an amount calculated at the
rate certified for fiscal year 2004 by the Board of Trustees of
the State Employees' Retirement System under Section 14-135.08
of the Illinois Pension Code. This payment shall be made to the
extent that a line item appropriation to an employer for this
purpose is available or unexhausted. No payment from
appropriations for State contributions shall be made in
conjunction with payment of salary to an employee under the
personal services line item from the General Revenue Fund.
    (b) Except during the period beginning on the effective
date of this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly and
ending at the time of the payment of the final payroll from
fiscal year 2004 appropriations, the State Comptroller shall
not approve for payment any payroll voucher that (1) includes
payments of salary to eligible employees in the State
Employees' Retirement System of Illinois and (2) does not
include the corresponding payment of State contributions to
that retirement system at the full rate certified under Section
14-135.08 for that fiscal year for eligible employees, unless
the balance in the fund on which the payroll voucher is drawn
is insufficient to pay the total payroll voucher, or
unavailable due to any limitation on appropriations that may
apply, including, but not limited to, limitations on
appropriations from the Road Fund under Section 8.3 of the
State Finance Act. If the State Comptroller approves a payroll
voucher under this Section for which the fund balance is
insufficient to pay the full amount of the required State
contribution to the State Employees' Retirement System, the
Comptroller shall promptly so notify the Retirement System.
    (c) Notwithstanding any other provisions of law, beginning
July 1, 2007, required State and employee contributions to the
State Employees' Retirement System of Illinois relating to
affected legislative staff employees shall be paid out of
moneys appropriated for that purpose to the Commission on
Government Forecasting and Accountability, rather than out of
the lump-sum appropriations otherwise made for the payroll and
other costs of those employees.
    These payments must be made pursuant to payroll vouchers
submitted by the employing entity as part of the regular
payroll voucher process.
    For the purpose of this subsection, "affected legislative
staff employees" means legislative staff employees paid out of
lump-sum appropriations made to the General Assembly, an
Officer of the General Assembly, or the Senate Operations
Commission, but does not include district-office staff or
employees of legislative support services agencies.
(Source: P.A. 93-665, eff. 3-5-04; 93-1067, eff. 1-15-05.)
 
    (30 ILCS 105/25.5 new)
    Sec. 25.5. FY2008 payment validation. All expenses
lawfully incurred during July of 2007 under an appropriation or
reappropriation included in Public Act 95-11 shall be paid by
the State Comptroller and State Treasurer at the time and in
the manner normally provided by law, notwithstanding that the
appropriation under that Public Act may have expired prior to
the actual date of payment due to the repeal of that Public
Act. Any otherwise lawful action of the State Comptroller, the
State Treasurer, or any public employee in the course of making
payment in accordance with this Section is hereby validated.
 
    Section 5-13. The Budget Stabilization Act is amended by
changing Section 10 as follows:
 
    (30 ILCS 122/10)
    Sec. 10. Budget limitations.
    (a) Except as provided in subsection (b-5), in In addition
to Section 50-5 of the State Budget Law of the Civil
Administrative Code of Illinois, the General Assembly's
appropriations and transfers or diversions as required by law
from general funds shall not exceed 99% of the estimated
general funds revenues for the fiscal year when revenue
estimates of the State's general funds revenues exceed the
prior fiscal year's estimated general funds revenues by more
than 4%.
    (b) Except as provided in subsection (b-5), the The General
Assembly's appropriations and transfers or diversions as
required by law from general funds shall not exceed 98% of the
estimated general funds revenues for the fiscal year when
revenue estimates of the State's general funds revenues exceed
the prior fiscal year's estimated general funds revenues by
more than 4% for 2 or more consecutive fiscal years.
    (b-5) The limitations on appropriations and transfers or
diversions set forth under subsections (a) and (b) do not apply
for State fiscal year 2008.
    (c) For the purpose of this Act, "estimated general funds
revenues" include, for each budget year, all taxes, fees, and
other revenues expected to be deposited into the State's
general funds, including recurring transfers from other State
funds into the general funds.
    Year-over-year comparisons used to determine the
percentage growth factor of estimated general funds revenues
shall exclude the sum of the following: (i) expected revenues
resulting from new taxes or fees or from tax or fee increases
during the first year of the change, (ii) expected revenues
resulting from one-time receipts or non-recurring transfers
in, (iii) expected proceeds resulting from borrowing, and (iv)
increases in federal grants that must be completely
appropriated based on the terms of the grants.
(Source: P.A. 93-660, eff. 7-1-04; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    Section 5-15. The Illinois Income Tax Act is amended by
changing Sections 203, 304, 704A, 709.5, 901, 1001, 1007,
1405.5, 1405.6 and 1501 as follows:
 
    (35 ILCS 5/203)  (from Ch. 120, par. 2-203)
    Sec. 203. Base income defined.
    (a) Individuals.
        (1) In general. In the case of an individual, base
    income means an amount equal to the taxpayer's adjusted
    gross income for the taxable year as modified by paragraph
    (2).
        (2) Modifications. The adjusted gross income referred
    to in paragraph (1) shall be modified by adding thereto the
    sum of the following amounts:
            (A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued
        to the taxpayer as interest or dividends during the
        taxable year to the extent excluded from gross income
        in the computation of adjusted gross income, except
        stock dividends of qualified public utilities
        described in Section 305(e) of the Internal Revenue
        Code;
            (B) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by
        this Act to the extent deducted from gross income in
        the computation of adjusted gross income for the
        taxable year;
            (C) An amount equal to the amount received during
        the taxable year as a recovery or refund of real
        property taxes paid with respect to the taxpayer's
        principal residence under the Revenue Act of 1939 and
        for which a deduction was previously taken under
        subparagraph (L) of this paragraph (2) prior to July 1,
        1991, the retrospective application date of Article 4
        of Public Act 87-17. In the case of multi-unit or
        multi-use structures and farm dwellings, the taxes on
        the taxpayer's principal residence shall be that
        portion of the total taxes for the entire property
        which is attributable to such principal residence;
            (D) An amount equal to the amount of the capital
        gain deduction allowable under the Internal Revenue
        Code, to the extent deducted from gross income in the
        computation of adjusted gross income;
            (D-5) An amount, to the extent not included in
        adjusted gross income, equal to the amount of money
        withdrawn by the taxpayer in the taxable year from a
        medical care savings account and the interest earned on
        the account in the taxable year of a withdrawal
        pursuant to subsection (b) of Section 20 of the Medical
        Care Savings Account Act or subsection (b) of Section
        20 of the Medical Care Savings Account Act of 2000;
            (D-10) For taxable years ending after December 31,
        1997, an amount equal to any eligible remediation costs
        that the individual deducted in computing adjusted
        gross income and for which the individual claims a
        credit under subsection (l) of Section 201;
            (D-15) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an
        amount equal to the bonus depreciation deduction taken
        on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the
        taxable year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the
        Internal Revenue Code;
            (D-16) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons,
        or otherwise disposes of property for which the
        taxpayer was required in any taxable year to make an
        addition modification under subparagraph (D-15), then
        an amount equal to the aggregate amount of the
        deductions taken in all taxable years under
        subparagraph (Z) with respect to that property.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction
        modification under subparagraph (Z), then an amount
        equal to that subtraction modification.
            The taxpayer is required to make the addition
        modification under this subparagraph only once with
        respect to any one piece of property;
            (D-17) An amount equal to the amount otherwise
        allowed as a deduction in computing base income for
        interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
        indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a
        member of the same unitary business group but for the
        fact that foreign person's business activity outside
        the United States is 80% or more of the foreign
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304. The addition modification
        required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the
        extent that dividends were included in base income of
        the unitary group for the same taxable year and
        received by the taxpayer or by a member of the
        taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts
        included in gross income under Sections 951 through 964
        of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in
        gross income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue
        Code) with respect to the stock of the same person to
        whom the interest was paid, accrued, or incurred.
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such interest; or
                (ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a
            preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person, during the same
                taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                interest to a person that is not a related
                member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                interest expense between the taxpayer and the
                foreign person did not have as a principal
                purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax,
                and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement
                that reflects an arm's-length interest rate
                and terms; or
                (iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on
            clear and convincing evidence, that the interest
            paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or
            agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and
            terms and the principal purpose for the payment is
            not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
                (iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f).
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act;
            (D-18) An amount equal to the amount of intangible
        expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in
        computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a
        foreign person who would be a member of the same
        unitary business group but for the fact that the
        foreign person's business activity outside the United
        States is 80% or more of that person's total business
        activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of
        the same unitary business group but for the fact that
        the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27)
        from being included in the unitary business group
        because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion
        business income under different subsections of Section
        304. The addition modification required by this
        subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that
        dividends were included in base income of the unitary
        group for the same taxable year and received by the
        taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary
        business group (including amounts included in gross
        income under Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal
        Revenue Code and amounts included in gross income under
        Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect
        to the stock of the same person to whom the intangible
        expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid,
        incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not
        apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a
        reduction to the addition modification required under
        Section 203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act. As used in this
        subparagraph, the term "intangible expenses and costs"
        includes (1) expenses, losses, and costs for, or
        related to, the direct or indirect acquisition, use,
        maintenance or management, ownership, sale, exchange,
        or any other disposition of intangible property; (2)
        losses incurred, directly or indirectly, from
        factoring transactions or discounting transactions;
        (3) royalty, patent, technical, and copyright fees;
        (4) licensing fees; and (5) other similar expenses and
        costs. For purposes of this subparagraph, "intangible
        property" includes patents, patent applications, trade
        names, trademarks, service marks, copyrights, mask
        works, trade secrets, and similar types of intangible
        assets.
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) any item of intangible expenses or costs
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such item; or
                (ii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based
            on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person during the same
                taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                intangible expense or cost to a person that is
                not a related member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                intangible expense or cost between the
                taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as
                a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois
                income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract
                or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms;
                or
                (iii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence, that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f);
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act;
            (D-19) For taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of
        insurance premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed
        as a deduction in computing base income, and that were
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        a person who would be a member of the same unitary
        business group but for the fact that the person is
        prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being
        included in the unitary business group because he or
        she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304. The
        addition modification required by this subparagraph
        shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were
        included in base income of the unitary group for the
        same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group
        (including amounts included in gross income under
        Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code
        and amounts included in gross income under Section 78
        of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock
        of the same person to whom the premiums intangible
        expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid,
        incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not
        apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a
        reduction to the addition modification required under
        Section 203(a)(2)(D-17) or Section 203(a)(2)(D-18) of
        this Act.
            (D-20) For taxable years beginning on or after
        January 1, 2002 and ending on or before December 31,
        2006, in the case of a distribution from a qualified
        tuition program under Section 529 of the Internal
        Revenue Code, other than (i) a distribution from a
        College Savings Pool created under Section 16.5 of the
        State Treasurer Act or (ii) a distribution from the
        Illinois Prepaid Tuition Trust Fund, an amount equal to
        the amount excluded from gross income under Section
        529(c)(3)(B). For taxable years beginning on or after
        January 1, 2007, in the case of a distribution from a
        qualified tuition program under Section 529 of the
        Internal Revenue Code, other than (i) a distribution
        from a College Savings Pool created under Section 16.5
        of the State Treasurer Act, (ii) a distribution from
        the Illinois Prepaid Tuition Trust Fund, or (iii) a
        distribution from a qualified tuition program under
        Section 529 of the Internal Revenue Code that (I)
        adopts and determines that its offering materials
        comply with the College Savings Plans Network's
        disclosure principles and (II) has made reasonable
        efforts to inform in-state residents of the existence
        of in-state qualified tuition programs by informing
        Illinois residents directly and, where applicable, to
        inform financial intermediaries distributing the
        program to inform in-state residents of the existence
        of in-state qualified tuition programs at least
        annually, an amount equal to the amount excluded from
        gross income under Section 529(c)(3)(B).
            For the purposes of this subparagraph (D-20), a
        qualified tuition program has made reasonable efforts
        if it makes disclosures (which may use the term
        "in-state program" or "in-state plan" and need not
        specifically refer to Illinois or its qualified
        programs by name) (i) directly to prospective
        participants in its offering materials or makes a
        public disclosure, such as a website posting; and (ii)
        where applicable, to intermediaries selling the
        out-of-state program in the same manner that the
        out-of-state program distributes its offering
        materials;
                (D-21) For taxable years beginning on or after
        January 1, 2007, in the case of transfer of moneys from
        a qualified tuition program under Section 529 of the
        Internal Revenue Code that is administered by the State
        to an out-of-state program, an amount equal to the
        amount of moneys previously deducted from base income
        under subsection (a)(2)(Y) of this Section.
    and by deducting from the total so obtained the sum of the
    following amounts:
            (E) For taxable years ending before December 31,
        2001, any amount included in such total in respect of
        any compensation (including but not limited to any
        compensation paid or accrued to a serviceman while a
        prisoner of war or missing in action) paid to a
        resident by reason of being on active duty in the Armed
        Forces of the United States and in respect of any
        compensation paid or accrued to a resident who as a
        governmental employee was a prisoner of war or missing
        in action, and in respect of any compensation paid to a
        resident in 1971 or thereafter for annual training
        performed pursuant to Sections 502 and 503, Title 32,
        United States Code as a member of the Illinois National
        Guard or, beginning with taxable years ending on or
        after December 31, 2007, the National Guard of any
        other state. For taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2001, any amount included in such total in
        respect of any compensation (including but not limited
        to any compensation paid or accrued to a serviceman
        while a prisoner of war or missing in action) paid to a
        resident by reason of being a member of any component
        of the Armed Forces of the United States and in respect
        of any compensation paid or accrued to a resident who
        as a governmental employee was a prisoner of war or
        missing in action, and in respect of any compensation
        paid to a resident in 2001 or thereafter by reason of
        being a member of the Illinois National Guard or,
        beginning with taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2007, the National Guard of any other
        state. The provisions of this amendatory Act of the
        92nd General Assembly are exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (F) An amount equal to all amounts included in such
        total pursuant to the provisions of Sections 402(a),
        402(c), 403(a), 403(b), 406(a), 407(a), and 408 of the
        Internal Revenue Code, or included in such total as
        distributions under the provisions of any retirement
        or disability plan for employees of any governmental
        agency or unit, or retirement payments to retired
        partners, which payments are excluded in computing net
        earnings from self employment by Section 1402 of the
        Internal Revenue Code and regulations adopted pursuant
        thereto;
            (G) The valuation limitation amount;
            (H) An amount equal to the amount of any tax
        imposed by this Act which was refunded to the taxpayer
        and included in such total for the taxable year;
            (I) An amount equal to all amounts included in such
        total pursuant to the provisions of Section 111 of the
        Internal Revenue Code as a recovery of items previously
        deducted from adjusted gross income in the computation
        of taxable income;
            (J) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total which were paid by a corporation which
        conducts business operations in an Enterprise Zone or
        zones created under the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or
        a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones created under
        the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act, and conducts
        substantially all of its operations in an Enterprise
        Zone or zones or a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or
        zones. This subparagraph (J) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (K) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total that were paid by a corporation that
        conducts business operations in a federally designated
        Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated a
        High Impact Business located in Illinois; provided
        that dividends eligible for the deduction provided in
        subparagraph (J) of paragraph (2) of this subsection
        shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under
        this subparagraph (K);
            (L) For taxable years ending after December 31,
        1983, an amount equal to all social security benefits
        and railroad retirement benefits included in such
        total pursuant to Sections 72(r) and 86 of the Internal
        Revenue Code;
            (M) With the exception of any amounts subtracted
        under subparagraph (N), an amount equal to the sum of
        all amounts disallowed as deductions by (i) Sections
        171(a) (2), and 265(2) of the Internal Revenue Code of
        1954, as now or hereafter amended, and all amounts of
        expenses allocable to interest and disallowed as
        deductions by Section 265(1) of the Internal Revenue
        Code of 1954, as now or hereafter amended; and (ii) for
        taxable years ending on or after August 13, 1999,
        Sections 171(a)(2), 265, 280C, and 832(b)(5)(B)(i) of
        the Internal Revenue Code; the provisions of this
        subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of Section
        250;
            (N) An amount equal to all amounts included in such
        total which are exempt from taxation by this State
        either by reason of its statutes or Constitution or by
        reason of the Constitution, treaties or statutes of the
        United States; provided that, in the case of any
        statute of this State or, for taxable years ending on
        or after December 31, 2008, of the United States, any
        treaty of the United States, the Illinois
        Constitution, or the United States Constitution that
        exempts income derived from bonds or other obligations
        from the tax imposed under this Act, the amount
        exempted shall be the interest income net of bond
        premium amortization, and, for taxable years ending on
        or after December 31, 2008, interest expense incurred
        on indebtedness to carry the bond or other obligation,
        expenses incurred in producing the income to be
        deducted, and all other related expenses. The amount of
        expenses to be taken into account under this provision
        may not exceed the amount of income that is exempted;
            (O) An amount equal to any contribution made to a
        job training project established pursuant to the Tax
        Increment Allocation Redevelopment Act;
            (P) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction
        used to compute the federal income tax credit for
        restoration of substantial amounts held under claim of
        right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of
        the Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
            (Q) An amount equal to any amounts included in such
        total, received by the taxpayer as an acceleration in
        the payment of life, endowment or annuity benefits in
        advance of the time they would otherwise be payable as
        an indemnity for a terminal illness;
            (R) An amount equal to the amount of any federal or
        State bonus paid to veterans of the Persian Gulf War;
            (S) An amount, to the extent included in adjusted
        gross income, equal to the amount of a contribution
        made in the taxable year on behalf of the taxpayer to a
        medical care savings account established under the
        Medical Care Savings Account Act or the Medical Care
        Savings Account Act of 2000 to the extent the
        contribution is accepted by the account administrator
        as provided in that Act;
            (T) An amount, to the extent included in adjusted
        gross income, equal to the amount of interest earned in
        the taxable year on a medical care savings account
        established under the Medical Care Savings Account Act
        or the Medical Care Savings Account Act of 2000 on
        behalf of the taxpayer, other than interest added
        pursuant to item (D-5) of this paragraph (2);
            (U) For one taxable year beginning on or after
        January 1, 1994, an amount equal to the total amount of
        tax imposed and paid under subsections (a) and (b) of
        Section 201 of this Act on grant amounts received by
        the taxpayer under the Nursing Home Grant Assistance
        Act during the taxpayer's taxable years 1992 and 1993;
            (V) Beginning with tax years ending on or after
        December 31, 1995 and ending with tax years ending on
        or before December 31, 2004, an amount equal to the
        amount paid by a taxpayer who is a self-employed
        taxpayer, a partner of a partnership, or a shareholder
        in a Subchapter S corporation for health insurance or
        long-term care insurance for that taxpayer or that
        taxpayer's spouse or dependents, to the extent that the
        amount paid for that health insurance or long-term care
        insurance may be deducted under Section 213 of the
        Internal Revenue Code of 1986, has not been deducted on
        the federal income tax return of the taxpayer, and does
        not exceed the taxable income attributable to that
        taxpayer's income, self-employment income, or
        Subchapter S corporation income; except that no
        deduction shall be allowed under this item (V) if the
        taxpayer is eligible to participate in any health
        insurance or long-term care insurance plan of an
        employer of the taxpayer or the taxpayer's spouse. The
        amount of the health insurance and long-term care
        insurance subtracted under this item (V) shall be
        determined by multiplying total health insurance and
        long-term care insurance premiums paid by the taxpayer
        times a number that represents the fractional
        percentage of eligible medical expenses under Section
        213 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 not actually
        deducted on the taxpayer's federal income tax return;
            (W) For taxable years beginning on or after January
        1, 1998, all amounts included in the taxpayer's federal
        gross income in the taxable year from amounts converted
        from a regular IRA to a Roth IRA. This paragraph is
        exempt from the provisions of Section 250;
            (X) For taxable year 1999 and thereafter, an amount
        equal to the amount of any (i) distributions, to the
        extent includible in gross income for federal income
        tax purposes, made to the taxpayer because of his or
        her status as a victim of persecution for racial or
        religious reasons by Nazi Germany or any other Axis
        regime or as an heir of the victim and (ii) items of
        income, to the extent includible in gross income for
        federal income tax purposes, attributable to, derived
        from or in any way related to assets stolen from,
        hidden from, or otherwise lost to a victim of
        persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi
        Germany or any other Axis regime immediately prior to,
        during, and immediately after World War II, including,
        but not limited to, interest on the proceeds receivable
        as insurance under policies issued to a victim of
        persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi
        Germany or any other Axis regime by European insurance
        companies immediately prior to and during World War II;
        provided, however, this subtraction from federal
        adjusted gross income does not apply to assets acquired
        with such assets or with the proceeds from the sale of
        such assets; provided, further, this paragraph shall
        only apply to a taxpayer who was the first recipient of
        such assets after their recovery and who is a victim of
        persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi
        Germany or any other Axis regime or as an heir of the
        victim. The amount of and the eligibility for any
        public assistance, benefit, or similar entitlement is
        not affected by the inclusion of items (i) and (ii) of
        this paragraph in gross income for federal income tax
        purposes. This paragraph is exempt from the provisions
        of Section 250;
            (Y) For taxable years beginning on or after January
        1, 2002 and ending on or before December 31, 2004,
        moneys contributed in the taxable year to a College
        Savings Pool account under Section 16.5 of the State
        Treasurer Act, except that amounts excluded from gross
        income under Section 529(c)(3)(C)(i) of the Internal
        Revenue Code shall not be considered moneys
        contributed under this subparagraph (Y). For taxable
        years beginning on or after January 1, 2005, a maximum
        of $10,000 contributed in the taxable year to (i) a
        College Savings Pool account under Section 16.5 of the
        State Treasurer Act or (ii) the Illinois Prepaid
        Tuition Trust Fund, except that amounts excluded from
        gross income under Section 529(c)(3)(C)(i) of the
        Internal Revenue Code shall not be considered moneys
        contributed under this subparagraph (Y). This
        subparagraph (Y) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (Z) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the
        taxable year in which the bonus depreciation deduction
        is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return
        under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal
        Revenue Code and for each applicable taxable year
        thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
                (1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation
            deduction taken for the taxable year on the
            taxpayer's federal income tax return on property
            for which the bonus depreciation deduction was
            taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section
            168 of the Internal Revenue Code, but not including
            the bonus depreciation deduction;
                (2) for taxable years ending on or before
            December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30
            and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
            0.429); and
                (3) for taxable years ending after December
            31, 2005:
                    (i) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                30 and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
                0.429); and
                    (ii) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                1.0.
            The aggregate amount deducted under this
        subparagraph in all taxable years for any one piece of
        property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
        depreciation deduction taken on that property on the
        taxpayer's federal income tax return under subsection
        (k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This
        subparagraph (Z) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (AA) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons,
        or otherwise disposes of property for which the
        taxpayer was required in any taxable year to make an
        addition modification under subparagraph (D-15), then
        an amount equal to that addition modification.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was required in any taxable year to make an addition
        modification under subparagraph (D-15), then an amount
        equal to that addition modification.
            The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under
        this subparagraph only once with respect to any one
        piece of property.
            This subparagraph (AA) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (BB) Any amount included in adjusted gross income,
        other than salary, received by a driver in a
        ridesharing arrangement using a motor vehicle;
            (CC) The amount of (i) any interest income (net of
        the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account
        for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with
        a taxpayer that is required to make an addition
        modification with respect to such transaction under
        Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12),
        203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed
        the amount of that addition modification, and (ii) any
        income from intangible property (net of the deductions
        allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable
        year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that
        is required to make an addition modification with
        respect to such transaction under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or
        203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of that
        addition modification. This subparagraph (CC) is
        exempt from the provisions of Section 250;
            (DD) An amount equal to the interest income taken
        into account for the taxable year (net of the
        deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(a)(2)(D-17) for
        interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
        indirectly, to the same person. This subparagraph (DD)
        is exempt from the provisions of Section 250;and
            (EE) An amount equal to the income from intangible
        property taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(a)(2)(D-18) for
        intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign
        person. This subparagraph (EE) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250. ; and
            (FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance
        premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with a person who would be a member of the
        same unitary business group but for the fact that the
        person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from
        being included in the unitary business group because he
        or she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304, but
        not to exceed the addition modification required to be
        made for the same taxable year under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        the same person.
 
    (b) Corporations.
        (1) In general. In the case of a corporation, base
    income means an amount equal to the taxpayer's taxable
    income for the taxable year as modified by paragraph (2).
        (2) Modifications. The taxable income referred to in
    paragraph (1) shall be modified by adding thereto the sum
    of the following amounts:
            (A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued
        to the taxpayer as interest and all distributions
        received from regulated investment companies during
        the taxable year to the extent excluded from gross
        income in the computation of taxable income;
            (B) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by
        this Act to the extent deducted from gross income in
        the computation of taxable income for the taxable year;
            (C) In the case of a regulated investment company,
        an amount equal to the excess of (i) the net long-term
        capital gain for the taxable year, over (ii) the amount
        of the capital gain dividends designated as such in
        accordance with Section 852(b)(3)(C) of the Internal
        Revenue Code and any amount designated under Section
        852(b)(3)(D) of the Internal Revenue Code,
        attributable to the taxable year (this amendatory Act
        of 1995 (Public Act 89-89) is declarative of existing
        law and is not a new enactment);
            (D) The amount of any net operating loss deduction
        taken in arriving at taxable income, other than a net
        operating loss carried forward from a taxable year
        ending prior to December 31, 1986;
            (E) For taxable years in which a net operating loss
        carryback or carryforward from a taxable year ending
        prior to December 31, 1986 is an element of taxable
        income under paragraph (1) of subsection (e) or
        subparagraph (E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (e),
        the amount by which addition modifications other than
        those provided by this subparagraph (E) exceeded
        subtraction modifications in such earlier taxable
        year, with the following limitations applied in the
        order that they are listed:
                (i) the addition modification relating to the
            net operating loss carried back or forward to the
            taxable year from any taxable year ending prior to
            December 31, 1986 shall be reduced by the amount of
            addition modification under this subparagraph (E)
            which related to that net operating loss and which
            was taken into account in calculating the base
            income of an earlier taxable year, and
                (ii) the addition modification relating to the
            net operating loss carried back or forward to the
            taxable year from any taxable year ending prior to
            December 31, 1986 shall not exceed the amount of
            such carryback or carryforward;
            For taxable years in which there is a net operating
        loss carryback or carryforward from more than one other
        taxable year ending prior to December 31, 1986, the
        addition modification provided in this subparagraph
        (E) shall be the sum of the amounts computed
        independently under the preceding provisions of this
        subparagraph (E) for each such taxable year;
            (E-5) For taxable years ending after December 31,
        1997, an amount equal to any eligible remediation costs
        that the corporation deducted in computing adjusted
        gross income and for which the corporation claims a
        credit under subsection (l) of Section 201;
            (E-10) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an
        amount equal to the bonus depreciation deduction taken
        on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the
        taxable year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the
        Internal Revenue Code; and
            (E-11) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons,
        or otherwise disposes of property for which the
        taxpayer was required in any taxable year to make an
        addition modification under subparagraph (E-10), then
        an amount equal to the aggregate amount of the
        deductions taken in all taxable years under
        subparagraph (T) with respect to that property.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction
        modification under subparagraph (T), then an amount
        equal to that subtraction modification.
            The taxpayer is required to make the addition
        modification under this subparagraph only once with
        respect to any one piece of property;
            (E-12) An amount equal to the amount otherwise
        allowed as a deduction in computing base income for
        interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
        indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a
        member of the same unitary business group but for the
        fact the foreign person's business activity outside
        the United States is 80% or more of the foreign
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304. The addition modification
        required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the
        extent that dividends were included in base income of
        the unitary group for the same taxable year and
        received by the taxpayer or by a member of the
        taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts
        included in gross income pursuant to Sections 951
        through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts
        included in gross income under Section 78 of the
        Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock of the
        same person to whom the interest was paid, accrued, or
        incurred.
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such interest; or
                (ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a
            preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person, during the same
                taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                interest to a person that is not a related
                member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                interest expense between the taxpayer and the
                foreign person did not have as a principal
                purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax,
                and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement
                that reflects an arm's-length interest rate
                and terms; or
                (iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on
            clear and convincing evidence, that the interest
            paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or
            agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and
            terms and the principal purpose for the payment is
            not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
                (iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f).
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act;
            (E-13) An amount equal to the amount of intangible
        expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in
        computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a
        foreign person who would be a member of the same
        unitary business group but for the fact that the
        foreign person's business activity outside the United
        States is 80% or more of that person's total business
        activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of
        the same unitary business group but for the fact that
        the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27)
        from being included in the unitary business group
        because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion
        business income under different subsections of Section
        304. The addition modification required by this
        subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that
        dividends were included in base income of the unitary
        group for the same taxable year and received by the
        taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary
        business group (including amounts included in gross
        income pursuant to Sections 951 through 964 of the
        Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in gross
        income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code)
        with respect to the stock of the same person to whom
        the intangible expenses and costs were directly or
        indirectly paid, incurred, or accrued. The preceding
        sentence shall not apply to the extent that the same
        dividends caused a reduction to the addition
        modification required under Section 203(b)(2)(E-12) of
        this Act. As used in this subparagraph, the term
        "intangible expenses and costs" includes (1) expenses,
        losses, and costs for, or related to, the direct or
        indirect acquisition, use, maintenance or management,
        ownership, sale, exchange, or any other disposition of
        intangible property; (2) losses incurred, directly or
        indirectly, from factoring transactions or discounting
        transactions; (3) royalty, patent, technical, and
        copyright fees; (4) licensing fees; and (5) other
        similar expenses and costs. For purposes of this
        subparagraph, "intangible property" includes patents,
        patent applications, trade names, trademarks, service
        marks, copyrights, mask works, trade secrets, and
        similar types of intangible assets.
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) any item of intangible expenses or costs
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such item; or
                (ii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based
            on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person during the same
                taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                intangible expense or cost to a person that is
                not a related member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                intangible expense or cost between the
                taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as
                a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois
                income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract
                or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms;
                or
                (iii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence, that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f);
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act;
            (E-14) For taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of
        insurance premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed
        as a deduction in computing base income, and that were
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        a person who would be a member of the same unitary
        business group but for the fact that the person is
        prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being
        included in the unitary business group because he or
        she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304. The
        addition modification required by this subparagraph
        shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were
        included in base income of the unitary group for the
        same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group
        (including amounts included in gross income under
        Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code
        and amounts included in gross income under Section 78
        of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock
        of the same person to whom the premiums intangible
        expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid,
        incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not
        apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a
        reduction to the addition modification required under
        Section 203(b)(2)(E-12) or Section 203(b)(2)(E-13)
        203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act;
            (E-15) For taxable years beginning after December
        31, 2008, any deduction for dividends paid to a
        corporation by a captive real estate investment trust
        that is allowed to a real estate investment trust under
        Section 857(b)(2)(B) of the Internal Revenue Code for
        dividends paid;
    and by deducting from the total so obtained the sum of the
    following amounts:
            (F) An amount equal to the amount of any tax
        imposed by this Act which was refunded to the taxpayer
        and included in such total for the taxable year;
            (G) An amount equal to any amount included in such
        total under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code;
            (H) In the case of a regulated investment company,
        an amount equal to the amount of exempt interest
        dividends as defined in subsection (b) (5) of Section
        852 of the Internal Revenue Code, paid to shareholders
        for the taxable year;
            (I) With the exception of any amounts subtracted
        under subparagraph (J), an amount equal to the sum of
        all amounts disallowed as deductions by (i) Sections
        171(a) (2), and 265(a)(2) and amounts disallowed as
        interest expense by Section 291(a)(3) of the Internal
        Revenue Code, as now or hereafter amended, and all
        amounts of expenses allocable to interest and
        disallowed as deductions by Section 265(a)(1) of the
        Internal Revenue Code, as now or hereafter amended; and
        (ii) for taxable years ending on or after August 13,
        1999, Sections 171(a)(2), 265, 280C, 291(a)(3), and
        832(b)(5)(B)(i) of the Internal Revenue Code; the
        provisions of this subparagraph are exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (J) An amount equal to all amounts included in such
        total which are exempt from taxation by this State
        either by reason of its statutes or Constitution or by
        reason of the Constitution, treaties or statutes of the
        United States; provided that, in the case of any
        statute of this State or, for taxable years ending on
        or after December 31, 2008, of the United States, any
        treaty of the United States, the Illinois
        Constitution, or the United States Constitution that
        exempts income derived from bonds or other obligations
        from the tax imposed under this Act, the amount
        exempted shall be the interest income net of bond
        premium amortization, and, for taxable years ending on
        or after December 31, 2008, interest expense incurred
        on indebtedness to carry the bond or other obligation,
        expenses incurred in producing the income to be
        deducted, and all other related expenses. The amount of
        expenses to be taken into account under this provision
        may not exceed the amount of income that is exempted;
            (K) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total which were paid by a corporation which
        conducts business operations in an Enterprise Zone or
        zones created under the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or
        a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones created under
        the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act and conducts
        substantially all of its operations in an Enterprise
        Zone or zones or a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or
        zones. This subparagraph (K) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (L) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total that were paid by a corporation that
        conducts business operations in a federally designated
        Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated a
        High Impact Business located in Illinois; provided
        that dividends eligible for the deduction provided in
        subparagraph (K) of paragraph 2 of this subsection
        shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under
        this subparagraph (L);
            (M) For any taxpayer that is a financial
        organization within the meaning of Section 304(c) of
        this Act, an amount included in such total as interest
        income from a loan or loans made by such taxpayer to a
        borrower, to the extent that such a loan is secured by
        property which is eligible for the Enterprise Zone
        Investment Credit or the River Edge Redevelopment Zone
        Investment Credit. To determine the portion of a loan
        or loans that is secured by property eligible for a
        Section 201(f) investment credit to the borrower, the
        entire principal amount of the loan or loans between
        the taxpayer and the borrower should be divided into
        the basis of the Section 201(f) investment credit
        property which secures the loan or loans, using for
        this purpose the original basis of such property on the
        date that it was placed in service in the Enterprise
        Zone or the River Edge Redevelopment Zone. The
        subtraction modification available to taxpayer in any
        year under this subsection shall be that portion of the
        total interest paid by the borrower with respect to
        such loan attributable to the eligible property as
        calculated under the previous sentence. This
        subparagraph (M) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (M-1) For any taxpayer that is a financial
        organization within the meaning of Section 304(c) of
        this Act, an amount included in such total as interest
        income from a loan or loans made by such taxpayer to a
        borrower, to the extent that such a loan is secured by
        property which is eligible for the High Impact Business
        Investment Credit. To determine the portion of a loan
        or loans that is secured by property eligible for a
        Section 201(h) investment credit to the borrower, the
        entire principal amount of the loan or loans between
        the taxpayer and the borrower should be divided into
        the basis of the Section 201(h) investment credit
        property which secures the loan or loans, using for
        this purpose the original basis of such property on the
        date that it was placed in service in a federally
        designated Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone located in
        Illinois. No taxpayer that is eligible for the
        deduction provided in subparagraph (M) of paragraph
        (2) of this subsection shall be eligible for the
        deduction provided under this subparagraph (M-1). The
        subtraction modification available to taxpayers in any
        year under this subsection shall be that portion of the
        total interest paid by the borrower with respect to
        such loan attributable to the eligible property as
        calculated under the previous sentence;
            (N) Two times any contribution made during the
        taxable year to a designated zone organization to the
        extent that the contribution (i) qualifies as a
        charitable contribution under subsection (c) of
        Section 170 of the Internal Revenue Code and (ii) must,
        by its terms, be used for a project approved by the
        Department of Commerce and Economic Opportunity under
        Section 11 of the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or under
        Section 10-10 of the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act.
        This subparagraph (N) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (O) An amount equal to: (i) 85% for taxable years
        ending on or before December 31, 1992, or, a percentage
        equal to the percentage allowable under Section
        243(a)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 for
        taxable years ending after December 31, 1992, of the
        amount by which dividends included in taxable income
        and received from a corporation that is not created or
        organized under the laws of the United States or any
        state or political subdivision thereof, including, for
        taxable years ending on or after December 31, 1988,
        dividends received or deemed received or paid or deemed
        paid under Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal
        Revenue Code, exceed the amount of the modification
        provided under subparagraph (G) of paragraph (2) of
        this subsection (b) which is related to such dividends,
        and including, for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, dividends received from a captive
        real estate investment trust; plus (ii) 100% of the
        amount by which dividends, included in taxable income
        and received, including, for taxable years ending on or
        after December 31, 1988, dividends received or deemed
        received or paid or deemed paid under Sections 951
        through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and including,
        for taxable years ending on or after December 31, 2008,
        dividends received from a captive real estate
        investment trust, from any such corporation specified
        in clause (i) that would but for the provisions of
        Section 1504 (b) (3) of the Internal Revenue Code be
        treated as a member of the affiliated group which
        includes the dividend recipient, exceed the amount of
        the modification provided under subparagraph (G) of
        paragraph (2) of this subsection (b) which is related
        to such dividends. This subparagraph (O) is exempt from
        the provisions of Section 250 of this Act;
            (P) An amount equal to any contribution made to a
        job training project established pursuant to the Tax
        Increment Allocation Redevelopment Act;
            (Q) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction
        used to compute the federal income tax credit for
        restoration of substantial amounts held under claim of
        right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of
        the Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
            (R) On and after July 20, 1999, in the case of an
        attorney-in-fact with respect to whom an interinsurer
        or a reciprocal insurer has made the election under
        Section 835 of the Internal Revenue Code, 26 U.S.C.
        835, an amount equal to the excess, if any, of the
        amounts paid or incurred by that interinsurer or
        reciprocal insurer in the taxable year to the
        attorney-in-fact over the deduction allowed to that
        interinsurer or reciprocal insurer with respect to the
        attorney-in-fact under Section 835(b) of the Internal
        Revenue Code for the taxable year; the provisions of
        this subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (S) For taxable years ending on or after December
        31, 1997, in the case of a Subchapter S corporation, an
        amount equal to all amounts of income allocable to a
        shareholder subject to the Personal Property Tax
        Replacement Income Tax imposed by subsections (c) and
        (d) of Section 201 of this Act, including amounts
        allocable to organizations exempt from federal income
        tax by reason of Section 501(a) of the Internal Revenue
        Code. This subparagraph (S) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (T) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the
        taxable year in which the bonus depreciation deduction
        is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return
        under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal
        Revenue Code and for each applicable taxable year
        thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
                (1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation
            deduction taken for the taxable year on the
            taxpayer's federal income tax return on property
            for which the bonus depreciation deduction was
            taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section
            168 of the Internal Revenue Code, but not including
            the bonus depreciation deduction;
                (2) for taxable years ending on or before
            December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30
            and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
            0.429); and
                (3) for taxable years ending after December
            31, 2005:
                    (i) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                30 and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
                0.429); and
                    (ii) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                1.0.
            The aggregate amount deducted under this
        subparagraph in all taxable years for any one piece of
        property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
        depreciation deduction taken on that property on the
        taxpayer's federal income tax return under subsection
        (k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This
        subparagraph (T) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (U) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, or
        otherwise disposes of property for which the taxpayer
        was required in any taxable year to make an addition
        modification under subparagraph (E-10), then an amount
        equal to that addition modification.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was required in any taxable year to make an addition
        modification under subparagraph (E-10), then an amount
        equal to that addition modification.
            The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under
        this subparagraph only once with respect to any one
        piece of property.
            This subparagraph (U) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (V) The amount of: (i) any interest income (net of
        the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account
        for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with
        a taxpayer that is required to make an addition
        modification with respect to such transaction under
        Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12),
        203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed
        the amount of such addition modification, and (ii) any
        income from intangible property (net of the deductions
        allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable
        year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that
        is required to make an addition modification with
        respect to such transaction under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or
        203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of such
        addition modification, and (iii) any insurance premium
        income (net of deductions allocable thereto) taken
        into account for the taxable year with respect to a
        transaction with a taxpayer that is required to make an
        addition modification with respect to such transaction
        under Section 203(a)(2)(D-19), Section
        203(b)(2)(E-14), Section 203(c)(2)(G-14), or Section
        203(d)(2)(D-9), but not to exceed the amount of that
        addition modification. This subparagraph (V) is exempt
        from the provisions of Section 250;
            (W) An amount equal to the interest income taken
        into account for the taxable year (net of the
        deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(b)(2)(E-12) for
        interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
        indirectly, to the same person. This subparagraph (W)
        is exempt from the provisions of Section 250; and
            (X) An amount equal to the income from intangible
        property taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(b)(2)(E-13) for
        intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign
        person . This subparagraph (X) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250. ; and
             (FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance
        premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with a person who would be a member of the
        same unitary business group but for the fact that the
        person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from
        being included in the unitary business group because he
        or she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304, but
        not to exceed the addition modification required to be
        made for the same taxable year under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        the same person.
        (3) Special rule. For purposes of paragraph (2) (A),
    "gross income" in the case of a life insurance company, for
    tax years ending on and after December 31, 1994, shall mean
    the gross investment income for the taxable year.
 
    (c) Trusts and estates.
        (1) In general. In the case of a trust or estate, base
    income means an amount equal to the taxpayer's taxable
    income for the taxable year as modified by paragraph (2).
        (2) Modifications. Subject to the provisions of
    paragraph (3), the taxable income referred to in paragraph
    (1) shall be modified by adding thereto the sum of the
    following amounts:
            (A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued
        to the taxpayer as interest or dividends during the
        taxable year to the extent excluded from gross income
        in the computation of taxable income;
            (B) In the case of (i) an estate, $600; (ii) a
        trust which, under its governing instrument, is
        required to distribute all of its income currently,
        $300; and (iii) any other trust, $100, but in each such
        case, only to the extent such amount was deducted in
        the computation of taxable income;
            (C) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by
        this Act to the extent deducted from gross income in
        the computation of taxable income for the taxable year;
            (D) The amount of any net operating loss deduction
        taken in arriving at taxable income, other than a net
        operating loss carried forward from a taxable year
        ending prior to December 31, 1986;
            (E) For taxable years in which a net operating loss
        carryback or carryforward from a taxable year ending
        prior to December 31, 1986 is an element of taxable
        income under paragraph (1) of subsection (e) or
        subparagraph (E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (e),
        the amount by which addition modifications other than
        those provided by this subparagraph (E) exceeded
        subtraction modifications in such taxable year, with
        the following limitations applied in the order that
        they are listed:
                (i) the addition modification relating to the
            net operating loss carried back or forward to the
            taxable year from any taxable year ending prior to
            December 31, 1986 shall be reduced by the amount of
            addition modification under this subparagraph (E)
            which related to that net operating loss and which
            was taken into account in calculating the base
            income of an earlier taxable year, and
                (ii) the addition modification relating to the
            net operating loss carried back or forward to the
            taxable year from any taxable year ending prior to
            December 31, 1986 shall not exceed the amount of
            such carryback or carryforward;
            For taxable years in which there is a net operating
        loss carryback or carryforward from more than one other
        taxable year ending prior to December 31, 1986, the
        addition modification provided in this subparagraph
        (E) shall be the sum of the amounts computed
        independently under the preceding provisions of this
        subparagraph (E) for each such taxable year;
            (F) For taxable years ending on or after January 1,
        1989, an amount equal to the tax deducted pursuant to
        Section 164 of the Internal Revenue Code if the trust
        or estate is claiming the same tax for purposes of the
        Illinois foreign tax credit under Section 601 of this
        Act;
            (G) An amount equal to the amount of the capital
        gain deduction allowable under the Internal Revenue
        Code, to the extent deducted from gross income in the
        computation of taxable income;
            (G-5) For taxable years ending after December 31,
        1997, an amount equal to any eligible remediation costs
        that the trust or estate deducted in computing adjusted
        gross income and for which the trust or estate claims a
        credit under subsection (l) of Section 201;
            (G-10) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an
        amount equal to the bonus depreciation deduction taken
        on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the
        taxable year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the
        Internal Revenue Code; and
            (G-11) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons,
        or otherwise disposes of property for which the
        taxpayer was required in any taxable year to make an
        addition modification under subparagraph (G-10), then
        an amount equal to the aggregate amount of the
        deductions taken in all taxable years under
        subparagraph (R) with respect to that property.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction
        modification under subparagraph (R), then an amount
        equal to that subtraction modification.
            The taxpayer is required to make the addition
        modification under this subparagraph only once with
        respect to any one piece of property;
            (G-12) An amount equal to the amount otherwise
        allowed as a deduction in computing base income for
        interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
        indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a
        member of the same unitary business group but for the
        fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of the foreign
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304. The addition modification
        required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the
        extent that dividends were included in base income of
        the unitary group for the same taxable year and
        received by the taxpayer or by a member of the
        taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts
        included in gross income pursuant to Sections 951
        through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts
        included in gross income under Section 78 of the
        Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock of the
        same person to whom the interest was paid, accrued, or
        incurred.
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such interest; or
                (ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a
            preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person, during the same
                taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                interest to a person that is not a related
                member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                interest expense between the taxpayer and the
                foreign person did not have as a principal
                purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax,
                and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement
                that reflects an arm's-length interest rate
                and terms; or
                (iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on
            clear and convincing evidence, that the interest
            paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or
            agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and
            terms and the principal purpose for the payment is
            not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
                (iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f).
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act;
            (G-13) An amount equal to the amount of intangible
        expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in
        computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a
        foreign person who would be a member of the same
        unitary business group but for the fact that the
        foreign person's business activity outside the United
        States is 80% or more of that person's total business
        activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of
        the same unitary business group but for the fact that
        the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27)
        from being included in the unitary business group
        because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion
        business income under different subsections of Section
        304. The addition modification required by this
        subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that
        dividends were included in base income of the unitary
        group for the same taxable year and received by the
        taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary
        business group (including amounts included in gross
        income pursuant to Sections 951 through 964 of the
        Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in gross
        income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code)
        with respect to the stock of the same person to whom
        the intangible expenses and costs were directly or
        indirectly paid, incurred, or accrued. The preceding
        sentence shall not apply to the extent that the same
        dividends caused a reduction to the addition
        modification required under Section 203(c)(2)(G-12) of
        this Act. As used in this subparagraph, the term
        "intangible expenses and costs" includes: (1)
        expenses, losses, and costs for or related to the
        direct or indirect acquisition, use, maintenance or
        management, ownership, sale, exchange, or any other
        disposition of intangible property; (2) losses
        incurred, directly or indirectly, from factoring
        transactions or discounting transactions; (3) royalty,
        patent, technical, and copyright fees; (4) licensing
        fees; and (5) other similar expenses and costs. For
        purposes of this subparagraph, "intangible property"
        includes patents, patent applications, trade names,
        trademarks, service marks, copyrights, mask works,
        trade secrets, and similar types of intangible assets.
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) any item of intangible expenses or costs
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such item; or
                (ii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based
            on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person during the same
                taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                intangible expense or cost to a person that is
                not a related member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                intangible expense or cost between the
                taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as
                a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois
                income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract
                or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms;
                or
                (iii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence, that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f);
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act;
            (G-14) For taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of
        insurance premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed
        as a deduction in computing base income, and that were
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        a person who would be a member of the same unitary
        business group but for the fact that the person is
        prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being
        included in the unitary business group because he or
        she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304. The
        addition modification required by this subparagraph
        shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were
        included in base income of the unitary group for the
        same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group
        (including amounts included in gross income under
        Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code
        and amounts included in gross income under Section 78
        of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock
        of the same person to whom the premiums intangible
        expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid,
        incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not
        apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a
        reduction to the addition modification required under
        Section 203(c)(2)(G-12) or Section 203(c)(2)(G-13)
        203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act.
    and by deducting from the total so obtained the sum of the
    following amounts:
            (H) An amount equal to all amounts included in such
        total pursuant to the provisions of Sections 402(a),
        402(c), 403(a), 403(b), 406(a), 407(a) and 408 of the
        Internal Revenue Code or included in such total as
        distributions under the provisions of any retirement
        or disability plan for employees of any governmental
        agency or unit, or retirement payments to retired
        partners, which payments are excluded in computing net
        earnings from self employment by Section 1402 of the
        Internal Revenue Code and regulations adopted pursuant
        thereto;
            (I) The valuation limitation amount;
            (J) An amount equal to the amount of any tax
        imposed by this Act which was refunded to the taxpayer
        and included in such total for the taxable year;
            (K) An amount equal to all amounts included in
        taxable income as modified by subparagraphs (A), (B),
        (C), (D), (E), (F) and (G) which are exempt from
        taxation by this State either by reason of its statutes
        or Constitution or by reason of the Constitution,
        treaties or statutes of the United States; provided
        that, in the case of any statute of this State or, for
        taxable years ending on or after December 31, 2008, of
        the United States, any treaty of the United States, the
        Illinois Constitution, or the United States
        Constitution that exempts income derived from bonds or
        other obligations from the tax imposed under this Act,
        the amount exempted shall be the interest income net of
        bond premium amortization, and, for taxable years
        ending on or after December 31, 2008, interest expense
        incurred on indebtedness to carry the bond or other
        obligation, expenses incurred in producing the income
        to be deducted, and all other related expenses. The
        amount of expenses to be taken into account under this
        provision may not exceed the amount of income that is
        exempted;
            (L) With the exception of any amounts subtracted
        under subparagraph (K), an amount equal to the sum of
        all amounts disallowed as deductions by (i) Sections
        171(a) (2) and 265(a)(2) of the Internal Revenue Code,
        as now or hereafter amended, and all amounts of
        expenses allocable to interest and disallowed as
        deductions by Section 265(1) of the Internal Revenue
        Code of 1954, as now or hereafter amended; and (ii) for
        taxable years ending on or after August 13, 1999,
        Sections 171(a)(2), 265, 280C, and 832(b)(5)(B)(i) of
        the Internal Revenue Code; the provisions of this
        subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of Section
        250;
            (M) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total which were paid by a corporation which
        conducts business operations in an Enterprise Zone or
        zones created under the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act or
        a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones created under
        the River Edge Redevelopment Zone Act and conducts
        substantially all of its operations in an Enterprise
        Zone or Zones or a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or
        zones. This subparagraph (M) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (N) An amount equal to any contribution made to a
        job training project established pursuant to the Tax
        Increment Allocation Redevelopment Act;
            (O) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total that were paid by a corporation that
        conducts business operations in a federally designated
        Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated a
        High Impact Business located in Illinois; provided
        that dividends eligible for the deduction provided in
        subparagraph (M) of paragraph (2) of this subsection
        shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under
        this subparagraph (O);
            (P) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction
        used to compute the federal income tax credit for
        restoration of substantial amounts held under claim of
        right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of
        the Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
            (Q) For taxable year 1999 and thereafter, an amount
        equal to the amount of any (i) distributions, to the
        extent includible in gross income for federal income
        tax purposes, made to the taxpayer because of his or
        her status as a victim of persecution for racial or
        religious reasons by Nazi Germany or any other Axis
        regime or as an heir of the victim and (ii) items of
        income, to the extent includible in gross income for
        federal income tax purposes, attributable to, derived
        from or in any way related to assets stolen from,
        hidden from, or otherwise lost to a victim of
        persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi
        Germany or any other Axis regime immediately prior to,
        during, and immediately after World War II, including,
        but not limited to, interest on the proceeds receivable
        as insurance under policies issued to a victim of
        persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi
        Germany or any other Axis regime by European insurance
        companies immediately prior to and during World War II;
        provided, however, this subtraction from federal
        adjusted gross income does not apply to assets acquired
        with such assets or with the proceeds from the sale of
        such assets; provided, further, this paragraph shall
        only apply to a taxpayer who was the first recipient of
        such assets after their recovery and who is a victim of
        persecution for racial or religious reasons by Nazi
        Germany or any other Axis regime or as an heir of the
        victim. The amount of and the eligibility for any
        public assistance, benefit, or similar entitlement is
        not affected by the inclusion of items (i) and (ii) of
        this paragraph in gross income for federal income tax
        purposes. This paragraph is exempt from the provisions
        of Section 250;
            (R) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the
        taxable year in which the bonus depreciation deduction
        is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return
        under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal
        Revenue Code and for each applicable taxable year
        thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
                (1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation
            deduction taken for the taxable year on the
            taxpayer's federal income tax return on property
            for which the bonus depreciation deduction was
            taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section
            168 of the Internal Revenue Code, but not including
            the bonus depreciation deduction;
                (2) for taxable years ending on or before
            December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30
            and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
            0.429); and
                (3) for taxable years ending after December
            31, 2005:
                    (i) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                30 and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
                0.429); and
                    (ii) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                1.0.
            The aggregate amount deducted under this
        subparagraph in all taxable years for any one piece of
        property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
        depreciation deduction taken on that property on the
        taxpayer's federal income tax return under subsection
        (k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This
        subparagraph (R) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (S) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, or
        otherwise disposes of property for which the taxpayer
        was required in any taxable year to make an addition
        modification under subparagraph (G-10), then an amount
        equal to that addition modification.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was required in any taxable year to make an addition
        modification under subparagraph (G-10), then an amount
        equal to that addition modification.
            The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under
        this subparagraph only once with respect to any one
        piece of property.
            This subparagraph (S) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (T) The amount of (i) any interest income (net of
        the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account
        for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with
        a taxpayer that is required to make an addition
        modification with respect to such transaction under
        Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12),
        203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed
        the amount of such addition modification and (ii) any
        income from intangible property (net of the deductions
        allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable
        year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that
        is required to make an addition modification with
        respect to such transaction under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or
        203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of such
        addition modification. This subparagraph (T) is exempt
        from the provisions of Section 250;
            (U) An amount equal to the interest income taken
        into account for the taxable year (net of the
        deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(c)(2)(G-12) for
        interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
        indirectly, to the same person. This subparagraph (U)
        is exempt from the provisions of Section 250; and
            (V) An amount equal to the income from intangible
        property taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(c)(2)(G-13) for
        intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign
        person. This subparagraph (V) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250. ; and
             (FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance
        premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with a person who would be a member of the
        same unitary business group but for the fact that the
        person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from
        being included in the unitary business group because he
        or she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304, but
        not to exceed the addition modification required to be
        made for the same taxable year under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        the same person.
        (3) Limitation. The amount of any modification
    otherwise required under this subsection shall, under
    regulations prescribed by the Department, be adjusted by
    any amounts included therein which were properly paid,
    credited, or required to be distributed, or permanently set
    aside for charitable purposes pursuant to Internal Revenue
    Code Section 642(c) during the taxable year.
 
    (d) Partnerships.
        (1) In general. In the case of a partnership, base
    income means an amount equal to the taxpayer's taxable
    income for the taxable year as modified by paragraph (2).
        (2) Modifications. The taxable income referred to in
    paragraph (1) shall be modified by adding thereto the sum
    of the following amounts:
            (A) An amount equal to all amounts paid or accrued
        to the taxpayer as interest or dividends during the
        taxable year to the extent excluded from gross income
        in the computation of taxable income;
            (B) An amount equal to the amount of tax imposed by
        this Act to the extent deducted from gross income for
        the taxable year;
            (C) The amount of deductions allowed to the
        partnership pursuant to Section 707 (c) of the Internal
        Revenue Code in calculating its taxable income;
            (D) An amount equal to the amount of the capital
        gain deduction allowable under the Internal Revenue
        Code, to the extent deducted from gross income in the
        computation of taxable income;
            (D-5) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, an
        amount equal to the bonus depreciation deduction taken
        on the taxpayer's federal income tax return for the
        taxable year under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the
        Internal Revenue Code;
            (D-6) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons,
        or otherwise disposes of property for which the
        taxpayer was required in any taxable year to make an
        addition modification under subparagraph (D-5), then
        an amount equal to the aggregate amount of the
        deductions taken in all taxable years under
        subparagraph (O) with respect to that property.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was allowed in any taxable year to make a subtraction
        modification under subparagraph (O), then an amount
        equal to that subtraction modification.
            The taxpayer is required to make the addition
        modification under this subparagraph only once with
        respect to any one piece of property;
            (D-7) An amount equal to the amount otherwise
        allowed as a deduction in computing base income for
        interest paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
        indirectly, (i) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2004, to a foreign person who would be a
        member of the same unitary business group but for the
        fact the foreign person's business activity outside
        the United States is 80% or more of the foreign
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304. The addition modification
        required by this subparagraph shall be reduced to the
        extent that dividends were included in base income of
        the unitary group for the same taxable year and
        received by the taxpayer or by a member of the
        taxpayer's unitary business group (including amounts
        included in gross income pursuant to Sections 951
        through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code and amounts
        included in gross income under Section 78 of the
        Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock of the
        same person to whom the interest was paid, accrued, or
        incurred.
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such interest; or
                (ii) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer can establish, based on a
            preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person, during the same
                taxable year, paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                interest to a person that is not a related
                member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                interest expense between the taxpayer and the
                foreign person did not have as a principal
                purpose the avoidance of Illinois income tax,
                and is paid pursuant to a contract or agreement
                that reflects an arm's-length interest rate
                and terms; or
                (iii) the taxpayer can establish, based on
            clear and convincing evidence, that the interest
            paid, accrued, or incurred relates to a contract or
            agreement entered into at arm's-length rates and
            terms and the principal purpose for the payment is
            not federal or Illinois tax avoidance; or
                (iv) an item of interest paid, accrued, or
            incurred, directly or indirectly, to a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f).
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act; and
            (D-8) An amount equal to the amount of intangible
        expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a deduction in
        computing base income, and that were paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, (i) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2004, to a
        foreign person who would be a member of the same
        unitary business group but for the fact that the
        foreign person's business activity outside the United
        States is 80% or more of that person's total business
        activity and (ii) for taxable years ending on or after
        December 31, 2008, to a person who would be a member of
        the same unitary business group but for the fact that
        the person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27)
        from being included in the unitary business group
        because he or she is ordinarily required to apportion
        business income under different subsections of Section
        304. The addition modification required by this
        subparagraph shall be reduced to the extent that
        dividends were included in base income of the unitary
        group for the same taxable year and received by the
        taxpayer or by a member of the taxpayer's unitary
        business group (including amounts included in gross
        income pursuant to Sections 951 through 964 of the
        Internal Revenue Code and amounts included in gross
        income under Section 78 of the Internal Revenue Code)
        with respect to the stock of the same person to whom
        the intangible expenses and costs were directly or
        indirectly paid, incurred or accrued. The preceding
        sentence shall not apply to the extent that the same
        dividends caused a reduction to the addition
        modification required under Section 203(d)(2)(D-7) of
        this Act. As used in this subparagraph, the term
        "intangible expenses and costs" includes (1) expenses,
        losses, and costs for, or related to, the direct or
        indirect acquisition, use, maintenance or management,
        ownership, sale, exchange, or any other disposition of
        intangible property; (2) losses incurred, directly or
        indirectly, from factoring transactions or discounting
        transactions; (3) royalty, patent, technical, and
        copyright fees; (4) licensing fees; and (5) other
        similar expenses and costs. For purposes of this
        subparagraph, "intangible property" includes patents,
        patent applications, trade names, trademarks, service
        marks, copyrights, mask works, trade secrets, and
        similar types of intangible assets;
            This paragraph shall not apply to the following:
                (i) any item of intangible expenses or costs
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person who is subject in a foreign country or
            state, other than a state which requires mandatory
            unitary reporting, to a tax on or measured by net
            income with respect to such item; or
                (ii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, if the taxpayer can establish, based
            on a preponderance of the evidence, both of the
            following:
                    (a) the foreign person during the same
                taxable year paid, accrued, or incurred, the
                intangible expense or cost to a person that is
                not a related member, and
                    (b) the transaction giving rise to the
                intangible expense or cost between the
                taxpayer and the foreign person did not have as
                a principal purpose the avoidance of Illinois
                income tax, and is paid pursuant to a contract
                or agreement that reflects arm's-length terms;
                or
                (iii) any item of intangible expense or cost
            paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or
            indirectly, from a transaction with a foreign
            person if the taxpayer establishes by clear and
            convincing evidence, that the adjustments are
            unreasonable; or if the taxpayer and the Director
            agree in writing to the application or use of an
            alternative method of apportionment under Section
            304(f);
                Nothing in this subsection shall preclude the
            Director from making any other adjustment
            otherwise allowed under Section 404 of this Act for
            any tax year beginning after the effective date of
            this amendment provided such adjustment is made
            pursuant to regulation adopted by the Department
            and such regulations provide methods and standards
            by which the Department will utilize its authority
            under Section 404 of this Act;
            (D-9) For taxable years ending on or after December
        31, 2008, an amount equal to the amount of insurance
        premium expenses and costs otherwise allowed as a
        deduction in computing base income, and that were paid,
        accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to a
        person who would be a member of the same unitary
        business group but for the fact that the person is
        prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from being
        included in the unitary business group because he or
        she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304. The
        addition modification required by this subparagraph
        shall be reduced to the extent that dividends were
        included in base income of the unitary group for the
        same taxable year and received by the taxpayer or by a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group
        (including amounts included in gross income under
        Sections 951 through 964 of the Internal Revenue Code
        and amounts included in gross income under Section 78
        of the Internal Revenue Code) with respect to the stock
        of the same person to whom the premiums intangible
        expenses and costs were directly or indirectly paid,
        incurred, or accrued. The preceding sentence does not
        apply to the extent that the same dividends caused a
        reduction to the addition modification required under
        Section 203(d)(2)(D-7) or Section 203(d)(2)(D-8)
        203(a)(2)(D-17) of this Act.
    and by deducting from the total so obtained the following
    amounts:
            (E) The valuation limitation amount;
            (F) An amount equal to the amount of any tax
        imposed by this Act which was refunded to the taxpayer
        and included in such total for the taxable year;
            (G) An amount equal to all amounts included in
        taxable income as modified by subparagraphs (A), (B),
        (C) and (D) which are exempt from taxation by this
        State either by reason of its statutes or Constitution
        or by reason of the Constitution, treaties or statutes
        of the United States; provided that, in the case of any
        statute of this State or, for taxable years ending on
        or after December 31, 2008, of the United States, any
        treaty of the United States, the Illinois
        Constitution, or the United States Constitution that
        exempts income derived from bonds or other obligations
        from the tax imposed under this Act, the amount
        exempted shall be the interest income net of bond
        premium amortization, and, for taxable years ending on
        or after December 31, 2008, interest expense incurred
        on indebtedness to carry the bond or other obligation,
        expenses incurred in producing the income to be
        deducted, and all other related expenses. The amount of
        expenses to be taken into account under this provision
        may not exceed the amount of income that is exempted;
            (H) Any income of the partnership which
        constitutes personal service income as defined in
        Section 1348 (b) (1) of the Internal Revenue Code (as
        in effect December 31, 1981) or a reasonable allowance
        for compensation paid or accrued for services rendered
        by partners to the partnership, whichever is greater;
            (I) An amount equal to all amounts of income
        distributable to an entity subject to the Personal
        Property Tax Replacement Income Tax imposed by
        subsections (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this Act
        including amounts distributable to organizations
        exempt from federal income tax by reason of Section
        501(a) of the Internal Revenue Code;
            (J) With the exception of any amounts subtracted
        under subparagraph (G), an amount equal to the sum of
        all amounts disallowed as deductions by (i) Sections
        171(a) (2), and 265(2) of the Internal Revenue Code of
        1954, as now or hereafter amended, and all amounts of
        expenses allocable to interest and disallowed as
        deductions by Section 265(1) of the Internal Revenue
        Code, as now or hereafter amended; and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after August 13, 1999, Sections
        171(a)(2), 265, 280C, and 832(b)(5)(B)(i) of the
        Internal Revenue Code; the provisions of this
        subparagraph are exempt from the provisions of Section
        250;
            (K) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total which were paid by a corporation which
        conducts business operations in an Enterprise Zone or
        zones created under the Illinois Enterprise Zone Act,
        enacted by the 82nd General Assembly, or a River Edge
        Redevelopment Zone or zones created under the River
        Edge Redevelopment Zone Act and conducts substantially
        all of its operations in an Enterprise Zone or Zones or
        from a River Edge Redevelopment Zone or zones. This
        subparagraph (K) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (L) An amount equal to any contribution made to a
        job training project established pursuant to the Real
        Property Tax Increment Allocation Redevelopment Act;
            (M) An amount equal to those dividends included in
        such total that were paid by a corporation that
        conducts business operations in a federally designated
        Foreign Trade Zone or Sub-Zone and that is designated a
        High Impact Business located in Illinois; provided
        that dividends eligible for the deduction provided in
        subparagraph (K) of paragraph (2) of this subsection
        shall not be eligible for the deduction provided under
        this subparagraph (M);
            (N) An amount equal to the amount of the deduction
        used to compute the federal income tax credit for
        restoration of substantial amounts held under claim of
        right for the taxable year pursuant to Section 1341 of
        the Internal Revenue Code of 1986;
            (O) For taxable years 2001 and thereafter, for the
        taxable year in which the bonus depreciation deduction
        is taken on the taxpayer's federal income tax return
        under subsection (k) of Section 168 of the Internal
        Revenue Code and for each applicable taxable year
        thereafter, an amount equal to "x", where:
                (1) "y" equals the amount of the depreciation
            deduction taken for the taxable year on the
            taxpayer's federal income tax return on property
            for which the bonus depreciation deduction was
            taken in any year under subsection (k) of Section
            168 of the Internal Revenue Code, but not including
            the bonus depreciation deduction;
                (2) for taxable years ending on or before
            December 31, 2005, "x" equals "y" multiplied by 30
            and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
            0.429); and
                (3) for taxable years ending after December
            31, 2005:
                    (i) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 30% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                30 and then divided by 70 (or "y" multiplied by
                0.429); and
                    (ii) for property on which a bonus
                depreciation deduction of 50% of the adjusted
                basis was taken, "x" equals "y" multiplied by
                1.0.
            The aggregate amount deducted under this
        subparagraph in all taxable years for any one piece of
        property may not exceed the amount of the bonus
        depreciation deduction taken on that property on the
        taxpayer's federal income tax return under subsection
        (k) of Section 168 of the Internal Revenue Code. This
        subparagraph (O) is exempt from the provisions of
        Section 250;
            (P) If the taxpayer sells, transfers, abandons, or
        otherwise disposes of property for which the taxpayer
        was required in any taxable year to make an addition
        modification under subparagraph (D-5), then an amount
        equal to that addition modification.
            If the taxpayer continues to own property through
        the last day of the last tax year for which the
        taxpayer may claim a depreciation deduction for
        federal income tax purposes and for which the taxpayer
        was required in any taxable year to make an addition
        modification under subparagraph (D-5), then an amount
        equal to that addition modification.
            The taxpayer is allowed to take the deduction under
        this subparagraph only once with respect to any one
        piece of property.
            This subparagraph (P) is exempt from the
        provisions of Section 250;
            (Q) The amount of (i) any interest income (net of
        the deductions allocable thereto) taken into account
        for the taxable year with respect to a transaction with
        a taxpayer that is required to make an addition
        modification with respect to such transaction under
        Section 203(a)(2)(D-17), 203(b)(2)(E-12),
        203(c)(2)(G-12), or 203(d)(2)(D-7), but not to exceed
        the amount of such addition modification and (ii) any
        income from intangible property (net of the deductions
        allocable thereto) taken into account for the taxable
        year with respect to a transaction with a taxpayer that
        is required to make an addition modification with
        respect to such transaction under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18), 203(b)(2)(E-13), 203(c)(2)(G-13), or
        203(d)(2)(D-8), but not to exceed the amount of such
        addition modification. This subparagraph (Q) is exempt
        from Section 250;
            (R) An amount equal to the interest income taken
        into account for the taxable year (net of the
        deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(d)(2)(D-7) for interest
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        the same person. This subparagraph (R) is exempt from
        Section 250; and
            (S) An amount equal to the income from intangible
        property taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with (i) a foreign person who would be a
        member of the taxpayer's unitary business group but for
        the fact that the foreign person's business activity
        outside the United States is 80% or more of that
        person's total business activity and (ii) for taxable
        years ending on or after December 31, 2008, to a person
        who would be a member of the same unitary business
        group but for the fact that the person is prohibited
        under Section 1501(a)(27) from being included in the
        unitary business group because he or she is ordinarily
        required to apportion business income under different
        subsections of Section 304, but not to exceed the
        addition modification required to be made for the same
        taxable year under Section 203(d)(2)(D-8) for
        intangible expenses and costs paid, accrued, or
        incurred, directly or indirectly, to the same foreign
        person. This subparagraph (S) is exempt from Section
        250. ; and
             (FF) An amount equal to the income from insurance
        premiums taken into account for the taxable year (net
        of the deductions allocable thereto) with respect to
        transactions with a person who would be a member of the
        same unitary business group but for the fact that the
        person is prohibited under Section 1501(a)(27) from
        being included in the unitary business group because he
        or she is ordinarily required to apportion business
        income under different subsections of Section 304, but
        not to exceed the addition modification required to be
        made for the same taxable year under Section
        203(a)(2)(D-18) for intangible expenses and costs
        paid, accrued, or incurred, directly or indirectly, to
        the same person.
 
    (e) Gross income; adjusted gross income; taxable income.
        (1) In general. Subject to the provisions of paragraph
    (2) and subsection (b) (3), for purposes of this Section
    and Section 803(e), a taxpayer's gross income, adjusted
    gross income, or taxable income for the taxable year shall
    mean the amount of gross income, adjusted gross income or
    taxable income properly reportable for federal income tax
    purposes for the taxable year under the provisions of the
    Internal Revenue Code. Taxable income may be less than
    zero. However, for taxable years ending on or after
    December 31, 1986, net operating loss carryforwards from
    taxable years ending prior to December 31, 1986, may not
    exceed the sum of federal taxable income for the taxable
    year before net operating loss deduction, plus the excess
    of addition modifications over subtraction modifications
    for the taxable year. For taxable years ending prior to
    December 31, 1986, taxable income may never be an amount in
    excess of the net operating loss for the taxable year as
    defined in subsections (c) and (d) of Section 172 of the
    Internal Revenue Code, provided that when taxable income of
    a corporation (other than a Subchapter S corporation),
    trust, or estate is less than zero and addition
    modifications, other than those provided by subparagraph
    (E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (b) for corporations or
    subparagraph (E) of paragraph (2) of subsection (c) for
    trusts and estates, exceed subtraction modifications, an
    addition modification must be made under those
    subparagraphs for any other taxable year to which the
    taxable income less than zero (net operating loss) is
    applied under Section 172 of the Internal Revenue Code or
    under subparagraph (E) of paragraph (2) of this subsection
    (e) applied in conjunction with Section 172 of the Internal
    Revenue Code.
        (2) Special rule. For purposes of paragraph (1) of this
    subsection, the taxable income properly reportable for
    federal income tax purposes shall mean:
            (A) Certain life insurance companies. In the case
        of a life insurance company subject to the tax imposed
        by Section 801 of the Internal Revenue Code, life
        insurance company taxable income, plus the amount of
        distribution from pre-1984 policyholder surplus
        accounts as calculated under Section 815a of the
        Internal Revenue Code;
            (B) Certain other insurance companies. In the case
        of mutual insurance companies subject to the tax
        imposed by Section 831 of the Internal Revenue Code,
        insurance company taxable income;
            (C) Regulated investment companies. In the case of
        a regulated investment company subject to the tax
        imposed by Section 852 of the Internal Revenue Code,
        investment company taxable income;
            (D) Real estate investment trusts. In the case of a
        real estate investment trust subject to the tax imposed
        by Section 857 of the Internal Revenue Code, real
        estate investment trust taxable income;
            (E) Consolidated corporations. In the case of a
        corporation which is a member of an affiliated group of
        corporations filing a consolidated income tax return
        for the taxable year for federal income tax purposes,
        taxable income determined as if such corporation had
        filed a separate return for federal income tax purposes
        for the taxable year and each preceding taxable year
        for which it was a member of an affiliated group. For
        purposes of this subparagraph, the taxpayer's separate
        taxable income shall be determined as if the election
        provided by Section 243(b) (2) of the Internal Revenue
        Code had been in effect for all such years;
            (F) Cooperatives. In the case of a cooperative
        corporation or association, the taxable income of such
        organization determined in accordance with the
        provisions of Section 1381 through 1388 of the Internal
        Revenue Code;
            (G) Subchapter S corporations. In the case of: (i)
        a Subchapter S corporation for which there is in effect
        an election for the taxable year under Section 1362 of
        the Internal Revenue Code, the taxable income of such
        corporation determined in accordance with Section
        1363(b) of the Internal Revenue Code, except that
        taxable income shall take into account those items
        which are required by Section 1363(b)(1) of the
        Internal Revenue Code to be separately stated; and (ii)
        a Subchapter S corporation for which there is in effect
        a federal election to opt out of the provisions of the
        Subchapter S Revision Act of 1982 and have applied
        instead the prior federal Subchapter S rules as in
        effect on July 1, 1982, the taxable income of such
        corporation determined in accordance with the federal
        Subchapter S rules as in effect on July 1, 1982; and
            (H) Partnerships. In the case of a partnership,
        taxable income determined in accordance with Section
        703 of the Internal Revenue Code, except that taxable
        income shall take into account those items which are
        required by Section 703(a)(1) to be separately stated
        but which would be taken into account by an individual
        in calculating his taxable income.
        (3) Recapture of business expenses on disposition of
    asset or business. Notwithstanding any other law to the
    contrary, if in prior years income from an asset or
    business has been classified as business income and in a
    later year is demonstrated to be non-business income, then
    all expenses, without limitation, deducted in such later
    year and in the 2 immediately preceding taxable years
    related to that asset or business that generated the
    non-business income shall be added back and recaptured as
    business income in the year of the disposition of the asset
    or business. Such amount shall be apportioned to Illinois
    using the greater of the apportionment fraction computed
    for the business under Section 304 of this Act for the
    taxable year or the average of the apportionment fractions
    computed for the business under Section 304 of this Act for
    the taxable year and for the 2 immediately preceding
    taxable years.
    (f) Valuation limitation amount.
        (1) In general. The valuation limitation amount
    referred to in subsections (a) (2) (G), (c) (2) (I) and
    (d)(2) (E) is an amount equal to:
            (A) The sum of the pre-August 1, 1969 appreciation
        amounts (to the extent consisting of gain reportable
        under the provisions of Section 1245 or 1250 of the
        Internal Revenue Code) for all property in respect of
        which such gain was reported for the taxable year; plus
            (B) The lesser of (i) the sum of the pre-August 1,
        1969 appreciation amounts (to the extent consisting of
        capital gain) for all property in respect of which such
        gain was reported for federal income tax purposes for
        the taxable year, or (ii) the net capital gain for the
        taxable year, reduced in either case by any amount of
        such gain included in the amount determined under
        subsection (a) (2) (F) or (c) (2) (H).
        (2) Pre-August 1, 1969 appreciation amount.
            (A) If the fair market value of property referred
        to in paragraph (1) was readily ascertainable on August
        1, 1969, the pre-August 1, 1969 appreciation amount for
        such property is the lesser of (i) the excess of such
        fair market value over the taxpayer's basis (for
        determining gain) for such property on that date
        (determined under the Internal Revenue Code as in
        effect on that date), or (ii) the total gain realized
        and reportable for federal income tax purposes in
        respect of the sale, exchange or other disposition of
        such property.
            (B) If the fair market value of property referred
        to in paragraph (1) was not readily ascertainable on
        August 1, 1969, the pre-August 1, 1969 appreciation
        amount for such property is that amount which bears the
        same ratio to the total gain reported in respect of the
        property for federal income tax purposes for the
        taxable year, as the number of full calendar months in
        that part of the taxpayer's holding period for the
        property ending July 31, 1969 bears to the number of
        full calendar months in the taxpayer's entire holding
        period for the property.
            (C) The Department shall prescribe such
        regulations as may be necessary to carry out the
        purposes of this paragraph.
 
    (g) Double deductions. Unless specifically provided
otherwise, nothing in this Section shall permit the same item
to be deducted more than once.
 
    (h) Legislative intention. Except as expressly provided by
this Section there shall be no modifications or limitations on
the amounts of income, gain, loss or deduction taken into
account in determining gross income, adjusted gross income or
taxable income for federal income tax purposes for the taxable
year, or in the amount of such items entering into the
computation of base income and net income under this Act for
such taxable year, whether in respect of property values as of
August 1, 1969 or otherwise.
(Source: P.A. 94-776, eff. 5-19-06; 94-789, eff. 5-19-06;
94-1021, eff. 7-12-06; 94-1074, eff. 12-26-06; 95-23, eff.
8-3-07; 95-233, eff. 8-16-07; 95-286, eff. 8-20-07; 95-331,
eff. 8-21-07; revised 10-31-07.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/304)  (from Ch. 120, par. 3-304)
    Sec. 304. Business income of persons other than residents.
    (a) In general. The business income of a person other than
a resident shall be allocated to this State if such person's
business income is derived solely from this State. If a person
other than a resident derives business income from this State
and one or more other states, then, for tax years ending on or
before December 30, 1998, and except as otherwise provided by
this Section, such person's business income shall be
apportioned to this State by multiplying the income by a
fraction, the numerator of which is the sum of the property
factor (if any), the payroll factor (if any) and 200% of the
sales factor (if any), and the denominator of which is 4
reduced by the number of factors other than the sales factor
which have a denominator of zero and by an additional 2 if the
sales factor has a denominator of zero. For tax years ending on
or after December 31, 1998, and except as otherwise provided by
this Section, persons other than residents who derive business
income from this State and one or more other states shall
compute their apportionment factor by weighting their
property, payroll, and sales factors as provided in subsection
(h) of this Section.
    (1) Property factor.
        (A) The property factor is a fraction, the numerator of
    which is the average value of the person's real and
    tangible personal property owned or rented and used in the
    trade or business in this State during the taxable year and
    the denominator of which is the average value of all the
    person's real and tangible personal property owned or
    rented and used in the trade or business during the taxable
    year.
        (B) Property owned by the person is valued at its
    original cost. Property rented by the person is valued at 8
    times the net annual rental rate. Net annual rental rate is
    the annual rental rate paid by the person less any annual
    rental rate received by the person from sub-rentals.
        (C) The average value of property shall be determined
    by averaging the values at the beginning and ending of the
    taxable year but the Director may require the averaging of
    monthly values during the taxable year if reasonably
    required to reflect properly the average value of the
    person's property.
    (2) Payroll factor.
        (A) The payroll factor is a fraction, the numerator of
    which is the total amount paid in this State during the
    taxable year by the person for compensation, and the
    denominator of which is the total compensation paid
    everywhere during the taxable year.
        (B) Compensation is paid in this State if:
            (i) The individual's service is performed entirely
        within this State;
            (ii) The individual's service is performed both
        within and without this State, but the service
        performed without this State is incidental to the
        individual's service performed within this State; or
            (iii) Some of the service is performed within this
        State and either the base of operations, or if there is
        no base of operations, the place from which the service
        is directed or controlled is within this State, or the
        base of operations or the place from which the service
        is directed or controlled is not in any state in which
        some part of the service is performed, but the
        individual's residence is in this State.
            (iv) Compensation paid to nonresident professional
        athletes.
            (a) General. The Illinois source income of a
        nonresident individual who is a member of a
        professional athletic team includes the portion of the
        individual's total compensation for services performed
        as a member of a professional athletic team during the
        taxable year which the number of duty days spent within
        this State performing services for the team in any
        manner during the taxable year bears to the total
        number of duty days spent both within and without this
        State during the taxable year.
            (b) Travel days. Travel days that do not involve
        either a game, practice, team meeting, or other similar
        team event are not considered duty days spent in this
        State. However, such travel days are considered in the
        total duty days spent both within and without this
        State.
            (c) Definitions. For purposes of this subpart
        (iv):
                (1) The term "professional athletic team"
            includes, but is not limited to, any professional
            baseball, basketball, football, soccer, or hockey
            team.
                (2) The term "member of a professional
            athletic team" includes those employees who are
            active players, players on the disabled list, and
            any other persons required to travel and who travel
            with and perform services on behalf of a
            professional athletic team on a regular basis.
            This includes, but is not limited to, coaches,
            managers, and trainers.
                (3) Except as provided in items (C) and (D) of
            this subpart (3), the term "duty days" means all
            days during the taxable year from the beginning of
            the professional athletic team's official
            pre-season training period through the last game
            in which the team competes or is scheduled to
            compete. Duty days shall be counted for the year in
            which they occur, including where a team's
            official pre-season training period through the
            last game in which the team competes or is
            scheduled to compete, occurs during more than one
            tax year.
                    (A) Duty days shall also include days on
                which a member of a professional athletic team
                performs service for a team on a date that does
                not fall within the foregoing period (e.g.,
                participation in instructional leagues, the
                "All Star Game", or promotional "caravans").
                Performing a service for a professional
                athletic team includes conducting training and
                rehabilitation activities, when such
                activities are conducted at team facilities.
                    (B) Also included in duty days are game
                days, practice days, days spent at team
                meetings, promotional caravans, preseason
                training camps, and days served with the team
                through all post-season games in which the team
                competes or is scheduled to compete.
                    (C) Duty days for any person who joins a
                team during the period from the beginning of
                the professional athletic team's official
                pre-season training period through the last
                game in which the team competes, or is
                scheduled to compete, shall begin on the day
                that person joins the team. Conversely, duty
                days for any person who leaves a team during
                this period shall end on the day that person
                leaves the team. Where a person switches teams
                during a taxable year, a separate duty-day
                calculation shall be made for the period the
                person was with each team.
                    (D) Days for which a member of a
                professional athletic team is not compensated
                and is not performing services for the team in
                any manner, including days when such member of
                a professional athletic team has been
                suspended without pay and prohibited from
                performing any services for the team, shall not
                be treated as duty days.
                    (E) Days for which a member of a
                professional athletic team is on the disabled
                list and does not conduct rehabilitation
                activities at facilities of the team, and is
                not otherwise performing services for the team
                in Illinois, shall not be considered duty days
                spent in this State. All days on the disabled
                list, however, are considered to be included in
                total duty days spent both within and without
                this State.
                (4) The term "total compensation for services
            performed as a member of a professional athletic
            team" means the total compensation received during
            the taxable year for services performed:
                    (A) from the beginning of the official
                pre-season training period through the last
                game in which the team competes or is scheduled
                to compete during that taxable year; and
                    (B) during the taxable year on a date which
                does not fall within the foregoing period
                (e.g., participation in instructional leagues,
                the "All Star Game", or promotional caravans).
                This compensation shall include, but is not
            limited to, salaries, wages, bonuses as described
            in this subpart, and any other type of compensation
            paid during the taxable year to a member of a
            professional athletic team for services performed
            in that year. This compensation does not include
            strike benefits, severance pay, termination pay,
            contract or option year buy-out payments,
            expansion or relocation payments, or any other
            payments not related to services performed for the
            team.
                For purposes of this subparagraph, "bonuses"
            included in "total compensation for services
            performed as a member of a professional athletic
            team" subject to the allocation described in
            Section 302(c)(1) are: bonuses earned as a result
            of play (i.e., performance bonuses) during the
            season, including bonuses paid for championship,
            playoff or "bowl" games played by a team, or for
            selection to all-star league or other honorary
            positions; and bonuses paid for signing a
            contract, unless the payment of the signing bonus
            is not conditional upon the signee playing any
            games for the team or performing any subsequent
            services for the team or even making the team, the
            signing bonus is payable separately from the
            salary and any other compensation, and the signing
            bonus is nonrefundable.
    (3) Sales factor.
        (A) The sales factor is a fraction, the numerator of
    which is the total sales of the person in this State during
    the taxable year, and the denominator of which is the total
    sales of the person everywhere during the taxable year.
        (B) Sales of tangible personal property are in this
    State if:
            (i) The property is delivered or shipped to a
        purchaser, other than the United States government,
        within this State regardless of the f. o. b. point or
        other conditions of the sale; or
            (ii) The property is shipped from an office, store,
        warehouse, factory or other place of storage in this
        State and either the purchaser is the United States
        government or the person is not taxable in the state of
        the purchaser; provided, however, that premises owned
        or leased by a person who has independently contracted
        with the seller for the printing of newspapers,
        periodicals or books shall not be deemed to be an
        office, store, warehouse, factory or other place of
        storage for purposes of this Section. Sales of tangible
        personal property are not in this State if the seller
        and purchaser would be members of the same unitary
        business group but for the fact that either the seller
        or purchaser is a person with 80% or more of total
        business activity outside of the United States and the
        property is purchased for resale.
        (B-1) Patents, copyrights, trademarks, and similar
    items of intangible personal property.
            (i) Gross receipts from the licensing, sale, or
        other disposition of a patent, copyright, trademark,
        or similar item of intangible personal property are in
        this State to the extent the item is utilized in this
        State during the year the gross receipts are included
        in gross income.
            (ii) Place of utilization.
                (I) A patent is utilized in a state to the
            extent that it is employed in production,
            fabrication, manufacturing, or other processing in
            the state or to the extent that a patented product
            is produced in the state. If a patent is utilized
            in more than one state, the extent to which it is
            utilized in any one state shall be a fraction equal
            to the gross receipts of the licensee or purchaser
            from sales or leases of items produced,
            fabricated, manufactured, or processed within that
            state using the patent and of patented items
            produced within that state, divided by the total of
            such gross receipts for all states in which the
            patent is utilized.
                (II) A copyright is utilized in a state to the
            extent that printing or other publication
            originates in the state. If a copyright is utilized
            in more than one state, the extent to which it is
            utilized in any one state shall be a fraction equal
            to the gross receipts from sales or licenses of
            materials printed or published in that state
            divided by the total of such gross receipts for all
            states in which the copyright is utilized.
                (III) Trademarks and other items of intangible
            personal property governed by this paragraph (B-1)
            are utilized in the state in which the commercial
            domicile of the licensee or purchaser is located.
            (iii) If the state of utilization of an item of
        property governed by this paragraph (B-1) cannot be
        determined from the taxpayer's books and records or
        from the books and records of any person related to the
        taxpayer within the meaning of Section 267(b) of the
        Internal Revenue Code, 26 U.S.C. 267, the gross
        receipts attributable to that item shall be excluded
        from both the numerator and the denominator of the
        sales factor.
        (B-2) Gross receipts from the license, sale, or other
    disposition of patents, copyrights, trademarks, and
    similar items of intangible personal property may be
    included in the numerator or denominator of the sales
    factor only if gross receipts from licenses, sales, or
    other disposition of such items comprise more than 50% of
    the taxpayer's total gross receipts included in gross
    income during the tax year and during each of the 2
    immediately preceding tax years; provided that, when a
    taxpayer is a member of a unitary business group, such
    determination shall be made on the basis of the gross
    receipts of the entire unitary business group.
        (B-5) For taxable years ending on or after December 31,
    2008, except as provided in subsections (ii) through (vii),
    receipts from the sale of telecommunications service or
    mobile telecommunications service are in this State if the
    customer's service address is in this State.
            (i) For purposes of this subparagraph (B-5), the
        follow terms have the following meanings:
            "Ancillary services" means services that are
        associated with or incidental to the provision of
        "telecommunications services", including but not
        limited to "detailed telecommunications billing",
        "directory assistance", "vertical service", and "voice
        mail services".
            "Air-to-Ground Radiotelephone service" means a
        radio service, as that term is defined in 47 CFR 22.99,
        in which common carriers are authorized to offer and
        provide radio telecommunications service for hire to
        subscribers in aircraft.
            "Call-by-call Basis" means any method of charging
        for telecommunications services where the price is
        measured by individual calls.
            "Communications Channel" means a physical or
        virtual path of communications over which signals are
        transmitted between or among customer channel
        termination points.
            "Conference bridging service" means an "ancillary
        service" that links two or more participants of an
        audio or video conference call and may include the
        provision of a telephone number. "Conference bridging
        service" does not include the "telecommunications
        services" used to reach the conference bridge.
            "Customer Channel Termination Point" means the
        location where the customer either inputs or receives
        the communications.
            "Detailed telecommunications billing service"
        means an "ancillary service" of separately stating
        information pertaining to individual calls on a
        customer's billing statement.
            "Directory assistance" means an "ancillary
        service" of providing telephone number information,
        and/or address information.
            "Home service provider" means the facilities based
        carrier or reseller with which the customer contracts
        for the provision of mobile telecommunications
        services.
            "Mobile telecommunications service" means
        commercial mobile radio service, as defined in Section
        20.3 of Title 47 of the Code of Federal Regulations as
        in effect on June 1, 1999.
            "Place of primary use" means the street address
        representative of where the customer's use of the
        telecommunications service primarily occurs, which
        must be the residential street address or the primary
        business street address of the customer. In the case of
        mobile telecommunications services, "place of primary
        use" must be within the licensed service area of the
        home service provider.
            "Post-paid telecommunication service" means the
        telecommunications service obtained by making a
        payment on a call-by-call basis either through the use
        of a credit card or payment mechanism such as a bank
        card, travel card, credit card, or debit card, or by
        charge made to a telephone number which is not
        associated with the origination or termination of the
        telecommunications service. A post-paid calling
        service includes telecommunications service, except a
        prepaid wireless calling service, that would be a
        prepaid calling service except it is not exclusively a
        telecommunication service.
            "Prepaid telecommunication service" means the
        right to access exclusively telecommunications
        services, which must be paid for in advance and which
        enables the origination of calls using an access number
        or authorization code, whether manually or
        electronically dialed, and that is sold in
        predetermined units or dollars of which the number
        declines with use in a known amount.
            "Prepaid Mobile telecommunication service" means a
        telecommunications service that provides the right to
        utilize mobile wireless service as well as other
        non-telecommunication services, including but not
        limited to ancillary services, which must be paid for
        in advance that is sold in predetermined units or
        dollars of which the number declines with use in a
        known amount.
            "Private communication service" means a
        telecommunication service that entitles the customer
        to exclusive or priority use of a communications
        channel or group of channels between or among
        termination points, regardless of the manner in which
        such channel or channels are connected, and includes
        switching capacity, extension lines, stations, and any
        other associated services that are provided in
        connection with the use of such channel or channels.
            "Service address" means:
                (a) The location of the telecommunications
            equipment to which a customer's call is charged and
            from which the call originates or terminates,
            regardless of where the call is billed or paid;
                (b) If the location in line (a) is not known,
            service address means the origination point of the
            signal of the telecommunications services first
            identified by either the seller's
            telecommunications system or in information
            received by the seller from its service provider
            where the system used to transport such signals is
            not that of the seller; and
                (c) If the locations in line (a) and line (b)
            are not known, the service address means the
            location of the customer's place of primary use.
            "Telecommunications service" means the electronic
        transmission, conveyance, or routing of voice, data,
        audio, video, or any other information or signals to a
        point, or between or among points. The term
        "telecommunications service" includes such
        transmission, conveyance, or routing in which computer
        processing applications are used to act on the form,
        code or protocol of the content for purposes of
        transmission, conveyance or routing without regard to
        whether such service is referred to as voice over
        Internet protocol services or is classified by the
        Federal Communications Commission as enhanced or value
        added. "Telecommunications service" does not include:
                (a) Data processing and information services
            that allow data to be generated, acquired, stored,
            processed, or retrieved and delivered by an
            electronic transmission to a purchaser when such
            purchaser's primary purpose for the underlying
            transaction is the processed data or information;
                (b) Installation or maintenance of wiring or
            equipment on a customer's premises;
                (c) Tangible personal property;
                (d) Advertising, including but not limited to
            directory advertising.
                (e) Billing and collection services provided
            to third parties;
                (f) Internet access service;
                (g) Radio and television audio and video
            programming services, regardless of the medium,
            including the furnishing of transmission,
            conveyance and routing of such services by the
            programming service provider. Radio and television
            audio and video programming services shall include
            but not be limited to cable service as defined in
            47 USC 522(6) and audio and video programming
            services delivered by commercial mobile radio
            service providers, as defined in 47 CFR 20.3;
                (h) "Ancillary services"; or
                (i) Digital products "delivered
            electronically", including but not limited to
            software, music, video, reading materials or ring
            tones.
            "Vertical service" means an "ancillary service"
        that is offered in connection with one or more
        "telecommunications services", which offers advanced
        calling features that allow customers to identify
        callers and to manage multiple calls and call
        connections, including "conference bridging services".
            "Voice mail service" means an "ancillary service"
        that enables the customer to store, send or receive
        recorded messages. "Voice mail service" does not
        include any "vertical services" that the customer may
        be required to have in order to utilize the "voice mail
        service".
            (ii) Receipts from the sale of telecommunications
        service sold on an individual call-by-call basis are in
        this State if either of the following applies:
                (a) The call both originates and terminates in
            this State.
                (b) The call either originates or terminates
            in this State and the service address is located in
            this State.
            (iii) Receipts from the sale of postpaid
        telecommunications service at retail are in this State
        if the origination point of the telecommunication
        signal, as first identified by the service provider's
        telecommunication system or as identified by
        information received by the seller from its service
        provider if the system used to transport
        telecommunication signals is not the seller's, is
        located in this State.
            (iv) Receipts from the sale of prepaid
        telecommunications service or prepaid mobile
        telecommunications service at retail are in this State
        if the purchaser obtains the prepaid card or similar
        means of conveyance at a location in this State.
        Receipts from recharging a prepaid telecommunications
        service or mobile telecommunications service is in
        this State if the purchaser's billing information
        indicates a location in this State.
            (v) Receipts from the sale of private
        communication services are in this State as follows:
                (a) 100% of receipts from charges imposed at
            each channel termination point in this State.
                (b) 100% of receipts from charges for the total
            channel mileage between each channel termination
            point in this State.
                (c) 50% of the total receipts from charges for
            service segments when those segments are between 2
            customer channel termination points, 1 of which is
            located in this State and the other is located
            outside of this State, which segments are
            separately charged.
                (d) The receipts from charges for service
            segments with a channel termination point located
            in this State and in two or more other states, and
            which segments are not separately billed, are in
            this State based on a percentage determined by
            dividing the number of customer channel
            termination points in this State by the total
            number of customer channel termination points.
            (vi) Receipts from charges for ancillary services
        for telecommunications service sold to customers at
        retail are in this State if the customer's primary
        place of use of telecommunications services associated
        with those ancillary services is in this State. If the
        seller of those ancillary services cannot determine
        where the associated telecommunications are located,
        then the ancillary services shall be based on the
        location of the purchaser.
            (vii) Receipts to access a carrier's network or
        from the sale of telecommunication services or
        ancillary services for resale are in this State as
        follows:
                (a) 100% of the receipts from access fees
            attributable to intrastate telecommunications
            service that both originates and terminates in
            this State.
                (b) 50% of the receipts from access fees
            attributable to interstate telecommunications
            service if the interstate call either originates
            or terminates in this State.
                (c) 100% of the receipts from interstate end
            user access line charges, if the customer's
            service address is in this State. As used in this
            subdivision, "interstate end user access line
            charges" includes, but is not limited to, the
            surcharge approved by the federal communications
            commission and levied pursuant to 47 CFR 69.
                (d) Gross receipts from sales of
            telecommunication services or from ancillary
            services for telecommunications services sold to
            other telecommunication service providers for
            resale shall be sourced to this State using the
            apportionment concepts used for non-resale
            receipts of telecommunications services if the
            information is readily available to make that
            determination. If the information is not readily
            available, then the taxpayer may use any other
            reasonable and consistent method.
        (C) For taxable years ending before December 31, 2008,
    sales, other than sales governed by paragraphs (B), (B-1),
    and (B-2), are in this State if:
            (i) The income-producing activity is performed in
        this State; or
            (ii) The income-producing activity is performed
        both within and without this State and a greater
        proportion of the income-producing activity is
        performed within this State than without this State,
        based on performance costs.
        (C-5) For taxable years ending on or after December 31,
    2008, sales, other than sales governed by paragraphs (B),
    (B-1), and (B-2), and (B-5), are in this State if any of
    the following criteria are met the purchaser is in this
    State or the sale is otherwise attributable to this State's
    marketplace. The following examples are illustrative:
            (i) Sales from the sale or lease of real property
        are in this State if the property is located in this
        State.
            (ii) Sales from the lease or rental of tangible
        personal property are in this State if the property is
        located in this State during the rental period. Sales
        from the lease or rental of tangible personal property
        that is characteristically moving property, including,
        but not limited to, motor vehicles, rolling stock,
        aircraft, vessels, or mobile equipment are in this
        State to the extent that the property is used in this
        State.
            (iii) In the case of interest, net gains (but not
        less than zero) and other items of income from
        intangible personal property, the sale is in this State
        if:
                (a) in the case of a taxpayer who is a dealer
            in the item of intangible personal property within
            the meaning of Section 475 of the Internal Revenue
            Code, the income or gain is received from a
            customer in this State. For purposes of this
            subparagraph, a customer is in this State if the
            customer is an individual, trust or estate who is a
            resident of this State and, for all other
            customers, if the customer's commercial domicile
            is in this State. Unless the dealer has actual
            knowledge of the residence or commercial domicile
            of a customer during a taxable year, the customer
            shall be deemed to be a customer in this State if
            the billing address of the customer, as shown in
            the records of the dealer, is in this State; or
                (b) in all other cases, if the
            income-producing activity of the taxpayer is
            performed in this State or, if the
            income-producing activity of the taxpayer is
            performed both within and without this State, if a
            greater proportion of the income-producing
            activity of the taxpayer is performed within this
            State than in any other state, based on performance
            costs. Sales of intangible personal property are
            in this State if the purchaser realizes benefit
            from the property in this State. If the purchaser
            realizes benefit from the property both within and
            without this State, the gross receipts from the
            sale shall be divided among those states in which
            the taxpayer is taxable in proportion to the
            benefit in each state. If the proportionate
            benefit in this State cannot be determined, the
            sale shall be excluded from both the numerator and
            the denominator of the sales factor.
            (iv) Sales of services are in this State if the
        services are received in this State. For the purposes
        of this section, gross receipts from the performance of
        services provided to a corporation, partnership, or
        trust may only be attributed to a state where that
        corporation, partnership, or trust has a fixed place of
        business. If the state where the services are received
        is not readily determinable or is a state where the
        corporation, partnership, or trust receiving the
        service does not have a fixed place of business, the
        services shall be deemed to be received at the location
        of the office of the customer from which the services
        were ordered in the regular course of the customer's
        trade or business. If the ordering office cannot be
        determined, the services shall be deemed to be received
        at the office of the customer to which the services are
        billed. If the taxpayer is not taxable in the state in
        which the services are received, the sale must be
        excluded from both the numerator and the denominator of
        the sales factor. the benefit of the service is
        realized in this State. If the benefit of the service
        is realized both within and without this State, the
        gross receipts from the sale shall be divided among
        those states in which the taxpayer is taxable in
        proportion to the benefit of service realized in each
        state. If the proportionate benefit in this State
        cannot be determined, the sale shall be excluded from
        both the numerator and the denominator of the sales
        factor. The Department shall may adopt rules
        prescribing where the benefit of specific types of
        service are received, including, but not limited to,
        telecommunications, broadcast, cable, advertising,
        publishing, and utility service, is realized.
        (D) For taxable years ending on or after December 31,
    1995, the following items of income shall not be included
    in the numerator or denominator of the sales factor:
    dividends; amounts included under Section 78 of the
    Internal Revenue Code; and Subpart F income as defined in
    Section 952 of the Internal Revenue Code. No inference
    shall be drawn from the enactment of this paragraph (D) in
    construing this Section for taxable years ending before
    December 31, 1995.
        (E) Paragraphs (B-1) and (B-2) shall apply to tax years
    ending on or after December 31, 1999, provided that a
    taxpayer may elect to apply the provisions of these
    paragraphs to prior tax years. Such election shall be made
    in the form and manner prescribed by the Department, shall
    be irrevocable, and shall apply to all tax years; provided
    that, if a taxpayer's Illinois income tax liability for any
    tax year, as assessed under Section 903 prior to January 1,
    1999, was computed in a manner contrary to the provisions
    of paragraphs (B-1) or (B-2), no refund shall be payable to
    the taxpayer for that tax year to the extent such refund is
    the result of applying the provisions of paragraph (B-1) or
    (B-2) retroactively. In the case of a unitary business
    group, such election shall apply to all members of such
    group for every tax year such group is in existence, but
    shall not apply to any taxpayer for any period during which
    that taxpayer is not a member of such group.
    (b) Insurance companies.
        (1) In general. Except as otherwise provided by
    paragraph (2), business income of an insurance company for
    a taxable year shall be apportioned to this State by
    multiplying such income by a fraction, the numerator of
    which is the direct premiums written for insurance upon
    property or risk in this State, and the denominator of
    which is the direct premiums written for insurance upon
    property or risk everywhere. For purposes of this
    subsection, the term "direct premiums written" means the
    total amount of direct premiums written, assessments and
    annuity considerations as reported for the taxable year on
    the annual statement filed by the company with the Illinois
    Director of Insurance in the form approved by the National
    Convention of Insurance Commissioners or such other form as
    may be prescribed in lieu thereof.
        (2) Reinsurance. If the principal source of premiums
    written by an insurance company consists of premiums for
    reinsurance accepted by it, the business income of such
    company shall be apportioned to this State by multiplying
    such income by a fraction, the numerator of which is the
    sum of (i) direct premiums written for insurance upon
    property or risk in this State, plus (ii) premiums written
    for reinsurance accepted in respect of property or risk in
    this State, and the denominator of which is the sum of
    (iii) direct premiums written for insurance upon property
    or risk everywhere, plus (iv) premiums written for
    reinsurance accepted in respect of property or risk
    everywhere. For taxable years ending before December 31,
    2008, for purposes of this paragraph, premiums written for
    reinsurance accepted in respect of property or risk in this
    State, whether or not otherwise determinable, may, at the
    election of the company, be determined on the basis of the
    proportion which premiums written for reinsurance accepted
    from companies commercially domiciled in Illinois bears to
    premiums written for reinsurance accepted from all
    sources, or, alternatively, in the proportion which the sum
    of the direct premiums written for insurance upon property
    or risk in this State by each ceding company from which
    reinsurance is accepted bears to the sum of the total
    direct premiums written by each such ceding company for the
    taxable year.
    (c) Financial organizations.
        (1) In general. For taxable years ending before
    December 31, 2008, business income of a financial
    organization shall be apportioned to this State by
    multiplying such income by a fraction, the numerator of
    which is its business income from sources within this
    State, and the denominator of which is its business income
    from all sources. For the purposes of this subsection, the
    business income of a financial organization from sources
    within this State is the sum of the amounts referred to in
    subparagraphs (A) through (E) following, but excluding the
    adjusted income of an international banking facility as
    determined in paragraph (2):
            (A) Fees, commissions or other compensation for
        financial services rendered within this State;
            (B) Gross profits from trading in stocks, bonds or
        other securities managed within this State;
            (C) Dividends, and interest from Illinois
        customers, which are received within this State;
            (D) Interest charged to customers at places of
        business maintained within this State for carrying
        debit balances of margin accounts, without deduction
        of any costs incurred in carrying such accounts; and
            (E) Any other gross income resulting from the
        operation as a financial organization within this
        State. In computing the amounts referred to in
        paragraphs (A) through (E) of this subsection, any
        amount received by a member of an affiliated group
        (determined under Section 1504(a) of the Internal
        Revenue Code but without reference to whether any such
        corporation is an "includible corporation" under
        Section 1504(b) of the Internal Revenue Code) from
        another member of such group shall be included only to
        the extent such amount exceeds expenses of the
        recipient directly related thereto.
        (2) International Banking Facility. For taxable years
    ending before December 31, 2008:
            (A) Adjusted Income. The adjusted income of an
        international banking facility is its income reduced
        by the amount of the floor amount.
            (B) Floor Amount. The floor amount shall be the
        amount, if any, determined by multiplying the income of
        the international banking facility by a fraction, not
        greater than one, which is determined as follows:
                (i) The numerator shall be:
                The average aggregate, determined on a
            quarterly basis, of the financial organization's
            loans to banks in foreign countries, to foreign
            domiciled borrowers (except where secured
            primarily by real estate) and to foreign
            governments and other foreign official
            institutions, as reported for its branches,
            agencies and offices within the state on its
            "Consolidated Report of Condition", Schedule A,
            Lines 2.c., 5.b., and 7.a., which was filed with
            the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and
            other regulatory authorities, for the year 1980,
            minus
                The average aggregate, determined on a
            quarterly basis, of such loans (other than loans of
            an international banking facility), as reported by
            the financial institution for its branches,
            agencies and offices within the state, on the
            corresponding Schedule and lines of the
            Consolidated Report of Condition for the current
            taxable year, provided, however, that in no case
            shall the amount determined in this clause (the
            subtrahend) exceed the amount determined in the
            preceding clause (the minuend); and
                (ii) the denominator shall be the average
            aggregate, determined on a quarterly basis, of the
            international banking facility's loans to banks in
            foreign countries, to foreign domiciled borrowers
            (except where secured primarily by real estate)
            and to foreign governments and other foreign
            official institutions, which were recorded in its
            financial accounts for the current taxable year.
            (C) Change to Consolidated Report of Condition and
        in Qualification. In the event the Consolidated Report
        of Condition which is filed with the Federal Deposit
        Insurance Corporation and other regulatory authorities
        is altered so that the information required for
        determining the floor amount is not found on Schedule
        A, lines 2.c., 5.b. and 7.a., the financial institution
        shall notify the Department and the Department may, by
        regulations or otherwise, prescribe or authorize the
        use of an alternative source for such information. The
        financial institution shall also notify the Department
        should its international banking facility fail to
        qualify as such, in whole or in part, or should there
        be any amendment or change to the Consolidated Report
        of Condition, as originally filed, to the extent such
        amendment or change alters the information used in
        determining the floor amount.
        (3) For taxable years ending on or after December 31,
    2008, the business income of a financial organization shall
    be apportioned to this State by multiplying such income by
    a fraction, the numerator of which is its gross receipts
    from sources in this State or otherwise attributable to
    this State's marketplace and the denominator of which is
    its gross receipts everywhere during the taxable year.
    "Gross receipts" for purposes of this subparagraph (3)
    means gross income, including net taxable gain on
    disposition of assets, including securities and money
    market instruments, when derived from transactions and
    activities in the regular course of the financial
    organization's trade or business. If a person derives
    business income from activities in addition to the
    provision of financial services, this subparagraph (3)
    shall apply only to its business income from financial
    services, and its other business income shall be
    apportioned to this State under the applicable provisions
    of this Section. The following examples are illustrative:
            (i) Receipts from the lease or rental of real or
        tangible personal property are in this State if the
        property is located in this State during the rental
        period. Receipts from the lease or rental of tangible
        personal property that is characteristically moving
        property, including, but not limited to, motor
        vehicles, rolling stock, aircraft, vessels, or mobile
        equipment are from sources in this State to the extent
        that the property is used in this State.
            (ii) Interest income, commissions, fees, gains on
        disposition, and other receipts from assets in the
        nature of loans that are secured primarily by real
        estate or tangible personal property are from sources
        in this State if the security is located in this State.
            (iii) Interest income, commissions, fees, gains on
        disposition, and other receipts from consumer loans
        that are not secured by real or tangible personal
        property are from sources in this State if the debtor
        is a resident of this State.
            (iv) Interest income, commissions, fees, gains on
        disposition, and other receipts from commercial loans
        and installment obligations that are not secured by
        real or tangible personal property are from sources in
        this State if the proceeds of the loan are to be
        applied in this State. If it cannot be determined where
        the funds are to be applied, the income and receipts
        are from sources in this State if the office of the
        borrower from which the loan was negotiated in the
        regular course of business is located in this State. If
        the location of this office cannot be determined, the
        income and receipts shall be excluded from the
        numerator and denominator of the sales factor.
            (v) Interest income, fees, gains on disposition,
        service charges, merchant discount income, and other
        receipts from credit card receivables are from sources
        in this State if the card charges are regularly billed
        to a customer in this State.
            (vi) Receipts from the performance of services,
        including, but not limited to, fiduciary, advisory,
        and brokerage services, are in this State if the
        services are received in this State within the meaning
        of subparagraph (a)(3)(C-5)(iv) of this Section. the
        benefit of the service is realized in this State. If
        the benefit of the service is realized both within and
        without this State, the gross receipts from the sale
        shall be divided among those states in which the
        taxpayer is taxable in proportion to the benefit of
        service realized in each state. If the proportionate
        benefit in this State cannot be determined, the sale
        shall be excluded from both the numerator and the
        denominator of the gross receipts factor.
            (vii) Receipts from the issuance of travelers
        checks and money orders are from sources in this State
        if the checks and money orders are issued from a
        location within this State.
            (viii) Receipts from investment assets and
        activities and trading assets and activities are
        included in the receipts factor as follows:
                (1) Interest, dividends, net gains (but not
            less than zero) and other income from investment
            assets and activities from trading assets and
            activities shall be included in the receipts
            factor. Investment assets and activities and
            trading assets and activities include but are not
            limited to: investment securities; trading account
            assets; federal funds; securities purchased and
            sold under agreements to resell or repurchase;
            options; futures contracts; forward contracts;
            notional principal contracts such as swaps;
            equities; and foreign currency transactions. With
            respect to the investment and trading assets and
            activities described in subparagraphs (A) and (B)
            of this paragraph, the receipts factor shall
            include the amounts described in such
            subparagraphs.
                    (A) The receipts factor shall include the
                amount by which interest from federal funds
                sold and securities purchased under resale
                agreements exceeds interest expense on federal
                funds purchased and securities sold under
                repurchase agreements.
                    (B) The receipts factor shall include the
                amount by which interest, dividends, gains and
                other income from trading assets and
                activities, including but not limited to
                assets and activities in the matched book, in
                the arbitrage book, and foreign currency
                transactions, exceed amounts paid in lieu of
                interest, amounts paid in lieu of dividends,
                and losses from such assets and activities.
                (2) The numerator of the receipts factor
            includes interest, dividends, net gains (but not
            less than zero), and other income from investment
            assets and activities and from trading assets and
            activities described in paragraph (1) of this
            subsection that are attributable to this State.
                    (A) The amount of interest, dividends, net
                gains (but not less than zero), and other
                income from investment assets and activities
                in the investment account to be attributed to
                this State and included in the numerator is
                determined by multiplying all such income from
                such assets and activities by a fraction, the
                numerator of which is the gross income from
                such assets and activities which are properly
                assigned to a fixed place of business of the
                taxpayer within this State and the denominator
                of which is the gross income from all such
                assets and activities.
                    (B) The amount of interest from federal
                funds sold and purchased and from securities
                purchased under resale agreements and
                securities sold under repurchase agreements
                attributable to this State and included in the
                numerator is determined by multiplying the
                amount described in subparagraph (A) of
                paragraph (1) of this subsection from such
                funds and such securities by a fraction, the
                numerator of which is the gross income from
                such funds and such securities which are
                properly assigned to a fixed place of business
                of the taxpayer within this State and the
                denominator of which is the gross income from
                all such funds and such securities.
                    (C) The amount of interest, dividends,
                gains, and other income from trading assets and
                activities, including but not limited to
                assets and activities in the matched book, in
                the arbitrage book and foreign currency
                transactions (but excluding amounts described
                in subparagraphs (A) or (B) of this paragraph),
                attributable to this State and included in the
                numerator is determined by multiplying the
                amount described in subparagraph (B) of
                paragraph (1) of this subsection by a fraction,
                the numerator of which is the gross income from
                such trading assets and activities which are
                properly assigned to a fixed place of business
                of the taxpayer within this State and the
                denominator of which is the gross income from
                all such assets and activities.
                    (D) Properly assigned, for purposes of
                this paragraph (2) of this subsection, means
                the investment or trading asset or activity is
                assigned to the fixed place of business with
                which it has a preponderance of substantive
                contacts. An investment or trading asset or
                activity assigned by the taxpayer to a fixed
                place of business without the State shall be
                presumed to have been properly assigned if:
                        (i) the taxpayer has assigned, in the
                    regular course of its business, such asset
                    or activity on its records to a fixed place
                    of business consistent with federal or
                    state regulatory requirements;
                        (ii) such assignment on its records is
                    based upon substantive contacts of the
                    asset or activity to such fixed place of
                    business; and
                        (iii) the taxpayer uses such records
                    reflecting assignment of such assets or
                    activities for the filing of all state and
                    local tax returns for which an assignment
                    of such assets or activities to a fixed
                    place of business is required.
                    (E) The presumption of proper assignment
                of an investment or trading asset or activity
                provided in subparagraph (D) of paragraph (2)
                of this subsection may be rebutted upon a
                showing by the Department, supported by a
                preponderance of the evidence, that the
                preponderance of substantive contacts
                regarding such asset or activity did not occur
                at the fixed place of business to which it was
                assigned on the taxpayer's records. If the
                fixed place of business that has a
                preponderance of substantive contacts cannot
                be determined for an investment or trading
                asset or activity to which the presumption in
                subparagraph (D) of paragraph (2) of this
                subsection does not apply or with respect to
                which that presumption has been rebutted, that
                asset or activity is properly assigned to the
                state in which the taxpayer's commercial
                domicile is located. For purposes of this
                subparagraph (E), it shall be presumed,
                subject to rebuttal, that taxpayer's
                commercial domicile is in the state of the
                United States or the District of Columbia to
                which the greatest number of employees are
                regularly connected with the management of the
                investment or trading income or out of which
                they are working, irrespective of where the
                services of such employees are performed, as of
                the last day of the taxable year. In the case
                of a financial organization that accepts
                deposits, receipts from investments and from
                money market instruments are apportioned to
                this State based on the ratio that the total
                deposits of the financial organization
                (including all members of the financial
                organization's unitary group) from this State,
                its residents, (including businesses with an
                office or other place of business in this
                State), and its political subdivisions,
                agencies, and instrumentalities bear to total
                deposits everywhere. For purposes of this
                subdivision, deposits must be attributed to
                this State under the preceding sentence,
                whether or not the deposits are accepted or
                maintained by the financial organization at
                locations within this State. In the case of a
                financial organization that does not accept
                deposits, receipts from investments in
                securities and from money market instruments
                shall be excluded from the numerator and the
                denominator of the gross receipts factor.
        (4) (Blank). As used in subparagraph (3), "deposit"
    includes but is not limited to:
            (i) the unpaid balance of money or its equivalent
        received or held by a financial institution in the
        usual course of business and for which it has given or
        is obligated to give credit, either conditionally or
        unconditionally, to a commercial, checking, savings,
        time, or thrift account whether or not advance notice
        is required to withdraw the credited funds, or which is
        evidenced by its certificate of deposit, thrift
        certificate, investment certificate, or certificate of
        indebtedness, or other similar name, or a check or
        draft drawn against a deposit account and certified by
        the financial organization, or a letter of credit or a
        traveler's check on which the financial organization
        is primarily liable. However, without limiting the
        generality of the term "money or its equivalent", any
        such account or instrument must be regarded as
        evidencing the receipt of the equivalent of money when
        credited or issued in exchange for checks or drafts or
        for a promissory note upon which the person obtaining
        the credit or instrument is primarily or secondarily
        liable, or for a charge against a deposit account, or
        in settlement of checks, drafts, or other instruments
        forwarded to the bank for collection;
            (ii) trust funds received or held by the financial
        organization, whether held in the trust department or
        held or deposited in any other department of the
        financial organization;
            (iii) money received or held by a financial
        organization, or the credit given for money or its
        equivalent received or held by a financial
        organization, in the usual course of business for a
        special or specific purpose, regardless of the legal
        relationship so established. Under this paragraph,
        "deposit" includes, but is not limited to, escrow
        funds, funds held as security for an obligation due to
        the financial organization or others, including funds
        held as dealers reserves, or for securities loaned by
        the financial organization, funds deposited by a
        debtor to meet maturing obligations, funds deposited
        as advance payment on subscriptions to United States
        government securities, funds held for distribution or
        purchase of securities, funds held to meet its
        acceptances or letters of credit, and withheld taxes.
        It does not include funds received by the financial
        organization for immediate application to the
        reduction of an indebtedness to the receiving
        financial organization, or under condition that the
        receipt of the funds immediately reduces or
        extinguishes the indebtedness;
            (iv) outstanding drafts, including advice of
        another financial organization, cashier's checks,
        money orders, or other officer's checks issued in the
        usual course of business for any purpose, but not
        including those issued in payment for services,
        dividends, or purchases or other costs or expenses of
        the financial organization itself; and
            (v) money or its equivalent held as a credit
        balance by a financial organization on behalf of its
        customer if the entity is engaged in soliciting and
        holding such balances in the regular course of its
        business.
        (5) (Blank). As used in subparagraph (3), "money market
    instruments" includes but is not limited to:
            (i) Interest-bearing deposits, federal funds sold
        and securities purchased under agreements to resell,
        commercial paper, banker's acceptances, and purchased
        certificates of deposit and similar instruments to the
        extent that the instruments are reflected as assets
        under generally accepted accounting principles.
            "Securities" means corporate stock, bonds, and
        other securities (including, for purposes of taxation
        of gains on securities and for purchases under
        agreements to resell, United States Treasury
        securities, obligations of United States government
        agencies and corporations, obligations of state and
        political subdivisions, the interest on which is
        exempt from Illinois income tax), participations in
        securities backed by mortgages held by United States or
        state government agencies, loan-backed securities, and
        similar investments to the extent the investments are
        reflected as assets under generally accepted
        accounting principles.
            (ii) For purposes of subparagraph (3), "money
        market instruments" shall include investments in
        investment partnerships, trusts, pools, funds,
        investment companies, or any similar entity in
        proportion to the investment of the entity in money
        market instruments, and "securities" shall include
        investments in investment partnerships, trusts, pools,
        funds, investment companies, or any similar entity in
        proportion to the investment of the entity in
        securities.
    (d) Transportation services. For taxable years ending
before December 31, 2008, business income derived from
furnishing transportation services shall be apportioned to
this State in accordance with paragraphs (1) and (2):
        (1) Such business income (other than that derived from
    transportation by pipeline) shall be apportioned to this
    State by multiplying such income by a fraction, the
    numerator of which is the revenue miles of the person in
    this State, and the denominator of which is the revenue
    miles of the person everywhere. For purposes of this
    paragraph, a revenue mile is the transportation of 1
    passenger or 1 net ton of freight the distance of 1 mile
    for a consideration. Where a person is engaged in the
    transportation of both passengers and freight, the
    fraction above referred to shall be determined by means of
    an average of the passenger revenue mile fraction and the
    freight revenue mile fraction, weighted to reflect the
    person's
            (A) relative railway operating income from total
        passenger and total freight service, as reported to the
        Interstate Commerce Commission, in the case of
        transportation by railroad, and
            (B) relative gross receipts from passenger and
        freight transportation, in case of transportation
        other than by railroad.
        (2) Such business income derived from transportation
    by pipeline shall be apportioned to this State by
    multiplying such income by a fraction, the numerator of
    which is the revenue miles of the person in this State, and
    the denominator of which is the revenue miles of the person
    everywhere. For the purposes of this paragraph, a revenue
    mile is the transportation by pipeline of 1 barrel of oil,
    1,000 cubic feet of gas, or of any specified quantity of
    any other substance, the distance of 1 mile for a
    consideration.
        (3) For taxable years ending on or after December 31,
    2008, business income derived from providing
    transportation services other than airline services shall
    be apportioned to this State by using a fraction, (a) the
    numerator of which shall be (i) all receipts from any
    movement or shipment of people, goods, mail, oil, gas, or
    any other substance (other than by airline) that both
    originates and terminates in this State, plus (ii) that
    portion of the person's gross receipts from movements or
    shipments of people, goods, mail, oil, gas, or any other
    substance (other than by airline) that originates in one
    state or jurisdiction and terminates in another state or
    jurisdiction passing through, into, or out of this State,
    that is determined by the ratio that the miles traveled in
    this State bears to total miles everywhere from point of
    origin to point of destination and (b) the denominator of
    which shall be all revenue derived from the movement or
    shipment of people, goods, mail, oil, gas, or any other
    substance (other than by airline). Where a taxpayer is
    engaged in the transportation of both passengers and
    freight, the fraction above referred to shall first be
    determined separately for passenger miles and freight
    miles. Then an average of the passenger miles fraction and
    the freight miles fraction shall be weighted to reflect the
    taxpayer's:
            (A) relative railway operating income from total
        passenger and total freight service, as reported to the
        Surface Transportation Board, in the case of
        transportation by railroad; and
            (B) relative gross receipts from passenger and
        freight transportation, in case of transportation
        other than by railroad. If a person derives business
        income from activities in addition to the provision of
        transportation services (other than by airline), this
        subsection shall apply only to its business income from
        transportation services and its other business income
        shall be apportioned to this State according to the
        applicable provisions of this Section.
        (4) For taxable years ending on or after December 31,
    2008, business income derived from furnishing airline
    transportation services shall be apportioned to this State
    by multiplying such income by a fraction, the numerator of
    which is the revenue miles of the person in this State, and
    the denominator of which is the revenue miles of the person
    everywhere. For purposes of this paragraph, a revenue mile
    is the transportation of one passenger or one net ton of
    freight the distance of one mile for a consideration. If a
    person is engaged in the transportation of both passengers
    and freight, the fraction above referred to shall be
    determined by means of an average of the passenger revenue
    mile fraction and the freight revenue mile fraction,
    weighted to reflect the person's relative gross receipts
    from passenger and freight airline transportation. For
    taxable years ending on or after December 31, 2008,
    business income derived from providing airline services
    shall be apportioned to this State by using a fraction, (a)
    the numerator of which shall be arrivals of aircraft to and
    departures from this State weighted as to cost of aircraft
    by type and (b) the denominator of which shall be total
    arrivals and departures of aircraft weighted as to cost of
    aircraft by type. If a person derives business income from
    activities in addition to the provision of airline
    services, this subsection shall apply only to its business
    income from airline services and its other business income
    shall be apportioned to this State under the applicable
    provisions of this Section.
    (e) Combined apportionment. Where 2 or more persons are
engaged in a unitary business as described in subsection
(a)(27) of Section 1501, a part of which is conducted in this
State by one or more members of the group, the business income
attributable to this State by any such member or members shall
be apportioned by means of the combined apportionment method.
    (f) Alternative allocation. If the allocation and
apportionment provisions of subsections (a) through (e) and of
subsection (h) do not fairly represent the extent of a person's
business activity in this State, the person may petition for,
or the Director may, without a petition, permit or require, in
respect of all or any part of the person's business activity,
if reasonable:
        (1) Separate accounting;
        (2) The exclusion of any one or more factors;
        (3) The inclusion of one or more additional factors
    which will fairly represent the person's business
    activities in this State; or
        (4) The employment of any other method to effectuate an
    equitable allocation and apportionment of the person's
    business income.
    (g) Cross reference. For allocation of business income by
residents, see Section 301(a).
    (h) For tax years ending on or after December 31, 1998, the
apportionment factor of persons who apportion their business
income to this State under subsection (a) shall be equal to:
        (1) for tax years ending on or after December 31, 1998
    and before December 31, 1999, 16 2/3% of the property
    factor plus 16 2/3% of the payroll factor plus 66 2/3% of
    the sales factor;
        (2) for tax years ending on or after December 31, 1999
    and before December 31, 2000, 8 1/3% of the property factor
    plus 8 1/3% of the payroll factor plus 83 1/3% of the sales
    factor;
        (3) for tax years ending on or after December 31, 2000,
    the sales factor.
If, in any tax year ending on or after December 31, 1998 and
before December 31, 2000, the denominator of the payroll,
property, or sales factor is zero, the apportionment factor
computed in paragraph (1) or (2) of this subsection for that
year shall be divided by an amount equal to 100% minus the
percentage weight given to each factor whose denominator is
equal to zero.
(Source: P.A. 94-247, eff. 1-1-06; 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/704A)
    Sec. 704A. Employer's return and payment of tax withheld.
    (a) In general, every employer who deducts and withholds or
is required to deduct and withhold tax under this Act on or
after January 1, 2008 shall make those payments and returns as
provided in this Section.
    (b) Returns. Every employer shall, in the form and manner
required by the Department, make returns with respect to taxes
withheld or required to be withheld under this Article 7 for
each quarter beginning on or after January 1, 2008, on or
before the last day of the first month following the close of
that quarter.
    (c) Payments. With respect to amounts withheld or required
to be withheld on or after January 1, 2008:
        (1) Semi-weekly payments. For each calendar year, each
    employer who withheld or was required to withhold more than
    $12,000 during the one-year period ending on June 30 of the
    immediately preceding calendar year, payment must be made:
            (A) on or before each Friday of the calendar year,
        for taxes withheld or required to be withheld on the
        immediately preceding Saturday, Sunday, Monday, or
        Tuesday;
            (B) on or before each Wednesday of the calendar
        year, for taxes withheld or required to be withheld on
        the immediately preceding Wednesday, Thursday, or
        Friday.
        (2) Semi-weekly payments. Any employer who withholds
    or is required to withhold more than $12,000 in any quarter
    of a calendar year is required to make payments on the
    dates set forth under item (1) of this subsection (c) for
    each remaining quarter of that calendar year and for the
    subsequent calendar year.
        (3) Monthly payments. Each employer, other than an
    employer described in items (1) or (2) of this subsection,
    shall pay to the Department, on or before the 15th day of
    each month the taxes withheld or required to be withheld
    during the immediately preceding month.
        (4) Payments with returns. Each employer shall pay to
    the Department, on or before the due date for each return
    required to be filed under this Section, any tax withheld
    or required to be withheld during the period for which the
    return is due and not previously paid to the Department.
    (d) Regulatory authority. The Department may, by rule:
        (1) If the aggregate amounts required to be withheld
    under this Article 7 do not exceed $1,000 for the calendar
    year, permit employers, in lieu of the requirements of
    subsections (b) and (c), to file annual returns due on or
    before January 31 of the following year for taxes withheld
    or required to be withheld during that calendar year and to
    pay the taxes required to be shown on each such return no
    later than the due date for such return.
        (2) Provide that any payment required to be made under
    subsection (c)(1) or (c)(2) is deemed to be timely to the
    extent paid by electronic funds transfer on or before the
    due date for deposit of federal income taxes withheld from,
    or federal employment taxes due with respect to, the wages
    from which the Illinois taxes were withheld.
        (3) Designate one or more depositories to which payment
    of taxes required to be withheld under this Article 7 must
    be paid by some or all employers.
        (4) Increase the threshold dollar amounts at which
    employers are required to make semi-weekly payments under
    subsection (c)(1) or (c)(2).
    (e) Annual return and payment. Every employer who deducts
and withholds or is required to deduct and withhold tax from a
person engaged in domestic service employment, as that term is
defined in Section 3510 of the Internal Revenue Code, may
comply with the requirements of this Section with respect to
such employees by filing an annual return and paying the taxes
required to be deducted and withheld on or before the 15th day
of the fourth month following the close of the employer's
taxable year. The Department may allow the employer's return to
be submitted with the employer's individual income tax return
or to be submitted with a return due from the employer under
Section 1400.2 of the Unemployment Insurance Act.
    (f) Magnetic media and electronic filing. Any W-2 Form
that, under the Internal Revenue Code and regulations
promulgated thereunder, is required to be submitted to the
Internal Revenue Service on magnetic media or electronically
must also be submitted to the Department on magnetic media or
electronically for Illinois purposes, if required by the
Department.
(Source: P.A. 95-8, eff. 6-29-07.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/709.5)
    Sec. 709.5. Withholding by partnerships, Subchapter S
corporations, and trusts.
    (a) In general. For each taxable year ending on or after
December 31, 2008, every partnership (other than a publicly
traded partnership under Section 7704 of the Internal Revenue
Code or investment partnership), Subchapter S corporation, and
trust must withhold from each nonresident partner,
shareholder, or beneficiary (other than a partner,
shareholder, or beneficiary who is exempt from tax under
Section 501(a) of the Internal Revenue Code or under Section
205 of this Act or who is included on a composite return filed
by the partnership or Subchapter S corporation for the taxable
year under subsection (f) of Section 502 of this Act) an amount
equal to the distributable share of the business income of the
partnership, Subchapter S corporation, or trust apportionable
to Illinois of that partner, shareholder, or beneficiary under
Sections 702 and 704 and Subchapter S of the Internal Revenue
Code, whether or not distributed, multiplied by the applicable
rates of tax for that partner or shareholder under subsections
(a) through (d) of Section 201 of this Act.
    (b) Credit for taxes withheld. Any amount withheld under
subsection (a) of this Section and paid to the Department shall
be treated as a payment of the estimated tax liability or of
the liability for withholding under this Section of the
partner, shareholder, or beneficiary to whom the income is
distributable for the taxable year in which that person
incurred a liability under this Act with respect to that
income. The Department shall adopt rules pursuant to which a
partner, shareholder, or beneficiary may claim a credit against
its obligation for withholding under this Section for amounts
withheld under this Section with respect to income
distributable to it by a partnership, Subchapter S corporation,
or trust and allowing its partners, shareholders, or
beneficiaries to claim a credit under this subsection (b) for
those withheld amounts.
    (c) Exemption from withholding.
        (1) A partnership, Subchapter S corporation, or trust
    shall not be required to withhold tax under subsection (a)
    of this Section with respect to any nonresident partner,
    shareholder, or beneficiary (other than an individual)
    from whom the partnership, S corporation, or trust has
    received a certificate, completed in the form and manner
    prescribed by the Department, stating that such
    nonresident partner, shareholder, or beneficiary shall:
            (A) file all returns that the partner,
        shareholder, or beneficiary is required to file under
        Section 502 of this Act and make timely payment of all
        taxes imposed under Section 201 of this Act or under
        this Section on the partner, shareholder, or
        beneficiary with respect to income of the partnership,
        S corporation, or trust; and
            (B) be subject to personal jurisdiction in this
        State for purposes of the collection of income taxes,
        together with related interest and penalties, imposed
        on the partner, shareholder, or beneficiary with
        respect to the income of the partnership, S
        corporation, or trust.
        (2) The Department may revoke the exemption provided by
    this subsection (c) at any time that it determines that the
    nonresident partner, shareholder, or beneficiary is not
    abiding by the terms of the certificate. The Department
    shall notify the partnership, S corporation, or trust that
    it has revoked a certificate by notice left at the usual
    place of business of the partnership, S corporation, or
    trust or by mail to the last known address of the
    partnership, S corporation, or trust.
        (3) A partnership, S corporation, or trust that
    receives a certificate under this subsection (c) properly
    completed by a nonresident partner, shareholder, or
    beneficiary shall not be required to withhold any amount
    from that partner, shareholder, or beneficiary, the
    payment of which would be due under Section 711(a-5) of
    this Act after the receipt of the certificate and no
    earlier than 60 days after the Department has notified the
    partnership, S corporation, or trust that the certificate
    has been revoked.
        (4) Certificates received by a the partnership, S
    corporation, or trust under this subsection (c) must be
    retained by the partnership, S corporation, or trust and a
    record of such certificates must be provided to the
    Department, in a format in which the record is available
    for review by the Department, upon request by the
    Department. The Department may, by rule, require the record
    of certificates to be maintained and provided to the
    Department electronically.
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/901)  (from Ch. 120, par. 9-901)
    Sec. 901. Collection Authority.
    (a) In general.
    The Department shall collect the taxes imposed by this Act.
The Department shall collect certified past due child support
amounts under Section 2505-650 of the Department of Revenue Law
(20 ILCS 2505/2505-650). Except as provided in subsections (c)
and (e) of this Section, money collected pursuant to
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this Act shall be
paid into the General Revenue Fund in the State treasury; money
collected pursuant to subsections (c) and (d) of Section 201 of
this Act shall be paid into the Personal Property Tax
Replacement Fund, a special fund in the State Treasury; and
money collected under Section 2505-650 of the Department of
Revenue Law (20 ILCS 2505/2505-650) shall be paid into the
Child Support Enforcement Trust Fund, a special fund outside
the State Treasury, or to the State Disbursement Unit
established under Section 10-26 of the Illinois Public Aid
Code, as directed by the Department of Healthcare and Family
Services.
    (b) Local Governmental Distributive Fund.
    Beginning August 1, 1969, and continuing through June 30,
1994, the Treasurer shall transfer each month from the General
Revenue Fund to a special fund in the State treasury, to be
known as the "Local Government Distributive Fund", an amount
equal to 1/12 of the net revenue realized from the tax imposed
by subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this Act during
the preceding month. Beginning July 1, 1994, and continuing
through June 30, 1995, the Treasurer shall transfer each month
from the General Revenue Fund to the Local Government
Distributive Fund an amount equal to 1/11 of the net revenue
realized from the tax imposed by subsections (a) and (b) of
Section 201 of this Act during the preceding month. Beginning
July 1, 1995, the Treasurer shall transfer each month from the
General Revenue Fund to the Local Government Distributive Fund
an amount equal to the net of (i) 1/10 of the net revenue
realized from the tax imposed by subsections (a) and (b) of
Section 201 of the Illinois Income Tax Act during the preceding
month (ii) minus, beginning July 1, 2003 and ending June 30,
2004, $6,666,666, and beginning July 1, 2004, zero. Net revenue
realized for a month shall be defined as the revenue from the
tax imposed by subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this
Act which is deposited in the General Revenue Fund, the
Educational Assistance Fund and the Income Tax Surcharge Local
Government Distributive Fund during the month minus the amount
paid out of the General Revenue Fund in State warrants during
that same month as refunds to taxpayers for overpayment of
liability under the tax imposed by subsections (a) and (b) of
Section 201 of this Act.
    (c) Deposits Into Income Tax Refund Fund.
        (1) Beginning on January 1, 1989 and thereafter, the
    Department shall deposit a percentage of the amounts
    collected pursuant to subsections (a) and (b)(1), (2), and
    (3), of Section 201 of this Act into a fund in the State
    treasury known as the Income Tax Refund Fund. The
    Department shall deposit 6% of such amounts during the
    period beginning January 1, 1989 and ending on June 30,
    1989. Beginning with State fiscal year 1990 and for each
    fiscal year thereafter, the percentage deposited into the
    Income Tax Refund Fund during a fiscal year shall be the
    Annual Percentage. For fiscal years 1999 through 2001, the
    Annual Percentage shall be 7.1%. For fiscal year 2003, the
    Annual Percentage shall be 8%. For fiscal year 2004, the
    Annual Percentage shall be 11.7%. Upon the effective date
    of this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly, the
    Annual Percentage shall be 10% for fiscal year 2005. For
    fiscal year 2006, the Annual Percentage shall be 9.75%. For
    fiscal year 2007, the Annual Percentage shall be 9.75%. For
    fiscal year 2008, the Annual Percentage shall be 7.75%. For
    all other fiscal years, the Annual Percentage shall be
    calculated as a fraction, the numerator of which shall be
    the amount of refunds approved for payment by the
    Department during the preceding fiscal year as a result of
    overpayment of tax liability under subsections (a) and
    (b)(1), (2), and (3) of Section 201 of this Act plus the
    amount of such refunds remaining approved but unpaid at the
    end of the preceding fiscal year, minus the amounts
    transferred into the Income Tax Refund Fund from the
    Tobacco Settlement Recovery Fund, and the denominator of
    which shall be the amounts which will be collected pursuant
    to subsections (a) and (b)(1), (2), and (3) of Section 201
    of this Act during the preceding fiscal year; except that
    in State fiscal year 2002, the Annual Percentage shall in
    no event exceed 7.6%. The Director of Revenue shall certify
    the Annual Percentage to the Comptroller on the last
    business day of the fiscal year immediately preceding the
    fiscal year for which it is to be effective.
        (2) Beginning on January 1, 1989 and thereafter, the
    Department shall deposit a percentage of the amounts
    collected pursuant to subsections (a) and (b)(6), (7), and
    (8), (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this Act into a fund in
    the State treasury known as the Income Tax Refund Fund. The
    Department shall deposit 18% of such amounts during the
    period beginning January 1, 1989 and ending on June 30,
    1989. Beginning with State fiscal year 1990 and for each
    fiscal year thereafter, the percentage deposited into the
    Income Tax Refund Fund during a fiscal year shall be the
    Annual Percentage. For fiscal years 1999, 2000, and 2001,
    the Annual Percentage shall be 19%. For fiscal year 2003,
    the Annual Percentage shall be 27%. For fiscal year 2004,
    the Annual Percentage shall be 32%. Upon the effective date
    of this amendatory Act of the 93rd General Assembly, the
    Annual Percentage shall be 24% for fiscal year 2005. For
    fiscal year 2006, the Annual Percentage shall be 20%. For
    fiscal year 2007, the Annual Percentage shall be 17.5%. For
    fiscal year 2008, the Annual Percentage shall be 15.5%. For
    all other fiscal years, the Annual Percentage shall be
    calculated as a fraction, the numerator of which shall be
    the amount of refunds approved for payment by the
    Department during the preceding fiscal year as a result of
    overpayment of tax liability under subsections (a) and
    (b)(6), (7), and (8), (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this
    Act plus the amount of such refunds remaining approved but
    unpaid at the end of the preceding fiscal year, and the
    denominator of which shall be the amounts which will be
    collected pursuant to subsections (a) and (b)(6), (7), and
    (8), (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this Act during the
    preceding fiscal year; except that in State fiscal year
    2002, the Annual Percentage shall in no event exceed 23%.
    The Director of Revenue shall certify the Annual Percentage
    to the Comptroller on the last business day of the fiscal
    year immediately preceding the fiscal year for which it is
    to be effective.
        (3) The Comptroller shall order transferred and the
    Treasurer shall transfer from the Tobacco Settlement
    Recovery Fund to the Income Tax Refund Fund (i) $35,000,000
    in January, 2001, (ii) $35,000,000 in January, 2002, and
    (iii) $35,000,000 in January, 2003.
    (d) Expenditures from Income Tax Refund Fund.
        (1) Beginning January 1, 1989, money in the Income Tax
    Refund Fund shall be expended exclusively for the purpose
    of paying refunds resulting from overpayment of tax
    liability under Section 201 of this Act, for paying rebates
    under Section 208.1 in the event that the amounts in the
    Homeowners' Tax Relief Fund are insufficient for that
    purpose, and for making transfers pursuant to this
    subsection (d).
        (2) The Director shall order payment of refunds
    resulting from overpayment of tax liability under Section
    201 of this Act from the Income Tax Refund Fund only to the
    extent that amounts collected pursuant to Section 201 of
    this Act and transfers pursuant to this subsection (d) and
    item (3) of subsection (c) have been deposited and retained
    in the Fund.
        (3) As soon as possible after the end of each fiscal
    year, the Director shall order transferred and the State
    Treasurer and State Comptroller shall transfer from the
    Income Tax Refund Fund to the Personal Property Tax
    Replacement Fund an amount, certified by the Director to
    the Comptroller, equal to the excess of the amount
    collected pursuant to subsections (c) and (d) of Section
    201 of this Act deposited into the Income Tax Refund Fund
    during the fiscal year over the amount of refunds resulting
    from overpayment of tax liability under subsections (c) and
    (d) of Section 201 of this Act paid from the Income Tax
    Refund Fund during the fiscal year.
        (4) As soon as possible after the end of each fiscal
    year, the Director shall order transferred and the State
    Treasurer and State Comptroller shall transfer from the
    Personal Property Tax Replacement Fund to the Income Tax
    Refund Fund an amount, certified by the Director to the
    Comptroller, equal to the excess of the amount of refunds
    resulting from overpayment of tax liability under
    subsections (c) and (d) of Section 201 of this Act paid
    from the Income Tax Refund Fund during the fiscal year over
    the amount collected pursuant to subsections (c) and (d) of
    Section 201 of this Act deposited into the Income Tax
    Refund Fund during the fiscal year.
        (4.5) As soon as possible after the end of fiscal year
    1999 and of each fiscal year thereafter, the Director shall
    order transferred and the State Treasurer and State
    Comptroller shall transfer from the Income Tax Refund Fund
    to the General Revenue Fund any surplus remaining in the
    Income Tax Refund Fund as of the end of such fiscal year;
    excluding for fiscal years 2000, 2001, and 2002 amounts
    attributable to transfers under item (3) of subsection (c)
    less refunds resulting from the earned income tax credit.
        (5) This Act shall constitute an irrevocable and
    continuing appropriation from the Income Tax Refund Fund
    for the purpose of paying refunds upon the order of the
    Director in accordance with the provisions of this Section.
    (e) Deposits into the Education Assistance Fund and the
Income Tax Surcharge Local Government Distributive Fund.
    On July 1, 1991, and thereafter, of the amounts collected
pursuant to subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this Act,
minus deposits into the Income Tax Refund Fund, the Department
shall deposit 7.3% into the Education Assistance Fund in the
State Treasury. Beginning July 1, 1991, and continuing through
January 31, 1993, of the amounts collected pursuant to
subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of the Illinois Income
Tax Act, minus deposits into the Income Tax Refund Fund, the
Department shall deposit 3.0% into the Income Tax Surcharge
Local Government Distributive Fund in the State Treasury.
Beginning February 1, 1993 and continuing through June 30,
1993, of the amounts collected pursuant to subsections (a) and
(b) of Section 201 of the Illinois Income Tax Act, minus
deposits into the Income Tax Refund Fund, the Department shall
deposit 4.4% into the Income Tax Surcharge Local Government
Distributive Fund in the State Treasury. Beginning July 1,
1993, and continuing through June 30, 1994, of the amounts
collected under subsections (a) and (b) of Section 201 of this
Act, minus deposits into the Income Tax Refund Fund, the
Department shall deposit 1.475% into the Income Tax Surcharge
Local Government Distributive Fund in the State Treasury.
(Source: P.A. 93-32, eff. 6-20-03; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91,
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/1001)  (from Ch. 120, par. 10-1001)
    Sec. 1001. Failure to File Tax Returns.
    (a) Failure to file tax return. In case of failure to file
any tax return required under this Act on the date prescribed
therefor, (determined with regard to any extensions of time for
filing) there shall be added as a penalty the amount prescribed
by Section 3-3 of the Uniform Penalty and Interest Act.
    (b) Failure to disclose reportable transaction. Any
taxpayer who fails to include on any return or statement any
information with respect to a reportable transaction that is
required under Section 501(b) of this Act to be included with
such return or statement shall pay a penalty in the amount
determined under this subsection who fails to comply with the
requirements of Section 501(b) of this Act shall pay a penalty
in the amount determined under this subsection. Such penalty
shall be deemed assessed upon the date of filing of the return
for the taxable year in which the taxpayer participates in the
reportable transaction. A taxpayer shall not be considered to
have complied with the requirements of Section 501(b) of this
Act unless the disclosure statement filed with the Department
includes all of the information required to be disclosed with
respect to a reportable transaction pursuant to Section 6011 of
the Internal Revenue Code, the regulations promulgated under
that statute, Treasury Regulations Section 1.6011-4 (26 CFR
1.6011-4) and regulations promulgated by the Department under
Section 501(b) of this Act.
        (1) Amount of penalty. Except as provided in paragraph
    (2), the amount of the penalty under this subsection shall
    be $15,000 for each failure to comply with the requirements
    of Section 501(b).
        (2) Increase in penalty for listed transactions. In the
    case of a failure to comply with the requirements of
    Section 501(b) with respect to a "listed transaction", the
    penalty under this subsection shall be $30,000 for each
    failure.
        (3) Authority to rescind penalty. The Department may
    rescind all or any portion of any penalty imposed by this
    subsection with respect to any violation, if any of the
    following apply:
            (A) the violation is with respect to a reportable
        transaction other than a listed transaction, and
            (B) rescinding the penalty would promote
        compliance with the requirements of this Act and
        effective tax administration.
            (A) It is determined that failure to comply did not
        jeopardize the best interests of the State and is not
        due to any willful neglect or any intent not to comply;
            (B) The person on whom the penalty is imposed has a
        history of complying with the requirements of this Act;
            (C) It is shown that the violation is due to an
        unintentional mistake of fact;
            (D) Imposing the penalty would be against equity
        and good conscience;
            (E) Rescinding the penalty would promote
        compliance with the requirements of this Act and
        effective tax administration; or
            (F) The taxpayer can show that there was a
        reasonable cause for the failure to disclose and that
        the taxpayer acted in good faith.
        A determination made under this subparagraph (3) may be
    reviewed in any administrative or judicial proceeding.
        (4) Coordination with other penalties. The penalty
    imposed by this subsection is in addition to any penalty
    imposed by this Act or the Uniform Penalty and Interest
    Act. The doubling of penalties and interest authorized by
    the Illinois Tax Delinquency Amnesty Act (P.A. 93-26) are
    not applicable to the reportable penalties under
    subsection (b).
    (c) The total penalty imposed under subsection (b) of this
Section with respect to any taxable year shall not exceed 10%
of the increase in net income (or reduction in Illinois net
loss under Section 207 of this Act) that would result had the
taxpayer not participated in any reportable transaction
affecting its net income for such taxable year.
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/1007)
    Sec. 1007. Failure to register tax shelter or maintain
list.
    (a) Penalty Imposed. Any person that fails to comply with
the requirements of Section 1405.5 or Section 1405.6 shall
incur a penalty as provided in subsection (b) this Section. A
person shall not be in compliance with the requirements of
Section 1405.5 unless and until the required return
registration has been filed and that return contains all of the
information required to be included by the Secretary under
federal law. with such registration under Section 6111 of the
Internal Revenue Code or such Section 1405.5. A person shall
not be in compliance with the requirements of Section 1405.6
unless, at the time the required list is made available to the
Department, such list contains all of the information required
to be maintained under Section 6112 of the Internal Revenue
Code or such Section 1405.6.
    (b) Amount of Penalty. The following penalties apply:
        (1) Except as provided in paragraph (2), the penalty
    imposed under subsection (a) with respect to any failure is
    $15,000. In the case of each failure to comply with the
    requirements of subsection (a), subsection (b), or
    subsection (e) of Section 1405.5, the penalty shall be
    $15,000.
        (2) If the failure is with respect to a listed
    transaction under subsection (c) of Section 1405.5, the
    penalty shall be $100,000.
        (3) In the case of each failure to comply with the
    requirements of subsection (a) or subsection (b) of Section
    1405.6, the penalty shall be $15,000.
        (4) If the failure is with respect to a listed
    transaction under subsection (c) of Section 1405.6, the
    penalty shall be $100,000.
    (c) Authority to rescind penalty. The Department may
rescind all or any portion of any penalty imposed by this
subsection with respect to any violation, if
        (1) the violation is with respect to a reportable
    transaction other than a listed transaction, and
        (2) rescinding the penalty would promote compliance
    with the requirements of this Act and effective tax
    administration. The Director of the Board of Appeals may
    rescind all or any portion of any penalty imposed by this
    Section with respect to any violation, if any of the
    following apply:
        (1) It is determined that failure to comply did not
    jeopardize the best interests of the State and is not due
    to any willful neglect or any intent not to comply;
        (2) The person on whom the penalty is imposed has a
    history of complying with the requirements of this Act;
        (3) It is shown that the violation is due to an
    unintentional mistake of fact;
        (4) Imposing the penalty would be against equity and
    good conscience;
        (5) Rescinding the penalty would promote compliance
    with the requirements of this Act and effective tax
    administration; or
        (6) The taxpayer can show that there was reasonable
    cause for the failure to disclose and that the taxpayer
    acted in good faith.
    (d) Coordination with other penalties. The penalty imposed
by this Section is in addition to any penalty imposed by this
Act or the Uniform Penalty and Interest Act.
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/1405.5)
    Sec. 1405.5. Registration of tax shelters.
    (a) Federal tax shelter. Any material advisor tax shelter
organizer required to make a return register a tax shelter
under Section 6111 of the Internal Revenue Code with respect to
a reportable transaction shall send a duplicate of the return
federal registration information to the Department not later
than the day on which the return registration is required to be
filed under federal law. Any person required to register under
Section 6111 of the Internal Revenue Code who receives a tax
registration number from the Secretary of the Treasury shall,
within 30 days after request by the Department, file a
statement of that registration number.
    (b) (Blank). Additional requirements for listed
transactions. In addition to the requirements of subsection
(a), for any transactions entered into on or after February 28,
2000 that become listed transactions (as defined under Treasury
Regulations Section 1.6011-4) at any time, those transactions
shall be registered with the Department (in the form and manner
prescribed by the Department) by the later of (i) 60 days after
entering into the transaction, (ii) 60 days after the
transaction becomes a listed transaction, or (iii) December 31,
2004.
    (c) Transactions Tax shelters subject to this Section. The
provisions of this Section apply to any reportable transaction
having a nexus with this State. For returns that must be filed
under this Section on or after January 1, 2008, a reportable
transaction has nexus with this State if, at the time the
transaction is entered into, the transaction has one or more
investors that is an Illinois taxpayer. For returns that must
be filed under this Section prior to January 1, 2008, a tax
shelter has a nexus with this State if it herein described that
additionally satisfies any of the following conditions: (1) is
organized in this State; (2) is doing business in this State;
or (3) is deriving income from sources in this State.
    (d) (Blank). Tax shelter identification number. Any person
required to file a return under this Act and required to
include on the person's federal tax return a tax shelter
identification number pursuant to Section 6111 of the Internal
Revenue Code shall furnish such number upon filing of the
person's Illinois return.
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/1405.6)
    Sec. 1405.6. Investor lists.
    (a) Federal abusive tax shelter. Any person required to
maintain a list under Section 6112 of the Internal Revenue Code
and Treasury Regulations Section 301.6112-1 with respect to a
potentially abusive tax shelter shall furnish a duplicate of
such list to the Department not later than the earlier of the
time such list is required to be furnished to the Internal
Revenue Service for inspection under Section 6112 of the
Internal Revenue Code or the date of written request by the
Department under federal income tax law.
    The list required under this Section shall include the same
information required with respect to a potentially abusive tax
shelter under Treasury Regulations Section 301.6112-1 and any
other information as the Department may require.
    (b) (Blank). Additional requirements for listed
transactions. For transactions entered into on or after
February 28, 2000 that become listed transactions (as defined
under Treasury Regulations Section 1.6011-4) at any time, the
list shall be furnished to the Department by the later of (i)
60 days after entering into the transaction, (ii) 60 days after
the transaction becomes a listed transaction, or (iii) December
31, 2004.
    (c) Transactions subject to this Section. The provisions of
this Section apply to any reportable transaction having a nexus
with this State. For lists that must be filed with the
Department on or after January 1, 2008, a reportable
transaction has nexus with this State if, at the time the
transaction is entered into, the transaction has one or more
investors that is an Illinois taxpayer. For lists that must be
filed with the Department prior to January 1, 2008, a
reportable transaction has nexus with this State if, at the
time the transaction is: (d) Tax Shelters subject to this
Section. The provisions of this Section apply to any tax
shelter herein described that additionally satisfies any of the
following conditions:
        (1) Organized in this State;
        (2) Doing Business in this State; or
        (3) Deriving income from sources in this State.
(Source: P.A. 93-840, eff. 7-30-04.)
 
    (35 ILCS 5/1501)  (from Ch. 120, par. 15-1501)
    Sec. 1501. Definitions.
    (a) In general. When used in this Act, where not otherwise
distinctly expressed or manifestly incompatible with the
intent thereof:
        (1) Business income. The term "business income" means
    all income that may be treated as apportionable business
    income under the Constitution of the United States.
    Business income is net of the deductions allocable thereto.
    Such term does not include compensation or the deductions
    allocable thereto. For each taxable year beginning on or
    after January 1, 2003, a taxpayer may elect to treat all
    income other than compensation as business income. This
    election shall be made in accordance with rules adopted by
    the Department and, once made, shall be irrevocable.
        (1.5) Captive real estate investment trust:
        (A) The term "captive real estate investment trust"
    means a corporation, trust, or association:
            (i) that is considered a real estate investment
        trust for the taxable year under Section 856 of the
        Internal Revenue Code;
            (ii) the certificates of beneficial interest or
        shares of which are that is not regularly traded on an
        established securities market; and
            (iii) of which more than 50% of the voting power or
        value of the beneficial interest or shares, at any time
        during the last half of the taxable year, is owned or
        controlled, directly, or indirectly, or
        constructively, by a single person entity that is
        subject to the provisions of Subchapter C of Chapter 1
        of the Internal Revenue Code.
        (B) The term "captive real estate investment trust"
    does not include:
            (i) a real estate investment trust corporation,
        trust, or association of which more than 50% of the
        voting power or value of the beneficial interest or
        shares is owned or controlled, directly, indirectly,
        or constructively, at any time during which the
        corporation, trust, or association satisfies item
        (A)(iii) of this subsection (1.5), by:
                (a) a real estate investment trust, other than
            a captive real estate investment trust described
            in item (A) of this subsection;
                (b) a person who is exempt from taxation under
            Section 501 of the Internal Revenue Code, and who
            is not required to treat income received from the
            real estate investment trust as unrelated business
            taxable income under Section 512 of the Internal
            Revenue Code;
                (c) a listed Australian property trust, if no
            more than 50% of the voting power or value of the
            beneficial interest or shares of that trust, at any
            time during the last half of the taxable year, is
            owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by a
            single person; or
                (d) an entity organized as a trust, provided a
            listed Australian property trust described in
            subparagraph (c) owns or controls, directly or
            indirectly, or constructively, 75% or more of the
            voting power or value of the beneficial interests
            or shares of such entity; or
            (ii) during its first taxable year for which it
        elects to be treated as a real estate investment trust
        under Section 856(c)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code, a
        real estate investment trust the certificates of
        beneficial interest or shares of which are not
        regularly traded on an established securities market,
        but only if the certificates of beneficial interest or
        shares of the real estate investment trust are
        regularly traded on an established securities market
        prior to the earlier of the due date (including
        extensions) for filing its return under this Act for
        that first taxable year or the date it actually files
        that return.
                (c) a listed Australian property trust; or
                (d) a real estate investment trust that,
            subject to rules of the Secretary of State, is
            intended to become regularly traded on an
            established securities market and that satisfies
            the requirements of Sections 856(A)(5) and
            856(A)(6) of the Internal Revenue Code by reason of
            Section 856(H)(2) of the Internal Revenue Code.
        (C) For the purposes of this subsection (1.5), the
    constructive ownership rules prescribed under Section
    318(a) 318(A) of the Internal Revenue Code, as modified by
    Section 856(d)(5) 856(D)(5) of the Internal Revenue Code,
    apply in determining the ownership of stock, assets, or net
    profits of any person.
        (2) Commercial domicile. The term "commercial
    domicile" means the principal place from which the trade or
    business of the taxpayer is directed or managed.
        (3) Compensation. The term "compensation" means wages,
    salaries, commissions and any other form of remuneration
    paid to employees for personal services.
        (4) Corporation. The term "corporation" includes
    associations, joint-stock companies, insurance companies
    and cooperatives. Any entity, including a limited
    liability company formed under the Illinois Limited
    Liability Company Act, shall be treated as a corporation if
    it is so classified for federal income tax purposes.
        (5) Department. The term "Department" means the
    Department of Revenue of this State.
        (6) Director. The term "Director" means the Director of
    Revenue of this State.
        (7) Fiduciary. The term "fiduciary" means a guardian,
    trustee, executor, administrator, receiver, or any person
    acting in any fiduciary capacity for any person.
        (8) Financial organization.
            (A) The term "financial organization" means any
        bank, bank holding company, trust company, savings
        bank, industrial bank, land bank, safe deposit
        company, private banker, savings and loan association,
        building and loan association, credit union, currency
        exchange, cooperative bank, small loan company, sales
        finance company, investment company, or any person
        which is owned by a bank or bank holding company. For
        the purpose of this Section a "person" will include
        only those persons which a bank holding company may
        acquire and hold an interest in, directly or
        indirectly, under the provisions of the Bank Holding
        Company Act of 1956 (12 U.S.C. 1841, et seq.), except
        where interests in any person must be disposed of
        within certain required time limits under the Bank
        Holding Company Act of 1956.
            (B) For purposes of subparagraph (A) of this
        paragraph, the term "bank" includes (i) any entity that
        is regulated by the Comptroller of the Currency under
        the National Bank Act, or by the Federal Reserve Board,
        or by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation and
        (ii) any federally or State chartered bank operating as
        a credit card bank.
            (C) For purposes of subparagraph (A) of this
        paragraph, the term "sales finance company" has the
        meaning provided in the following item (i) or (ii):
                (i) A person primarily engaged in one or more
            of the following businesses: the business of
            purchasing customer receivables, the business of
            making loans upon the security of customer
            receivables, the business of making loans for the
            express purpose of funding purchases of tangible
            personal property or services by the borrower, or
            the business of finance leasing. For purposes of
            this item (i), "customer receivable" means:
                    (a) a retail installment contract or
                retail charge agreement within the meaning of
                the Sales Finance Agency Act, the Retail
                Installment Sales Act, or the Motor Vehicle
                Retail Installment Sales Act;
                    (b) an installment, charge, credit, or
                similar contract or agreement arising from the
                sale of tangible personal property or services
                in a transaction involving a deferred payment
                price payable in one or more installments
                subsequent to the sale; or
                    (c) the outstanding balance of a contract
                or agreement described in provisions (a) or (b)
                of this item (i).
                A customer receivable need not provide for
            payment of interest on deferred payments. A sales
            finance company may purchase a customer receivable
            from, or make a loan secured by a customer
            receivable to, the seller in the original
            transaction or to a person who purchased the
            customer receivable directly or indirectly from
            that seller.
                (ii) A corporation meeting each of the
            following criteria:
                    (a) the corporation must be a member of an
                "affiliated group" within the meaning of
                Section 1504(a) of the Internal Revenue Code,
                determined without regard to Section 1504(b)
                of the Internal Revenue Code;
                    (b) more than 50% of the gross income of
                the corporation for the taxable year must be
                interest income derived from qualifying loans.
                A "qualifying loan" is a loan made to a member
                of the corporation's affiliated group that
                originates customer receivables (within the
                meaning of item (i)) or to whom customer
                receivables originated by a member of the
                affiliated group have been transferred, to the
                extent the average outstanding balance of
                loans from that corporation to members of its
                affiliated group during the taxable year do not
                exceed the limitation amount for that
                corporation. The "limitation amount" for a
                corporation is the average outstanding
                balances during the taxable year of customer
                receivables (within the meaning of item (i))
                originated by all members of the affiliated
                group. If the average outstanding balances of
                the loans made by a corporation to members of
                its affiliated group exceed the limitation
                amount, the interest income of that
                corporation from qualifying loans shall be
                equal to its interest income from loans to
                members of its affiliated groups times a
                fraction equal to the limitation amount
                divided by the average outstanding balances of
                the loans made by that corporation to members
                of its affiliated group;
                    (c) the total of all shareholder's equity
                (including, without limitation, paid-in
                capital on common and preferred stock and
                retained earnings) of the corporation plus the
                total of all of its loans, advances, and other
                obligations payable or owed to members of its
                affiliated group may not exceed 20% of the
                total assets of the corporation at any time
                during the tax year; and
                    (d) more than 50% of all interest-bearing
                obligations of the affiliated group payable to
                persons outside the group determined in
                accordance with generally accepted accounting
                principles must be obligations of the
                corporation.
            This amendatory Act of the 91st General Assembly is
        declaratory of existing law.
            (D) Subparagraphs (B) and (C) of this paragraph are
        declaratory of existing law and apply retroactively,
        for all tax years beginning on or before December 31,
        1996, to all original returns, to all amended returns
        filed no later than 30 days after the effective date of
        this amendatory Act of 1996, and to all notices issued
        on or before the effective date of this amendatory Act
        of 1996 under subsection (a) of Section 903, subsection
        (a) of Section 904, subsection (e) of Section 909, or
        Section 912. A taxpayer that is a "financial
        organization" that engages in any transaction with an
        affiliate shall be a "financial organization" for all
        purposes of this Act.
            (E) For all tax years beginning on or before
        December 31, 1996, a taxpayer that falls within the
        definition of a "financial organization" under
        subparagraphs (B) or (C) of this paragraph, but who
        does not fall within the definition of a "financial
        organization" under the Proposed Regulations issued by
        the Department of Revenue on July 19, 1996, may
        irrevocably elect to apply the Proposed Regulations
        for all of those years as though the Proposed
        Regulations had been lawfully promulgated, adopted,
        and in effect for all of those years. For purposes of
        applying subparagraphs (B) or (C) of this paragraph to
        all of those years, the election allowed by this
        subparagraph applies only to the taxpayer making the
        election and to those members of the taxpayer's unitary
        business group who are ordinarily required to
        apportion business income under the same subsection of
        Section 304 of this Act as the taxpayer making the
        election. No election allowed by this subparagraph
        shall be made under a claim filed under subsection (d)
        of Section 909 more than 30 days after the effective
        date of this amendatory Act of 1996.
            (F) Finance Leases. For purposes of this
        subsection, a finance lease shall be treated as a loan
        or other extension of credit, rather than as a lease,
        regardless of how the transaction is characterized for
        any other purpose, including the purposes of any
        regulatory agency to which the lessor is subject. A
        finance lease is any transaction in the form of a lease
        in which the lessee is treated as the owner of the
        leased asset entitled to any deduction for
        depreciation allowed under Section 167 of the Internal
        Revenue Code.
        (9) Fiscal year. The term "fiscal year" means an
    accounting period of 12 months ending on the last day of
    any month other than December.
        (9.5) Fixed place of business. The term "fixed place of
    business" has the same meaning as that term is given in
    Section 864 of the Internal Revenue Code and the related
    Treasury regulations.
        (10) Includes and including. The terms "includes" and
    "including" when used in a definition contained in this Act
    shall not be deemed to exclude other things otherwise
    within the meaning of the term defined.
        (11) Internal Revenue Code. The term "Internal Revenue
    Code" means the United States Internal Revenue Code of 1954
    or any successor law or laws relating to federal income
    taxes in effect for the taxable year.
        (11.5) Investment partnership.
            (A) The term "investment partnership" means any
        entity that is treated as a partnership for federal
        income tax purposes that meets the following
        requirements:
                (i) no less than 90% of the partnership's cost
            of its total assets consists of qualifying
            investment securities, deposits at banks or other
            financial institutions, and office space and
            equipment reasonably necessary to carry on its
            activities as an investment partnership;
                (ii) no less than 90% of its gross income
            consists of interest, dividends, and gains from
            the sale or exchange of qualifying investment
            securities; and
                (iii) the partnership is not a dealer in
            qualifying investment securities.
            (B) For purposes of this paragraph (11.5), the term
        "qualifying investment securities" includes all of the
        following:
                (i) common stock, including preferred or debt
            securities convertible into common stock, and
            preferred stock;
                (ii) bonds, debentures, and other debt
            securities;
                (iii) foreign and domestic currency deposits
            secured by federal, state, or local governmental
            agencies;
                (iv) mortgage or asset-backed securities
            secured by federal, state, or local governmental
            agencies;
                (v) repurchase agreements and loan
            participations;
                (vi) foreign currency exchange contracts and
            forward and futures contracts on foreign
            currencies;
                (vii) stock and bond index securities and
            futures contracts and other similar financial
            securities and futures contracts on those
            securities;
                (viii) options for the purchase or sale of any
            of the securities, currencies, contracts, or
            financial instruments described in items (i) to
            (vii), inclusive;
                (ix) regulated futures contracts;
                (x) commodities (not described in Section
            1221(a)(1) of the Internal Revenue Code) or
            futures, forwards, and options with respect to
            such commodities, provided, however, that any item
            of a physical commodity to which title is actually
            acquired in the partnership's capacity as a dealer
            in such commodity shall not be a qualifying
            investment security;
                (xi) derivatives; and
                (xii) a partnership interest in another
            partnership that is an investment partnership.
        (12) Mathematical error. The term "mathematical error"
    includes the following types of errors, omissions, or
    defects in a return filed by a taxpayer which prevents
    acceptance of the return as filed for processing:
            (A) arithmetic errors or incorrect computations on
        the return or supporting schedules;
            (B) entries on the wrong lines;
            (C) omission of required supporting forms or
        schedules or the omission of the information in whole
        or in part called for thereon; and
            (D) an attempt to claim, exclude, deduct, or
        improperly report, in a manner directly contrary to the
        provisions of the Act and regulations thereunder any
        item of income, exemption, deduction, or credit.
        (13) Nonbusiness income. The term "nonbusiness income"
    means all income other than business income or
    compensation.
        (14) Nonresident. The term "nonresident" means a
    person who is not a resident.
        (15) Paid, incurred and accrued. The terms "paid",
    "incurred" and "accrued" shall be construed according to
    the method of accounting upon the basis of which the
    person's base income is computed under this Act.
        (16) Partnership and partner. The term "partnership"
    includes a syndicate, group, pool, joint venture or other
    unincorporated organization, through or by means of which
    any business, financial operation, or venture is carried
    on, and which is not, within the meaning of this Act, a
    trust or estate or a corporation; and the term "partner"
    includes a member in such syndicate, group, pool, joint
    venture or organization.
        The term "partnership" includes any entity, including
    a limited liability company formed under the Illinois
    Limited Liability Company Act, classified as a partnership
    for federal income tax purposes.
        The term "partnership" does not include a syndicate,
    group, pool, joint venture, or other unincorporated
    organization established for the sole purpose of playing
    the Illinois State Lottery.
        (17) Part-year resident. The term "part-year resident"
    means an individual who became a resident during the
    taxable year or ceased to be a resident during the taxable
    year. Under Section 1501(a)(20)(A)(i) residence commences
    with presence in this State for other than a temporary or
    transitory purpose and ceases with absence from this State
    for other than a temporary or transitory purpose. Under
    Section 1501(a)(20)(A)(ii) residence commences with the
    establishment of domicile in this State and ceases with the
    establishment of domicile in another State.
        (18) Person. The term "person" shall be construed to
    mean and include an individual, a trust, estate,
    partnership, association, firm, company, corporation,
    limited liability company, or fiduciary. For purposes of
    Section 1301 and 1302 of this Act, a "person" means (i) an
    individual, (ii) a corporation, (iii) an officer, agent, or
    employee of a corporation, (iv) a member, agent or employee
    of a partnership, or (v) a member, manager, employee,
    officer, director, or agent of a limited liability company
    who in such capacity commits an offense specified in
    Section 1301 and 1302.
        (18A) Records. The term "records" includes all data
    maintained by the taxpayer, whether on paper, microfilm,
    microfiche, or any type of machine-sensible data
    compilation.
        (19) Regulations. The term "regulations" includes
    rules promulgated and forms prescribed by the Department.
        (20) Resident. The term "resident" means:
            (A) an individual (i) who is in this State for
        other than a temporary or transitory purpose during the
        taxable year; or (ii) who is domiciled in this State
        but is absent from the State for a temporary or
        transitory purpose during the taxable year;
            (B) The estate of a decedent who at his or her
        death was domiciled in this State;
            (C) A trust created by a will of a decedent who at
        his death was domiciled in this State; and
            (D) An irrevocable trust, the grantor of which was
        domiciled in this State at the time such trust became
        irrevocable. For purpose of this subparagraph, a trust
        shall be considered irrevocable to the extent that the
        grantor is not treated as the owner thereof under
        Sections 671 through 678 of the Internal Revenue Code.
        (21) Sales. The term "sales" means all gross receipts
    of the taxpayer not allocated under Sections 301, 302 and
    303.
        (22) State. The term "state" when applied to a
    jurisdiction other than this State means any state of the
    United States, the District of Columbia, the Commonwealth
    of Puerto Rico, any Territory or Possession of the United
    States, and any foreign country, or any political
    subdivision of any of the foregoing. For purposes of the
    foreign tax credit under Section 601, the term "state"
    means any state of the United States, the District of
    Columbia, the Commonwealth of Puerto Rico, and any
    territory or possession of the United States, or any
    political subdivision of any of the foregoing, effective
    for tax years ending on or after December 31, 1989.
        (23) Taxable year. The term "taxable year" means the
    calendar year, or the fiscal year ending during such
    calendar year, upon the basis of which the base income is
    computed under this Act. "Taxable year" means, in the case
    of a return made for a fractional part of a year under the
    provisions of this Act, the period for which such return is
    made.
        (24) Taxpayer. The term "taxpayer" means any person
    subject to the tax imposed by this Act.
        (25) International banking facility. The term
    international banking facility shall have the same meaning
    as is set forth in the Illinois Banking Act or as is set
    forth in the laws of the United States or regulations of
    the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System.
        (26) Income Tax Return Preparer.
            (A) The term "income tax return preparer" means any
        person who prepares for compensation, or who employs
        one or more persons to prepare for compensation, any
        return of tax imposed by this Act or any claim for
        refund of tax imposed by this Act. The preparation of a
        substantial portion of a return or claim for refund
        shall be treated as the preparation of that return or
        claim for refund.
            (B) A person is not an income tax return preparer
        if all he or she does is
                (i) furnish typing, reproducing, or other
            mechanical assistance;
                (ii) prepare returns or claims for refunds for
            the employer by whom he or she is regularly and
            continuously employed;
                (iii) prepare as a fiduciary returns or claims
            for refunds for any person; or
                (iv) prepare claims for refunds for a taxpayer
            in response to any notice of deficiency issued to
            that taxpayer or in response to any waiver of
            restriction after the commencement of an audit of
            that taxpayer or of another taxpayer if a
            determination in the audit of the other taxpayer
            directly or indirectly affects the tax liability
            of the taxpayer whose claims he or she is
            preparing.
        (27) Unitary business group. The term "unitary
    business group" means a group of persons related through
    common ownership whose business activities are integrated
    with, dependent upon and contribute to each other. The
    group will not include those members whose business
    activity outside the United States is 80% or more of any
    such member's total business activity; for purposes of this
    paragraph and clause (a)(3)(B)(ii) of Section 304,
    business activity within the United States shall be
    measured by means of the factors ordinarily applicable
    under subsections (a), (b), (c), (d), or (h) of Section 304
    except that, in the case of members ordinarily required to
    apportion business income by means of the 3 factor formula
    of property, payroll and sales specified in subsection (a)
    of Section 304, including the formula as weighted in
    subsection (h) of Section 304, such members shall not use
    the sales factor in the computation and the results of the
    property and payroll factor computations of subsection (a)
    of Section 304 shall be divided by 2 (by one if either the
    property or payroll factor has a denominator of zero). The
    computation required by the preceding sentence shall, in
    each case, involve the division of the member's property,
    payroll, or revenue miles in the United States, insurance
    premiums on property or risk in the United States, or
    financial organization business income from sources within
    the United States, as the case may be, by the respective
    worldwide figures for such items. Common ownership in the
    case of corporations is the direct or indirect control or
    ownership of more than 50% of the outstanding voting stock
    of the persons carrying on unitary business activity.
    Unitary business activity can ordinarily be illustrated
    where the activities of the members are: (1) in the same
    general line (such as manufacturing, wholesaling,
    retailing of tangible personal property, insurance,
    transportation or finance); or (2) are steps in a
    vertically structured enterprise or process (such as the
    steps involved in the production of natural resources,
    which might include exploration, mining, refining, and
    marketing); and, in either instance, the members are
    functionally integrated through the exercise of strong
    centralized management (where, for example, authority over
    such matters as purchasing, financing, tax compliance,
    product line, personnel, marketing and capital investment
    is not left to each member). In no event, however, will any
    unitary business group include members which are
    ordinarily required to apportion business income under
    different subsections of Section 304 except that for tax
    years ending on or after December 31, 1987 this prohibition
    shall not apply to a unitary business group composed of one
    or more taxpayers all of which apportion business income
    pursuant to subsection (b) of Section 304, or all of which
    apportion business income pursuant to subsection (d) of
    Section 304, and a holding company of such single-factor
    taxpayers (see definition of "financial organization" for
    rule regarding holding companies of financial
    organizations). If a unitary business group would, but for
    the preceding sentence, include members that are
    ordinarily required to apportion business income under
    different subsections of Section 304, then for each
    subsection of Section 304 for which there are two or more
    members, there shall be a separate unitary business group
    composed of such members. For purposes of the preceding two
    sentences, a member is "ordinarily required to apportion
    business income" under a particular subsection of Section
    304 if it would be required to use the apportionment method
    prescribed by such subsection except for the fact that it
    derives business income solely from Illinois. As used in
    this paragraph, the phrase "United States" means only the
    50 states and the District of Columbia, but does not
    include any territory or possession of the United States or
    any area over which the United States has asserted
    jurisdiction or claimed exclusive rights with respect to
    the exploration for or exploitation of natural resources.
        If the unitary business group members' accounting
    periods differ, the common parent's accounting period or,
    if there is no common parent, the accounting period of the
    member that is expected to have, on a recurring basis, the
    greatest Illinois income tax liability must be used to
    determine whether to use the apportionment method provided
    in subsection (a) or subsection (h) of Section 304. The
    prohibition against membership in a unitary business group
    for taxpayers ordinarily required to apportion income
    under different subsections of Section 304 does not apply
    to taxpayers required to apportion income under subsection
    (a) and subsection (h) of Section 304. The provisions of
    this amendatory Act of 1998 apply to tax years ending on or
    after December 31, 1998.
        (28) Subchapter S corporation. The term "Subchapter S
    corporation" means a corporation for which there is in
    effect an election under Section 1362 of the Internal
    Revenue Code, or for which there is a federal election to
    opt out of the provisions of the Subchapter S Revision Act
    of 1982 and have applied instead the prior federal
    Subchapter S rules as in effect on July 1, 1982.
        (30) Foreign person. The term "foreign person" means
    any person who is a nonresident alien individual and any
    nonindividual entity, regardless of where created or
    organized, whose business activity outside the United
    States is 80% or more of the entity's total business
    activity.
 
    (b) Other definitions.
        (1) Words denoting number, gender, and so forth, when
    used in this Act, where not otherwise distinctly expressed
    or manifestly incompatible with the intent thereof:
            (A) Words importing the singular include and apply
        to several persons, parties or things;
            (B) Words importing the plural include the
        singular; and
            (C) Words importing the masculine gender include
        the feminine as well.
        (2) "Company" or "association" as including successors
    and assigns. The word "company" or "association", when used
    in reference to a corporation, shall be deemed to embrace
    the words "successors and assigns of such company or
    association", and in like manner as if these last-named
    words, or words of similar import, were expressed.
        (3) Other terms. Any term used in any Section of this
    Act with respect to the application of, or in connection
    with, the provisions of any other Section of this Act shall
    have the same meaning as in such other Section.
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
 
    Section 5-16. The Use Tax Act is amended by changing
Section 3-50 as follows:
 
    (35 ILCS 105/3-50)  (from Ch. 120, par. 439.3-50)
    Sec. 3-50. Manufacturing and assembly exemption. The
manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment exemption
includes machinery and equipment that replaces machinery and
equipment in an existing manufacturing facility as well as
machinery and equipment that are for use in an expanded or new
manufacturing facility. The machinery and equipment exemption
also includes machinery and equipment used in the general
maintenance or repair of exempt machinery and equipment or for
in-house manufacture of exempt machinery and equipment. For the
purposes of this exemption, terms have the following meanings:
        (1) "Manufacturing process" means the production of an
    article of tangible personal property, whether the article
    is a finished product or an article for use in the process
    of manufacturing or assembling a different article of
    tangible personal property, by a procedure commonly
    regarded as manufacturing, processing, fabricating, or
    refining that changes some existing material into a
    material with a different form, use, or name. In relation
    to a recognized integrated business composed of a series of
    operations that collectively constitute manufacturing, or
    individually constitute manufacturing operations, the
    manufacturing process commences with the first operation
    or stage of production in the series and does not end until
    the completion of the final product in the last operation
    or stage of production in the series. For purposes of this
    exemption, photoprocessing is a manufacturing process of
    tangible personal property for wholesale or retail sale.
        (2) "Assembling process" means the production of an
    article of tangible personal property, whether the article
    is a finished product or an article for use in the process
    of manufacturing or assembling a different article of
    tangible personal property, by the combination of existing
    materials in a manner commonly regarded as assembling that
    results in an article or material of a different form, use,
    or name.
        (3) "Machinery" means major mechanical machines or
    major components of those machines contributing to a
    manufacturing or assembling process.
        (4) "Equipment" includes an independent device or tool
    separate from machinery but essential to an integrated
    manufacturing or assembly process; including computers
    used primarily in a manufacturer's computer assisted
    design, computer assisted manufacturing (CAD/CAM) system;
    any subunit or assembly comprising a component of any
    machinery or auxiliary, adjunct, or attachment parts of
    machinery, such as tools, dies, jigs, fixtures, patterns,
    and molds; and any parts that require periodic replacement
    in the course of normal operation; but does not include
    hand tools. Equipment includes chemicals or chemicals
    acting as catalysts but only if the chemicals or chemicals
    acting as catalysts effect a direct and immediate change
    upon a product being manufactured or assembled for
    wholesale or retail sale or lease.
        (5) "Production related tangible personal property"
    means all tangible personal property that is used or
    consumed by the purchaser in a manufacturing facility in
    which a manufacturing process takes place and includes,
    without limitation, tangible personal property that is
    purchased for incorporation into real estate within a
    manufacturing facility and tangible personal property that
    is used or consumed in activities such as research and
    development, preproduction material handling, receiving,
    quality control, inventory control, storage, staging, and
    packaging for shipping and transportation purposes.
    "Production related tangible personal property" does not
    include (i) tangible personal property that is used, within
    or without a manufacturing facility, in sales, purchasing,
    accounting, fiscal management, marketing, personnel
    recruitment or selection, or landscaping or (ii) tangible
    personal property that is required to be titled or
    registered with a department, agency, or unit of federal,
    State, or local government.
    The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment
exemption includes production related tangible personal
property that is purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or
before June 30, 2008. The exemption for production related
tangible personal property is subject to both of the following
limitations:
        (1) The maximum amount of the exemption for any one
    taxpayer may not exceed 5% of the purchase price of
    production related tangible personal property that is
    purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or before June
    30, 2008. A credit under Section 3-85 of this Act may not
    be earned by the purchase of production related tangible
    personal property for which an exemption is received under
    this Section.
        (2) The maximum aggregate amount of the exemptions for
    production related tangible personal property awarded
    under this Act and the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act to all
    taxpayers may not exceed $10,000,000. If the claims for the
    exemption exceed $10,000,000, then the Department shall
    reduce the amount of the exemption to each taxpayer on a
    pro rata basis.
The Department may adopt rules to implement and administer the
exemption for production related tangible personal property.
    The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment
exemption includes the sale of materials to a purchaser who
produces exempted types of machinery, equipment, or tools and
who rents or leases that machinery, equipment, or tools to a
manufacturer of tangible personal property. This exemption
also includes the sale of materials to a purchaser who
manufactures those materials into an exempted type of
machinery, equipment, or tools that the purchaser uses himself
or herself in the manufacturing of tangible personal property.
This exemption includes the sale of exempted types of machinery
or equipment to a purchaser who is not the manufacturer, but
who rents or leases the use of the property to a manufacturer.
The purchaser of the machinery and equipment who has an active
resale registration number shall furnish that number to the
seller at the time of purchase. A user of the machinery,
equipment, or tools without an active resale registration
number shall prepare a certificate of exemption for each
transaction stating facts establishing the exemption for that
transaction, and that certificate shall be available to the
Department for inspection or audit. The Department shall
prescribe the form of the certificate. Informal rulings,
opinions, or letters issued by the Department in response to an
inquiry or request for an opinion from any person regarding the
coverage and applicability of this exemption to specific
devices shall be published, maintained as a public record, and
made available for public inspection and copying. If the
informal ruling, opinion, or letter contains trade secrets or
other confidential information, where possible, the Department
shall delete that information before publication. Whenever
informal rulings, opinions, or letters contain a policy of
general applicability, the Department shall formulate and
adopt that policy as a rule in accordance with the Illinois
Administrative Procedure Act.
(Source: P.A. 91-51, eff. 6-30-99; 92-484, eff. 8-23-01.)
 
    Section 5-17. The Retailers' Occupation Tax Act is amended
by changing Sections 2-5 and 2-45 as follows:
 
    (35 ILCS 120/2-5)  (from Ch. 120, par. 441-5)
    Sec. 2-5. Exemptions. Gross receipts from proceeds from the
sale of the following tangible personal property are exempt
from the tax imposed by this Act:
    (1) Farm chemicals.
    (2) Farm machinery and equipment, both new and used,
including that manufactured on special order, certified by the
purchaser to be used primarily for production agriculture or
State or federal agricultural programs, including individual
replacement parts for the machinery and equipment, including
machinery and equipment purchased for lease, and including
implements of husbandry defined in Section 1-130 of the
Illinois Vehicle Code, farm machinery and agricultural
chemical and fertilizer spreaders, and nurse wagons required to
be registered under Section 3-809 of the Illinois Vehicle Code,
but excluding other motor vehicles required to be registered
under the Illinois Vehicle Code. Horticultural polyhouses or
hoop houses used for propagating, growing, or overwintering
plants shall be considered farm machinery and equipment under
this item (2). Agricultural chemical tender tanks and dry boxes
shall include units sold separately from a motor vehicle
required to be licensed and units sold mounted on a motor
vehicle required to be licensed, if the selling price of the
tender is separately stated.
    Farm machinery and equipment shall include precision
farming equipment that is installed or purchased to be
installed on farm machinery and equipment including, but not
limited to, tractors, harvesters, sprayers, planters, seeders,
or spreaders. Precision farming equipment includes, but is not
limited to, soil testing sensors, computers, monitors,
software, global positioning and mapping systems, and other
such equipment.
    Farm machinery and equipment also includes computers,
sensors, software, and related equipment used primarily in the
computer-assisted operation of production agriculture
facilities, equipment, and activities such as, but not limited
to, the collection, monitoring, and correlation of animal and
crop data for the purpose of formulating animal diets and
agricultural chemicals. This item (7) is exempt from the
provisions of Section 2-70.
    (3) Until July 1, 2003, distillation machinery and
equipment, sold as a unit or kit, assembled or installed by the
retailer, certified by the user to be used only for the
production of ethyl alcohol that will be used for consumption
as motor fuel or as a component of motor fuel for the personal
use of the user, and not subject to sale or resale.
    (4) Until July 1, 2003 and beginning again September 1,
2004, graphic arts machinery and equipment, including repair
and replacement parts, both new and used, and including that
manufactured on special order or purchased for lease, certified
by the purchaser to be used primarily for graphic arts
production. Equipment includes chemicals or chemicals acting
as catalysts but only if the chemicals or chemicals acting as
catalysts effect a direct and immediate change upon a graphic
arts product.
    (5) A motor vehicle of the first division, a motor vehicle
of the second division that is a self contained motor vehicle
designed or permanently converted to provide living quarters
for recreational, camping, or travel use, with direct walk
through access to the living quarters from the driver's seat,
or a motor vehicle of the second division that is of the van
configuration designed for the transportation of not less than
7 nor more than 16 passengers, as defined in Section 1-146 of
the Illinois Vehicle Code, that is used for automobile renting,
as defined in the Automobile Renting Occupation and Use Tax
Act. This paragraph is exempt from the provisions of Section
2-70. (Blank).
    (6) Personal property sold by a teacher-sponsored student
organization affiliated with an elementary or secondary school
located in Illinois.
    (7) Until July 1, 2003, proceeds of that portion of the
selling price of a passenger car the sale of which is subject
to the Replacement Vehicle Tax.
    (8) Personal property sold to an Illinois county fair
association for use in conducting, operating, or promoting the
county fair.
    (9) Personal property sold to a not-for-profit arts or
cultural organization that establishes, by proof required by
the Department by rule, that it has received an exemption under
Section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code and that is
organized and operated primarily for the presentation or
support of arts or cultural programming, activities, or
services. These organizations include, but are not limited to,
music and dramatic arts organizations such as symphony
orchestras and theatrical groups, arts and cultural service
organizations, local arts councils, visual arts organizations,
and media arts organizations. On and after the effective date
of this amendatory Act of the 92nd General Assembly, however,
an entity otherwise eligible for this exemption shall not make
tax-free purchases unless it has an active identification
number issued by the Department.
    (10) Personal property sold by a corporation, society,
association, foundation, institution, or organization, other
than a limited liability company, that is organized and
operated as a not-for-profit service enterprise for the benefit
of persons 65 years of age or older if the personal property
was not purchased by the enterprise for the purpose of resale
by the enterprise.
    (11) Personal property sold to a governmental body, to a
corporation, society, association, foundation, or institution
organized and operated exclusively for charitable, religious,
or educational purposes, or to a not-for-profit corporation,
society, association, foundation, institution, or organization
that has no compensated officers or employees and that is
organized and operated primarily for the recreation of persons
55 years of age or older. A limited liability company may
qualify for the exemption under this paragraph only if the
limited liability company is organized and operated
exclusively for educational purposes. On and after July 1,
1987, however, no entity otherwise eligible for this exemption
shall make tax-free purchases unless it has an active
identification number issued by the Department.
    (12) Tangible personal property sold to interstate
carriers for hire for use as rolling stock moving in interstate
commerce or to lessors under leases of one year or longer
executed or in effect at the time of purchase by interstate
carriers for hire for use as rolling stock moving in interstate
commerce and equipment operated by a telecommunications
provider, licensed as a common carrier by the Federal
Communications Commission, which is permanently installed in
or affixed to aircraft moving in interstate commerce.
    (12-5) On and after July 1, 2003 and through June 30, 2004,
motor vehicles of the second division with a gross vehicle
weight in excess of 8,000 pounds that are subject to the
commercial distribution fee imposed under Section 3-815.1 of
the Illinois Vehicle Code. Beginning on July 1, 2004 and
through June 30, 2005, the use in this State of motor vehicles
of the second division: (i) with a gross vehicle weight rating
in excess of 8,000 pounds; (ii) that are subject to the
commercial distribution fee imposed under Section 3-815.1 of
the Illinois Vehicle Code; and (iii) that are primarily used
for commercial purposes. Through June 30, 2005, this exemption
applies to repair and replacement parts added after the initial
purchase of such a motor vehicle if that motor vehicle is used
in a manner that would qualify for the rolling stock exemption
otherwise provided for in this Act. For purposes of this
paragraph, "used for commercial purposes" means the
transportation of persons or property in furtherance of any
commercial or industrial enterprise whether for-hire or not.
    (13) Proceeds from sales to owners, lessors, or shippers of
tangible personal property that is utilized by interstate
carriers for hire for use as rolling stock moving in interstate
commerce and equipment operated by a telecommunications
provider, licensed as a common carrier by the Federal
Communications Commission, which is permanently installed in
or affixed to aircraft moving in interstate commerce.
    (14) Machinery and equipment that will be used by the
purchaser, or a lessee of the purchaser, primarily in the
process of manufacturing or assembling tangible personal
property for wholesale or retail sale or lease, whether the
sale or lease is made directly by the manufacturer or by some
other person, whether the materials used in the process are
owned by the manufacturer or some other person, or whether the
sale or lease is made apart from or as an incident to the
seller's engaging in the service occupation of producing
machines, tools, dies, jigs, patterns, gauges, or other similar
items of no commercial value on special order for a particular
purchaser.
    (15) Proceeds of mandatory service charges separately
stated on customers' bills for purchase and consumption of food
and beverages, to the extent that the proceeds of the service
charge are in fact turned over as tips or as a substitute for
tips to the employees who participate directly in preparing,
serving, hosting or cleaning up the food or beverage function
with respect to which the service charge is imposed.
    (16) Petroleum products sold to a purchaser if the seller
is prohibited by federal law from charging tax to the
purchaser.
    (17) Tangible personal property sold to a common carrier by
rail or motor that receives the physical possession of the
property in Illinois and that transports the property, or
shares with another common carrier in the transportation of the
property, out of Illinois on a standard uniform bill of lading
showing the seller of the property as the shipper or consignor
of the property to a destination outside Illinois, for use
outside Illinois.
    (18) Legal tender, currency, medallions, or gold or silver
coinage issued by the State of Illinois, the government of the
United States of America, or the government of any foreign
country, and bullion.
    (19) Until July 1 2003, oil field exploration, drilling,
and production equipment, including (i) rigs and parts of rigs,
rotary rigs, cable tool rigs, and workover rigs, (ii) pipe and
tubular goods, including casing and drill strings, (iii) pumps
and pump-jack units, (iv) storage tanks and flow lines, (v) any
individual replacement part for oil field exploration,
drilling, and production equipment, and (vi) machinery and
equipment purchased for lease; but excluding motor vehicles
required to be registered under the Illinois Vehicle Code.
    (20) Photoprocessing machinery and equipment, including
repair and replacement parts, both new and used, including that
manufactured on special order, certified by the purchaser to be
used primarily for photoprocessing, and including
photoprocessing machinery and equipment purchased for lease.
    (21) Until July 1, 2003, coal exploration, mining,
offhighway hauling, processing, maintenance, and reclamation
equipment, including replacement parts and equipment, and
including equipment purchased for lease, but excluding motor
vehicles required to be registered under the Illinois Vehicle
Code.
    (22) Fuel and petroleum products sold to or used by an air
carrier, certified by the carrier to be used for consumption,
shipment, or storage in the conduct of its business as an air
common carrier, for a flight destined for or returning from a
location or locations outside the United States without regard
to previous or subsequent domestic stopovers.
    (23) A transaction in which the purchase order is received
by a florist who is located outside Illinois, but who has a
florist located in Illinois deliver the property to the
purchaser or the purchaser's donee in Illinois.
    (24) Fuel consumed or used in the operation of ships,
barges, or vessels that are used primarily in or for the
transportation of property or the conveyance of persons for
hire on rivers bordering on this State if the fuel is delivered
by the seller to the purchaser's barge, ship, or vessel while
it is afloat upon that bordering river.
    (25) Except as provided in item (25-5) of this Section, a
motor vehicle sold in this State to a nonresident even though
the motor vehicle is delivered to the nonresident in this
State, if the motor vehicle is not to be titled in this State,
and if a drive-away permit is issued to the motor vehicle as
provided in Section 3-603 of the Illinois Vehicle Code or if
the nonresident purchaser has vehicle registration plates to
transfer to the motor vehicle upon returning to his or her home
state. The issuance of the drive-away permit or having the
out-of-state registration plates to be transferred is prima
facie evidence that the motor vehicle will not be titled in
this State.
    (25-5) The exemption under item (25) does not apply if the
state in which the motor vehicle will be titled does not allow
a reciprocal exemption for a motor vehicle sold and delivered
in that state to an Illinois resident but titled in Illinois.
The tax collected under this Act on the sale of a motor vehicle
in this State to a resident of another state that does not
allow a reciprocal exemption shall be imposed at a rate equal
to the state's rate of tax on taxable property in the state in
which the purchaser is a resident, except that the tax shall
not exceed the tax that would otherwise be imposed under this
Act. At the time of the sale, the purchaser shall execute a
statement, signed under penalty of perjury, of his or her
intent to title the vehicle in the state in which the purchaser
is a resident within 30 days after the sale and of the fact of
the payment to the State of Illinois of tax in an amount
equivalent to the state's rate of tax on taxable property in
his or her state of residence and shall submit the statement to
the appropriate tax collection agency in his or her state of
residence. In addition, the retailer must retain a signed copy
of the statement in his or her records. Nothing in this item
shall be construed to require the removal of the vehicle from
this state following the filing of an intent to title the
vehicle in the purchaser's state of residence if the purchaser
titles the vehicle in his or her state of residence within 30
days after the date of sale. The tax collected under this Act
in accordance with this item (25-5) shall be proportionately
distributed as if the tax were collected at the 6.25% general
rate imposed under this Act.
    (25-7) Beginning on July 1, 2007, no tax is imposed under
this Act on the sale of an aircraft, as defined in Section 3 of
the Illinois Aeronautics Act, if all of the following
conditions are met:
        (1) the aircraft leaves this State within 15 days after
    the later of either the issuance of the final billing for
    the sale of the aircraft, or the authorized approval for
    return to service, completion of the maintenance record
    entry, and completion of the test flight and ground test
    for inspection, as required by 14 C.F.R. 91.407;
        (2) the aircraft is not based or registered in this
    State after the sale of the aircraft; and
        (3) the seller retains in his or her books and records
    and provides to the Department a signed and dated
    certification from the purchaser, on a form prescribed by
    the Department, certifying that the requirements of this
    item (25-7) are met. The certificate must also include the
    name and address of the purchaser, the address of the
    location where the aircraft is to be titled or registered,
    the address of the primary physical location of the
    aircraft, and other information that the Department may
    reasonably require.
    For purposes of this item (25-7):
    "Based in this State" means hangared, stored, or otherwise
used, excluding post-sale customizations as defined in this
Section, for 10 or more days in each 12-month period
immediately following the date of the sale of the aircraft.
    "Registered in this State" means an aircraft registered
with the Department of Transportation, Aeronautics Division,
or titled or registered with the Federal Aviation
Administration to an address located in this State.
    This paragraph (25-7) is exempt from the provisions of
Section 2-70.
    (26) Semen used for artificial insemination of livestock
for direct agricultural production.
    (27) Horses, or interests in horses, registered with and
meeting the requirements of any of the Arabian Horse Club
Registry of America, Appaloosa Horse Club, American Quarter
Horse Association, United States Trotting Association, or
Jockey Club, as appropriate, used for purposes of breeding or
racing for prizes. This item (27) is exempt from the provisions
of Section 2-70, and the exemption provided for under this item
(27) applies for all periods beginning May 30, 1995, but no
claim for credit or refund is allowed on or after January 1,
2008 (the effective date of Public Act 95-88) this amendatory
Act of the 95th General Assembly for such taxes paid during the
period beginning May 30, 2000 and ending on January 1, 2008
(the effective date of Public Act 95-88) this amendatory Act of
the 95th General Assembly.
    (28) Computers and communications equipment utilized for
any hospital purpose and equipment used in the diagnosis,
analysis, or treatment of hospital patients sold to a lessor
who leases the equipment, under a lease of one year or longer
executed or in effect at the time of the purchase, to a
hospital that has been issued an active tax exemption
identification number by the Department under Section 1g of
this Act.
    (29) Personal property sold to a lessor who leases the
property, under a lease of one year or longer executed or in
effect at the time of the purchase, to a governmental body that
has been issued an active tax exemption identification number
by the Department under Section 1g of this Act.
    (30) Beginning with taxable years ending on or after
December 31, 1995 and ending with taxable years ending on or
before December 31, 2004, personal property that is donated for
disaster relief to be used in a State or federally declared
disaster area in Illinois or bordering Illinois by a
manufacturer or retailer that is registered in this State to a
corporation, society, association, foundation, or institution
that has been issued a sales tax exemption identification
number by the Department that assists victims of the disaster
who reside within the declared disaster area.
    (31) Beginning with taxable years ending on or after
December 31, 1995 and ending with taxable years ending on or
before December 31, 2004, personal property that is used in the
performance of infrastructure repairs in this State, including
but not limited to municipal roads and streets, access roads,
bridges, sidewalks, waste disposal systems, water and sewer
line extensions, water distribution and purification
facilities, storm water drainage and retention facilities, and
sewage treatment facilities, resulting from a State or
federally declared disaster in Illinois or bordering Illinois
when such repairs are initiated on facilities located in the
declared disaster area within 6 months after the disaster.
    (32) Beginning July 1, 1999, game or game birds sold at a
"game breeding and hunting preserve area" or an "exotic game
hunting area" as those terms are used in the Wildlife Code or
at a hunting enclosure approved through rules adopted by the
Department of Natural Resources. This paragraph is exempt from
the provisions of Section 2-70.
    (33) A motor vehicle, as that term is defined in Section
1-146 of the Illinois Vehicle Code, that is donated to a
corporation, limited liability company, society, association,
foundation, or institution that is determined by the Department
to be organized and operated exclusively for educational
purposes. For purposes of this exemption, "a corporation,
limited liability company, society, association, foundation,
or institution organized and operated exclusively for
educational purposes" means all tax-supported public schools,
private schools that offer systematic instruction in useful
branches of learning by methods common to public schools and
that compare favorably in their scope and intensity with the
course of study presented in tax-supported schools, and
vocational or technical schools or institutes organized and
operated exclusively to provide a course of study of not less
than 6 weeks duration and designed to prepare individuals to
follow a trade or to pursue a manual, technical, mechanical,
industrial, business, or commercial occupation.
    (34) Beginning January 1, 2000, personal property,
including food, purchased through fundraising events for the
benefit of a public or private elementary or secondary school,
a group of those schools, or one or more school districts if
the events are sponsored by an entity recognized by the school
district that consists primarily of volunteers and includes
parents and teachers of the school children. This paragraph
does not apply to fundraising events (i) for the benefit of
private home instruction or (ii) for which the fundraising
entity purchases the personal property sold at the events from
another individual or entity that sold the property for the
purpose of resale by the fundraising entity and that profits
from the sale to the fundraising entity. This paragraph is
exempt from the provisions of Section 2-70.
    (35) Beginning January 1, 2000 and through December 31,
2001, new or used automatic vending machines that prepare and
serve hot food and beverages, including coffee, soup, and other
items, and replacement parts for these machines. Beginning
January 1, 2002 and through June 30, 2003, machines and parts
for machines used in commercial, coin-operated amusement and
vending business if a use or occupation tax is paid on the
gross receipts derived from the use of the commercial,
coin-operated amusement and vending machines. This paragraph
is exempt from the provisions of Section 2-70.
    (35-5) Beginning August 23, 2001 and through June 30, 2011,
food for human consumption that is to be consumed off the
premises where it is sold (other than alcoholic beverages, soft
drinks, and food that has been prepared for immediate
consumption) and prescription and nonprescription medicines,
drugs, medical appliances, and insulin, urine testing
materials, syringes, and needles used by diabetics, for human
use, when purchased for use by a person receiving medical
assistance under Article 5 of the Illinois Public Aid Code who
resides in a licensed long-term care facility, as defined in
the Nursing Home Care Act.
    (36) Beginning August 2, 2001, computers and
communications equipment utilized for any hospital purpose and
equipment used in the diagnosis, analysis, or treatment of
hospital patients sold to a lessor who leases the equipment,
under a lease of one year or longer executed or in effect at
the time of the purchase, to a hospital that has been issued an
active tax exemption identification number by the Department
under Section 1g of this Act. This paragraph is exempt from the
provisions of Section 2-70.
    (37) Beginning August 2, 2001, personal property sold to a
lessor who leases the property, under a lease of one year or
longer executed or in effect at the time of the purchase, to a
governmental body that has been issued an active tax exemption
identification number by the Department under Section 1g of
this Act. This paragraph is exempt from the provisions of
Section 2-70.
    (38) Beginning on January 1, 2002 and through June 30,
2011, tangible personal property purchased from an Illinois
retailer by a taxpayer engaged in centralized purchasing
activities in Illinois who will, upon receipt of the property
in Illinois, temporarily store the property in Illinois (i) for
the purpose of subsequently transporting it outside this State
for use or consumption thereafter solely outside this State or
(ii) for the purpose of being processed, fabricated, or
manufactured into, attached to, or incorporated into other
tangible personal property to be transported outside this State
and thereafter used or consumed solely outside this State. The
Director of Revenue shall, pursuant to rules adopted in
accordance with the Illinois Administrative Procedure Act,
issue a permit to any taxpayer in good standing with the
Department who is eligible for the exemption under this
paragraph (38). The permit issued under this paragraph (38)
shall authorize the holder, to the extent and in the manner
specified in the rules adopted under this Act, to purchase
tangible personal property from a retailer exempt from the
taxes imposed by this Act. Taxpayers shall maintain all
necessary books and records to substantiate the use and
consumption of all such tangible personal property outside of
the State of Illinois.
    (39) Beginning January 1, 2008, tangible personal property
used in the construction or maintenance of a community water
supply, as defined under Section 3.145 of the Environmental
Protection Act, that is operated by a not-for-profit
corporation that holds a valid water supply permit issued under
Title IV of the Environmental Protection Act. This paragraph is
exempt from the provisions of Section 2-70.
(Source: P.A. 94-1002, eff. 7-3-06; 95-88, eff. 1-1-08; 95-233,
eff. 8-16-07; 95-304, eff. 8-20-07; 95-538, eff. 1-1-08;
revised 9-11-07.)
 
    (35 ILCS 120/2-45)  (from Ch. 120, par. 441-45)
    Sec. 2-45. Manufacturing and assembly exemption. The
manufacturing and assembly machinery and equipment exemption
includes machinery and equipment that replaces machinery and
equipment in an existing manufacturing facility as well as
machinery and equipment that are for use in an expanded or new
manufacturing facility.
    The machinery and equipment exemption also includes
machinery and equipment used in the general maintenance or
repair of exempt machinery and equipment or for in-house
manufacture of exempt machinery and equipment. For the purposes
of this exemption, terms have the following meanings:
        (1) "Manufacturing process" means the production of an
    article of tangible personal property, whether the article
    is a finished product or an article for use in the process
    of manufacturing or assembling a different article of
    tangible personal property, by a procedure commonly
    regarded as manufacturing, processing, fabricating, or
    refining that changes some existing material or materials
    into a material with a different form, use, or name. In
    relation to a recognized integrated business composed of a
    series of operations that collectively constitute
    manufacturing, or individually constitute manufacturing
    operations, the manufacturing process commences with the
    first operation or stage of production in the series and
    does not end until the completion of the final product in
    the last operation or stage of production in the series.
    For purposes of this exemption, photoprocessing is a
    manufacturing process of tangible personal property for
    wholesale or retail sale.
        (2) "Assembling process" means the production of an
    article of tangible personal property, whether the article
    is a finished product or an article for use in the process
    of manufacturing or assembling a different article of
    tangible personal property, by the combination of existing
    materials in a manner commonly regarded as assembling that
    results in a material of a different form, use, or name.
        (3) "Machinery" means major mechanical machines or
    major components of those machines contributing to a
    manufacturing or assembling process.
        (4) "Equipment" includes an independent device or tool
    separate from machinery but essential to an integrated
    manufacturing or assembly process; including computers
    used primarily in a manufacturer's computer assisted
    design, computer assisted manufacturing (CAD/CAM) system;
    any subunit or assembly comprising a component of any
    machinery or auxiliary, adjunct, or attachment parts of
    machinery, such as tools, dies, jigs, fixtures, patterns,
    and molds; and any parts that require periodic replacement
    in the course of normal operation; but does not include
    hand tools. Equipment includes chemicals or chemicals
    acting as catalysts but only if the chemicals or chemicals
    acting as catalysts effect a direct and immediate change
    upon a product being manufactured or assembled for
    wholesale or retail sale or lease.
        (5) "Production related tangible personal property"
    means all tangible personal property that is used or
    consumed by the purchaser in a manufacturing facility in
    which a manufacturing process takes place and includes,
    without limitation, tangible personal property that is
    purchased for incorporation into real estate within a
    manufacturing facility and tangible personal property that
    is used or consumed in activities such as research and
    development, preproduction material handling, receiving,
    quality control, inventory control, storage, staging, and
    packaging for shipping and transportation purposes.
    "Production related tangible personal property" does not
    include (i) tangible personal property that is used, within
    or without a manufacturing facility, in sales, purchasing,
    accounting, fiscal management, marketing, personnel
    recruitment or selection, or landscaping or (ii) tangible
    personal property that is required to be titled or
    registered with a department, agency, or unit of federal,
    State, or local government.
    The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment
exemption includes production related tangible personal
property that is purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or
before June 30, 2008. The exemption for production related
tangible personal property is subject to both of the following
limitations:
        (1) The maximum amount of the exemption for any one
    taxpayer may not exceed 5% of the purchase price of
    production related tangible personal property that is
    purchased on or after July 1, 2007 and on or before June
    30, 2008. A credit under Section 3-85 of this Act may not
    be earned by the purchase of production related tangible
    personal property for which an exemption is received under
    this Section.
        (2) The maximum aggregate amount of the exemptions for
    production related tangible personal property awarded
    under this Act and the Retailers' Occupation Tax Act to all
    taxpayers may not exceed $10,000,000. If the claims for the
    exemption exceed $10,000,000, then the Department shall
    reduce the amount of the exemption to each taxpayer on a
    pro rata basis.
The Department may adopt rules to implement and administer the
exemption for production related tangible personal property.
    The manufacturing and assembling machinery and equipment
exemption includes the sale of materials to a purchaser who
produces exempted types of machinery, equipment, or tools and
who rents or leases that machinery, equipment, or tools to a
manufacturer of tangible personal property. This exemption
also includes the sale of materials to a purchaser who
manufactures those materials into an exempted type of
machinery, equipment, or tools that the purchaser uses himself
or herself in the manufacturing of tangible personal property.
The purchaser of the machinery and equipment who has an active
resale registration number shall furnish that number to the
seller at the time of purchase. A purchaser of the machinery,
equipment, and tools without an active resale registration
number shall furnish to the seller a certificate of exemption
for each transaction stating facts establishing the exemption
for that transaction, and that certificate shall be available
to the Department for inspection or audit. Informal rulings,
opinions, or letters issued by the Department in response to an
inquiry or request for an opinion from any person regarding the
coverage and applicability of this exemption to specific
devices shall be published, maintained as a public record, and
made available for public inspection and copying. If the
informal ruling, opinion, or letter contains trade secrets or
other confidential information, where possible, the Department
shall delete that information before publication. Whenever
informal rulings, opinions, or letters contain a policy of
general applicability, the Department shall formulate and
adopt that policy as a rule in accordance with the Illinois
Administrative Procedure Act.
(Source: P.A. 91-51, eff. 6-30-99; 92-484, eff. 8-23-01.)
 
    Section 5-20. The School Code is amended by adding Sections
2-3.143, 2-3.146, 10-20.40, 10-20.41, and 21-29 and by changing
Sections 2-3.51.5, 2-3.127a, 2-3.131 (as added by Public Act
93-21), 7-14A, 11E-135, 14-13.01, and 18-8.05 as follows:
 
    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.51.5)
    Sec. 2-3.51.5. School Safety and Educational Improvement
Block Grant Program. To improve the level of education and
safety of students from kindergarten through grade 12 in school
districts and State-recognized, non-public schools. The State
Board of Education is authorized to fund a School Safety and
Educational Improvement Block Grant Program.
    (1) For school districts, the The program shall provide
funding for school safety, textbooks and software, teacher
training and curriculum development, school improvements,
remediation programs under subsection (a) of Section 2-3.64,
school report cards under Section 10-17a, and criminal history
records checks under Sections 10-21.9 and 34-18.5. For
State-recognized, non-public schools, the program shall
provide funding for secular textbooks and software, criminal
history records checks, and health and safety mandates to the
extent that the funds are expended for purely secular purposes.
A school district or laboratory school as defined in Section
18-8 or 18-8.05 is not required to file an application in order
to receive the categorical funding to which it is entitled
under this Section. Funds for the School Safety and Educational
Improvement Block Grant Program shall be distributed to school
districts and laboratory schools based on the prior year's best
3 months average daily attendance. Funds for the School Safety
and Educational Improvement Block Grant Program shall be
distributed to State-recognized, non-public schools based on
the average daily attendance figure for the previous school
year provided to the State Board of Education. The State Board
of Education shall develop an application that requires
State-recognized, non-public schools to submit average daily
attendance figures. A State-recognized, non-public school must
submit the application and average daily attendance figure
prior to receiving funds under this Section. The State Board of
Education shall promulgate rules and regulations necessary for
the implementation of this program.
    (2) Distribution of moneys to school districts and
State-recognized, non-public schools shall be made in 2
semi-annual installments, one payment on or before October 30,
and one payment prior to April 30, of each fiscal year.
    (3) Grants under the School Safety and Educational
Improvement Block Grant Program shall be awarded provided there
is an appropriation for the program, and funding levels for
each district shall be prorated according to the amount of the
appropriation.
    (4) The provisions of this Section are in the public
interest, are for the public benefit, and serve secular public
purposes.
(Source: P.A. 93-909, eff. 8-12-04.)
 
    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.127a)
    Sec. 2-3.127a. The State Board of Education Special Purpose
Trust Fund. The State Board of Education Special Purpose Trust
Fund is created as a special fund in the State treasury. The
State Board of Education shall deposit all indirect costs
recovered from federal programs into the State Board of
Education Special Purpose Trust Fund. These funds may be used
by the State Board of Education for its ordinary and contingent
expenses. Additionally and unless Unless specifically directed
to be deposited into other funds, all moneys received by the
State Board of Education from gifts, grants, or donations from
any source, public or private, shall be deposited into the
State Board of Education Special Purpose Trust Fund this Fund.
These funds Moneys in this Fund shall be used, subject to
appropriation by the General Assembly, by the State Board of
Education for the purposes established by the gifts, grants, or
donations.
(Source: P.A. 94-69, eff. 7-1-05.)
 
    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.131)
    Sec. 2-3.131. Transitional assistance payments.
    (a) If the amount that the State Board of Education will
pay to a school district from fiscal year 2004 appropriations,
as estimated by the State Board of Education on April 1, 2004,
is less than the amount that the State Board of Education paid
to the school district from fiscal year 2003 appropriations,
then, subject to appropriation, the State Board of Education
shall make a fiscal year 2004 transitional assistance payment
to the school district in an amount equal to the difference
between the estimated amount to be paid from fiscal year 2004
appropriations and the amount paid from fiscal year 2003
appropriations.
    (b) If the amount that the State Board of Education will
pay to a school district from fiscal year 2005 appropriations,
as estimated by the State Board of Education on April 1, 2005,
is less than the amount that the State Board of Education paid
to the school district from fiscal year 2004 appropriations,
then the State Board of Education shall make a fiscal year 2005
transitional assistance payment to the school district in an
amount equal to the difference between the estimated amount to
be paid from fiscal year 2005 appropriations and the amount
paid from fiscal year 2004 appropriations.
    (c) If the amount that the State Board of Education will
pay to a school district from fiscal year 2006 appropriations,
as estimated by the State Board of Education on April 1, 2006,
is less than the amount that the State Board of Education paid
to the school district from fiscal year 2005 appropriations,
then the State Board of Education shall make a fiscal year 2006
transitional assistance payment to the school district in an
amount equal to the difference between the estimated amount to
be paid from fiscal year 2006 appropriations and the amount
paid from fiscal year 2005 appropriations.
    (d) If the amount that the State Board of Education will
pay to a school district from fiscal year 2007 appropriations,
as estimated by the State Board of Education on April 1, 2007,
is less than the amount that the State Board of Education paid
to the school district from fiscal year 2006 appropriations,
then the State Board of Education, subject to appropriation,
shall make a fiscal year 2007 transitional assistance payment
to the school district in an amount equal to the difference
between the estimated amount to be paid from fiscal year 2007
appropriations and the amount paid from fiscal year 2006
appropriations.
    (e) Subject to appropriation, beginning on July 1, 2007,
the State Board of Education shall adjust prior year
information for the transitional assistance calculations under
this Section in the event of the creation or reorganization of
any school district pursuant to Article 11E of this Code, the
dissolution of an entire district and the annexation of all of
its territory to one or more other districts pursuant to
Article 7 of this Code, or a boundary change whereby the
enrollment of the annexing district increases by 90% or more as
a result of annexing territory detached from another district
pursuant to Article 7 of this Code.
    (f) If the amount that the State Board of Education will
pay to a school district from fiscal year 2008 appropriations,
as estimated by the State Board of Education on April 1, 2008,
is less than the amount that the State Board of Education paid
to the school district from fiscal year 2007 appropriations,
then the State Board of Education, subject to appropriation,
shall make a fiscal year 2008 transitional assistance payment
to the school district in an amount equal to the difference
between the estimated amount to be paid from fiscal year 2008
appropriations and the amount paid from fiscal year 2007
appropriations.
(Source: P.A. 93-21, eff. 7-1-03; 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 94-69,
eff. 7-1-05; 94-835, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.143 new)
    Sec. 2-3.143. Lincoln's ChalleNGe Academy study. The State
Board of Education shall conduct a study to consider the need
for an expansion of enrollment at or the replication of
services in other portions of this State for the Lincoln's
ChalleNGe Academy as an alternative program for students who
have dropped out of traditional school.
 
    (105 ILCS 5/2-3.146 new)
    Sec. 2-3.146. Severely overcrowded schools grant program.
There is created a grant program, subject to appropriation, for
severely overcrowded schools. The State Board of Education
shall administer the program. Grant funds may be used for
purposes of relieving overcrowding. In order for a school
district to be eligible for a grant under this Section, (i) the
main administrative office of the district must be located in a
city of 85,000 or more in population, according to the 2000
U.S. Census, (ii) the school district must have a district-wide
percentage of low-income students of 70% or more, as identified
by the 2005-2006 School Report Cards published by the State
Board of Education, and (iii) the school district must not be
eligible for a fast growth grant under Section 18-8.10 of this
Code. The State Board of Education shall distribute the funds
on a proportional basis with no single district receiving more
than 75% of the funds in any given year. The State Board of
Education may adopt rules as needed for the implementation and
distribution of grants under this Section.
 
    (105 ILCS 5/7-14A)  (from Ch. 122, par. 7-14A)
    Sec. 7-14A. Annexation Compensation. There shall be no
accounting made after a mere change in boundaries when no new
district is created, except that those districts whose
enrollment increases by 90% or more as a result of annexing
territory detached from another district pursuant to this
Article are eligible for supplementary State aid payments in
accordance with Section 11E-135 of this Code. Eligible annexing
districts shall apply to the State Board of Education for
supplementary State aid payments by submitting enrollment
figures for the year immediately preceding and the year
immediately following the effective date of the boundary change
for both the district gaining territory and the district losing
territory. Copies of any intergovernmental agreements between
the district gaining territory and the district losing
territory detailing any transfer of fund balances and staff
must also be submitted. In all instances of changes in
boundaries, . However, the district losing territory shall not
count the average daily attendance of pupils living in the
territory during the year preceding the effective date of the
boundary change in its claim for reimbursement under Section
18-8 for the school year following the effective date of the
change in boundaries and the district receiving the territory
shall count the average daily attendance of pupils living in
the territory during the year preceding the effective date of
the boundary change in its claim for reimbursement under
Section 18-8 for the school year following the effective date
of the change in boundaries. The changes to this Section made
by this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are
intended to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation
taking effect on or after July 1, 2004.
(Source: P.A. 84-1250.)
 
    (105 ILCS 5/10-20.40 new)
    Sec. 10-20.40. Report on contracts.
    (a) This Section applies to all school districts, including
a school district organized under Article 34 of this Code.
    (b) A school board must list on the district's Internet
website, if any, all contracts over $25,000 and any contract
that the school board enters into with an exclusive bargaining
representative.
    (c) Each year, in conjunction with the submission of the
Statement of Affairs to the State Board of Education prior to
December, 1 provided for in Section 10-17, each school district
shall submit to the State Board of Education an annual report
on all contracts over $25,000 awarded by the school district
during the previous fiscal year. The report shall include at
least the following:
        (1) the total number of all contracts awarded by the
    school district;
        (2) the total value of all contracts awarded;
        (3) the number of contracts awarded to minority owned
    businesses, female owned businesses, and businesses owned
    by persons with disabilities, as defined in the Business
    Enterprise for Minorities, Females and Persons with
    Disabilities Act, and locally owned businesses; and
        (4) the total value of contracts awarded to minority
    owned businesses, female owned businesses, and businesses
    owned by persons with disabilities, as defined in the
    Business Enterprise for Minorities, Females and Persons
    with Disabilities Act, and locally owned businesses.
    The report shall be made available to the public, including
publication on the school district's Internet website, if any.
 
    (105 ILCS 5/10-20.41 new)
    Sec. 10-20.41. Pay for performance.
    (a) Beginning with all newly-negotiated collective
bargaining agreements entered into after the effective date of
this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly, a school
board and the exclusive bargaining representative, if any, may
include a performance-based teacher compensation plan in the
subject of its collective bargaining agreement. Nothing in this
Section shall preclude the school board and the exclusive
bargaining representative from agreeing to and implementing a
new performance-based teacher compensation plan prior to the
termination of the current collective bargaining agreement.
    (b) The new teacher compensation plan bargained and agreed
to by the school board and the exclusive bargaining
representative under subsection (a) of this Section shall
provide certificated personnel with base salaries and shall
also provide that any increases in the compensation of
individual teachers or groups of teachers beyond base salaries
shall be pursuant, but not limited to, any of the following
elements:
        (1) Superior teacher evaluations based on multiple
    evaluations of their classroom teaching.
        (2) Evaluation of a teacher's student classroom-level
    achievement growth as measured using a value-added model.
    "Value-added" means the improvement gains in student
    achievement that are made each year based on pre-test and
    post-test outcomes.
        (3) Evaluation of school-level achievement growth as
    measured using a value-added model. "Value-added" means
    the improvement gains in student achievement that are made
    each year based on pre-test and post-test outcomes.
        (4) Demonstration of superior, outstanding performance
    by an individual teacher or groups of teachers through the
    meeting of unique and specific teaching practice
    objectives defined and agreed to in advance in any given
    school year.
        (5) Preparation for meeting and contribution to the
    broader needs of the school organization (e.g., curriculum
    development, family liaison and community outreach,
    implementation of a professional development program for
    faculty, and participation in school management).
    (c) A school board and exclusive bargaining representative
that initiate their own performance-based teacher compensation
program shall submit the new plan to the State Board of
Education for review not later than 150 days before the plan is
to become effective. If the plan does not conform to this
Section, the State Board of Education shall return the plan to
the school board and the exclusive bargaining representative
for modification. The school board and the exclusive bargaining
representative shall then have 30 days after the plan is
returned to them to submit a modified plan.
 
    (105 ILCS 5/11E-135)
    Sec. 11E-135. Incentives. For districts reorganizing under
this Article and for a district or districts that annex all of
the territory of one or more entire other school districts in
accordance with Article 7 of this Code, the following payments
shall be made from appropriations made for these purposes:
    (a)(1) For a combined school district, as defined in
Section 11E-20 of this Code, or for a unit district, as defined
in Section 11E-25 of this Code, for its first year of
existence, the general State aid and supplemental general State
aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code shall be
computed for the new district and for the previously existing
districts for which property is totally included within the new
district. If the computation on the basis of the previously
existing districts is greater, a supplementary payment equal to
the difference shall be made for the first 4 years of existence
of the new district.
    (2) For a school district that annexes all of the territory
of one or more entire other school districts as defined in
Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during which the
change of boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes
effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9 of
this Code, the general State aid and supplemental general State
aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code shall be
computed for the annexing district as constituted after the
annexation and for the annexing and each annexed district as
constituted prior to the annexation; and if the computation on
the basis of the annexing and annexed districts as constituted
prior to the annexation is greater, then a supplementary
payment equal to the difference shall be made for the first 4
years of existence of the annexing school district as
constituted upon the annexation.
    (3) For 2 or more school districts that annex all of the
territory of one or more entire other school districts, as
defined in Article 7 of this Code, for the first year during
which the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation
becomes effective for all purposes, as determined under Section
7-9 of this Code, the general State aid and supplemental
general State aid calculated under Section 18-8.05 of this Code
shall be computed for each annexing district as constituted
after the annexation and for each annexing and annexed district
as constituted prior to the annexation; and if the aggregate of
the general State aid and supplemental general State aid as so
computed for the annexing districts as constituted after the
annexation is less than the aggregate of the general State aid
and supplemental general State aid as so computed for the
annexing and annexed districts, as constituted prior to the
annexation, then a supplementary payment equal to the
difference shall be made and allocated between or among the
annexing districts, as constituted upon the annexation, for the
first 4 years of their existence. The total difference payment
shall be allocated between or among the annexing districts in
the same ratio as the pupil enrollment from that portion of the
annexed district or districts that is annexed to each annexing
district bears to the total pupil enrollment from the entire
annexed district or districts, as such pupil enrollment is
determined for the school year last ending prior to the date
when the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation
becomes effective for all purposes. The amount of the total
difference payment and the amount thereof to be allocated to
the annexing districts shall be computed by the State Board of
Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other data that
shall be certified to the State Board of Education, on forms
that it shall provide for that purpose, by the regional
superintendent of schools for each educational service region
in which the annexing and annexed districts are located.
    (4) For a school district conversion, as defined in Section
11E-15 of this Code, or a multi-unit conversion, as defined in
subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if in their
first year of existence the newly created elementary districts
and the newly created high school district, from a school
district conversion, or the newly created elementary district
or districts and newly created combined high school - unit
district, from a multi-unit conversion, qualify for less
general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of this Code than would
have been payable under Section 18-8.05 for that same year to
the previously existing districts, then a supplementary
payment equal to that difference shall be made for the first 4
years of existence of the newly created districts. The
aggregate amount of each supplementary payment shall be
allocated among the newly created districts in the proportion
that the deemed pupil enrollment in each district during its
first year of existence bears to the actual aggregate pupil
enrollment in all of the districts during their first year of
existence. For purposes of each allocation:
        (A) the deemed pupil enrollment of the newly created
    high school district from a school district conversion
    shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for
    its first year of existence multiplied by 1.25;
        (B) the deemed pupil enrollment of each newly created
    elementary district from a school district conversion
    shall be an amount equal to its actual pupil enrollment for
    its first year of existence reduced by an amount equal to
    the product obtained when the amount by which the newly
    created high school district's deemed pupil enrollment
    exceeds its actual pupil enrollment for its first year of
    existence is multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of
    which is the actual pupil enrollment of the newly created
    elementary district for its first year of existence and the
    denominator of which is the actual aggregate pupil
    enrollment of all of the newly created elementary districts
    for their first year of existence;
        (C) the deemed high school pupil enrollment of the
    newly created combined high school - unit district from a
    multi-unit conversion shall be an amount equal to its
    actual grades 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for its first
    year of existence multiplied by 1.25; and
        (D) the deemed elementary pupil enrollment of each
    newly created district from a multi-unit conversion shall
    be an amount equal to each district's actual grade K
    through 8 pupil enrollment for its first year of existence,
    reduced by an amount equal to the product obtained when the
    amount by which the newly created combined high school -
    unit district's deemed high school pupil enrollment
    exceeds its actual grade 9 through 12 pupil enrollment for
    its first year of existence is multiplied by a fraction,
    the numerator of which is the actual grade K through 8
    pupil enrollment of each newly created district for its
    first year of existence and the denominator of which is the
    actual aggregate grade K through 8 pupil enrollment of all
    such newly created districts for their first year of
    existence.
     The aggregate amount of each supplementary payment under
this subdivision (4) and the amount thereof to be allocated to
the newly created districts shall be computed by the State
Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment and other
data, which shall be certified to the State Board of Education,
on forms that it shall provide for that purpose, by the
regional superintendent of schools for each educational
service region in which the newly created districts are
located.
    (5) For a partial elementary unit district, as defined in
subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, if, in
the first year of existence, the newly created partial
elementary unit district qualifies for less general State aid
and supplemental general State aid under Section 18-8.05 of
this Code than would have been payable under that Section for
that same year to the previously existing districts that formed
the partial elementary unit district, then a supplementary
payment equal to that difference shall be made to the partial
elementary unit district for the first 4 years of existence of
that newly created district.
    (6) For an elementary opt-in, as described in subsection
(d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the general State aid
difference shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (5)
of this subsection (a) as if the elementary opt-in was included
in an optional elementary unit district at the optional
elementary unit district's original effective date. If the
calculation in this paragraph (6) is less than that calculated
in paragraph (5) of this subsection (a) at the optional
elementary unit district's original effective date, then no
adjustments may be made. If the calculation in this paragraph
(6) is more than that calculated in paragraph (5) of this
subsection (a) at the optional elementary unit district's
original effective date, then the excess must be paid as
follows:
        (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    one year after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    2 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    3 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    4 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    5 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit
    district is not eligible for any additional incentives due
    to the elementary opt-in.
    (6.5) For a school district that annexes territory detached
from another school district whereby the enrollment of the
annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of the
annexation, for the first year during which the change of
boundaries attributable to the annexation becomes effective
for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of this Code,
the general State aid and supplemental general State aid
calculated under this Section shall be computed for the
district gaining territory and the district losing territory as
constituted after the annexation and for the same districts as
constituted prior to the annexation; and if the aggregate of
the general State aid and supplemental general State aid as so
computed for the district gaining territory and the district
losing territory as constituted after the annexation is less
than the aggregate of the general State aid and supplemental
general State aid as so computed for the district gaining
territory and the district losing territory as constituted
prior to the annexation, then a supplementary payment shall be
made to the annexing district for the first 4 years of
existence after the annexation, equal to the difference
multiplied by the ratio of student enrollment in the territory
detached to the total student enrollment in the district losing
territory for the year prior to the effective date of the
annexation. The amount of the total difference and the
proportion paid to the annexing district shall be computed by
the State Board of Education on the basis of pupil enrollment
and other data that must be submitted to the State Board of
Education in accordance with Section 7-14A of this Code. The
changes to this Section made by this amendatory Act of the 95th
General Assembly are intended to be retroactive and applicable
to any annexation taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For
annexations that are eligible for payments under this paragraph
(6.5) and that are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but
before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th
General Assembly, the first required yearly payment under this
paragraph (6.5) shall be paid in the fiscal year of the
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General
Assembly. Subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid in
subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under this
paragraph (6.5) is complete.
    (7) Claims for financial assistance under this subsection
(a) may not be recomputed except as expressly provided under
Section 18-8.05 of this Code.
    (8) Any supplementary payment made under this subsection
(a) must be treated as separate from all other payments made
pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code.
    (b)(1) After the formation of a combined school district,
as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, or a unit district,
as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a computation shall
be made to determine the difference between the salaries
effective in each of the previously existing districts on June
30, prior to the creation of the new district. For the first 4
years after the formation of the new district, a supplementary
State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the new district equal
to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by
each of the certificated members of the new district, while
employed in one of the previously existing districts during the
year immediately preceding the formation of the new district,
and the sum of the salaries those certificated members would
have been paid during the year immediately prior to the
formation of the new district if placed on the salary schedule
of the previously existing district with the highest salary
schedule.
    (2) After the territory of one or more school districts is
annexed by one or more other school districts as defined in
Article 7 of this Code, a computation shall be made to
determine the difference between the salaries effective in each
annexed district and in the annexing district or districts as
they were each constituted on June 30 preceding the date when
the change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became
effective for all purposes, as determined under Section 7-9 of
this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to each
annexing district as constituted after the annexation equal to
the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by each
of the certificated members of the annexing district as
constituted after the annexation, while employed in an annexed
or annexing district during the year immediately preceding the
annexation, and the sum of the salaries those certificated
members would have been paid during the immediately preceding
year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the
annexing or annexed districts had the highest salary schedule
during the immediately preceding year.
    (3) For each new high school district formed under a school
district conversion, as defined in Section 11E-15 of this Code,
the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4 years equal
to the difference between the sum of the salaries earned by
each certified member of the new high school district, while
employed in one of the previously existing districts, and the
sum of the salaries those certified members would have been
paid if placed on the salary schedule of the previously
existing district with the highest salary schedule.
    (4) For each newly created partial elementary unit
district, the State shall make a supplementary payment for 4
years equal to the difference between the sum of the salaries
earned by each certified member of the newly created partial
elementary unit district, while employed in one of the
previously existing districts that formed the partial
elementary unit district, and the sum of the salaries those
certified members would have been paid if placed on the salary
schedule of the previously existing district with the highest
salary schedule. The salary schedules used in the calculation
shall be those in effect in the previously existing districts
for the school year prior to the creation of the new partial
elementary unit district.
    (5) For an elementary district opt-in, as described in
subsection (d) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the salary
difference incentive shall be computed in accordance with
paragraph (4) of this subsection (b) as if the opted-in
elementary district was included in the optional elementary
unit district at the optional elementary unit district's
original effective date. If the calculation in this paragraph
(5) is less than that calculated in paragraph (4) of this
subsection (b) at the optional elementary unit district's
original effective date, then no adjustments may be made. If
the calculation in this paragraph (5) is more than that
calculated in paragraph (4) of this subsection (b) at the
optional elementary unit district's original effective date,
then the excess must be paid as follows:
        (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    one year after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    2 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    3 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    each of the first 4 years after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    4 years after the effective date for the partial elementary
    unit district, 25% of the calculated excess shall be paid
    to the optional elementary unit district in each of the
    first 4 years after the effective date of the elementary
    opt-in.
        (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    5 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit
    district is not eligible for any additional incentives due
    to the elementary opt-in.
    (5.5) (b-5) After the formation of a cooperative high
school by 2 or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of
this Code, a computation shall be made to determine the
difference between the salaries effective in each of the
previously existing high schools on June 30 prior to the
formation of the cooperative high school. For the first 4 years
after the formation of the cooperative high school, a
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
cooperative high school equal to the difference between the sum
of the salaries earned by each of the certificated members of
the cooperative high school while employed in one of the
previously existing high schools during the year immediately
preceding the formation of the cooperative high school and the
sum of the salaries those certificated members would have been
paid during the year immediately prior to the formation of the
cooperative high school if placed on the salary schedule of the
previously existing high school with the highest salary
schedule.
    (5.10) After the annexation of territory detached from
another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
district increases by 90% or more as a result of the
annexation, a computation shall be made to determine the
difference between the salaries effective in the district
gaining territory and the district losing territory as they
each were constituted on June 30 preceding the date when the
change of boundaries attributable to the annexation became
effective for all purposes as determined under Section 7-9 of
this Code. For the first 4 years after the annexation, a
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
annexing district equal to the difference between the sum of
the salaries earned by each of the certificated members of the
annexing district as constituted after the annexation while
employed in the district gaining territory or the district
losing territory during the year immediately preceding the
annexation and the sum of the salaries those certificated
members would have been paid during such immediately preceding
year if placed on the salary schedule of whichever of the
district gaining territory or district losing territory had the
highest salary schedule during the immediately preceding year.
To be eligible for supplementary State aid reimbursement under
this Section, the intergovernmental agreement to be submitted
pursuant to Section 7-14A of this Code must show that staff
members were transferred from the control of the district
losing territory to the control of the district gaining
territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
by this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are
intended to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation
taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that
are eligible for payments under this paragraph (5.10) and that
are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but before the
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General
Assembly, the first required yearly payment under this
paragraph (5.10) shall be paid in the fiscal year of the
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General
Assembly. Subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid in
subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under this
paragraph (5.10) is complete.
    (6) The supplementary State aid reimbursement under this
subsection (b) shall be treated as separate from all other
payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code. In the
case of the formation of a new district or cooperative high
school, reimbursement shall begin during the first year of
operation of the new district or cooperative high school, and
in the case of an annexation of the territory of one or more
school districts by one or more other school districts or the
annexation of territory detached from a school district whereby
the enrollment of the annexing district increases by 90% or
more as a result of the annexation, reimbursement shall begin
during the first year when the change in boundaries
attributable to the annexation or division becomes effective
for all purposes as determined pursuant to Section 7-9 of this
Code, except that for an annexation of territory detached from
a school district that is effective on or after July 1, 2004,
but before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the
95th General Assembly, whereby the enrollment of the annexing
district increases by 90% or more as a result of the
annexation, reimbursement shall begin during the fiscal year of
the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General
Assembly. Each year that the new, annexing, or resulting
district or cooperative high school, as the case may be, is
entitled to receive reimbursement, the number of eligible
certified members who are employed on October 1 in the district
or cooperative high school shall be certified to the State
Board of Education on prescribed forms by October 15 and
payment shall be made on or before November 15 of that year.
    (c)(1) For the first year after the formation of a combined
school district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code or a
unit district, as defined in Section 11E-25 of this Code, a
computation shall be made totaling each previously existing
district's audited fund balances in the educational fund,
working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and
transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the
referendum for the creation of the new district. The new
district shall be paid supplementary State aid equal to the sum
of the differences between the deficit of the previously
existing district with the smallest deficit and the deficits of
each of the other previously existing districts.
    (2) For the first year after the annexation of all of the
territory of one or more entire school districts by another
school district, as defined in Article 7 of this Code,
computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior
to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the
annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision issued by the
regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this
Code, notwithstanding any effort to seek administrative review
of the decision, totaling the annexing district's and totaling
each annexed district's audited fund balances in their
respective educational, working cash, operations and
maintenance, and transportation funds. The annexing district
as constituted after the annexation shall be paid supplementary
State aid equal to the sum of the differences between the
deficit of whichever of the annexing or annexed districts as
constituted prior to the annexation had the smallest deficit
and the deficits of each of the other districts as constituted
prior to the annexation.
    (3) For the first year after the annexation of all of the
territory of one or more entire school districts by 2 or more
other school districts, as defined by Article 7 of this Code,
computations shall be made, for the year ending June 30 prior
to the date that the change of boundaries attributable to the
annexation is allowed by the affirmative decision of the
regional board of school trustees under Section 7-6 of this
Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative review of
the decision, totaling each annexing and annexed district's
audited fund balances in their respective educational, working
cash, operations and maintenance, and transportation funds.
The annexing districts as constituted after the annexation
shall be paid supplementary State aid, allocated as provided in
this paragraph (3), in an aggregate amount equal to the sum of
the differences between the deficit of whichever of the
annexing or annexed districts as constituted prior to the
annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficits of each of
the other districts as constituted prior to the annexation. The
aggregate amount of the supplementary State aid payable under
this paragraph (3) shall be allocated between or among the
annexing districts as follows:
        (A) the regional superintendent of schools for each
    educational service region in which an annexed district is
    located prior to the annexation shall certify to the State
    Board of Education, on forms that it shall provide for that
    purpose, the value of all taxable property in each annexed
    district, as last equalized or assessed by the Department
    of Revenue prior to the annexation, and the equalized
    assessed value of each part of the annexed district that
    was annexed to or included as a part of an annexing
    district;
        (B) using equalized assessed values as certified by the
    regional superintendent of schools under clause (A) of this
    paragraph (3), the combined audited fund balance deficit of
    each annexed district as determined under this Section
    shall be apportioned between or among the annexing
    districts in the same ratio as the equalized assessed value
    of that part of the annexed district that was annexed to or
    included as a part of an annexing district bears to the
    total equalized assessed value of the annexed district; and
        (C) the aggregate supplementary State aid payment
    under this paragraph (3) shall be allocated between or
    among, and shall be paid to, the annexing districts in the
    same ratio as the sum of the combined audited fund balance
    deficit of each annexing district as constituted prior to
    the annexation, plus all combined audited fund balance
    deficit amounts apportioned to that annexing district
    under clause (B) of this subsection, bears to the aggregate
    of the combined audited fund balance deficits of all of the
    annexing and annexed districts as constituted prior to the
    annexation.
    (4) For the new elementary districts and new high school
district formed through a school district conversion, as
defined in subsection (b) of Section 11E-15 of this Code or the
new elementary district or districts and new combined high
school - unit district formed through a multi-unit conversion,
as defined in subsection (b) of Section 11E-30 of this Code, a
computation shall be made totaling each previously existing
district's audited fund balances in the educational fund,
working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and
transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the
referendum establishing the new districts. In the first year of
the new districts, the State shall make a one-time
supplementary payment equal to the sum of the differences
between the deficit of the previously existing district with
the smallest deficit and the deficits of each of the other
previously existing districts. A district with a combined
balance among the 4 funds that is positive shall be considered
to have a deficit of zero. The supplementary payment shall be
allocated among the newly formed high school and elementary
districts in the manner provided by the petition for the
formation of the districts, in the form in which the petition
is approved by the regional superintendent of schools or State
Superintendent of Education under Section 11E-50 of this Code.
    (5) For each newly created partial elementary unit
district, as defined in subsection (a) or (c) of Section 11E-30
of this Code, a computation shall be made totaling the audited
fund balances of each previously existing district that formed
the new partial elementary unit district in the educational
fund, working cash fund, operations and maintenance fund, and
transportation fund for the year ending June 30 prior to the
referendum for the formation of the partial elementary unit
district. In the first year of the new partial elementary unit
district, the State shall make a one-time supplementary payment
to the new district equal to the sum of the differences between
the deficit of the previously existing district with the
smallest deficit and the deficits of each of the other
previously existing districts. A district with a combined
balance among the 4 funds that is positive shall be considered
to have a deficit of zero.
    (6) For an elementary opt-in as defined in subsection (d)
of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the deficit fund balance
incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (5) of
this subsection (c) as if the opted-in elementary was included
in the optional elementary unit district at the optional
elementary unit district's original effective date. If the
calculation in this paragraph (6) is less than that calculated
in paragraph (5) of this subsection (c) at the optional
elementary unit district's original effective date, then no
adjustments may be made. If the calculation in this paragraph
(6) is more than that calculated in paragraph (5) of this
subsection (c) at the optional elementary unit district's
original effective date, then the excess must be paid as
follows:
        (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    one year after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 100% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    the first year after the effective date of the elementary
    opt-in.
        (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    2 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 75% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    the first year after the effective date of the elementary
    opt-in.
        (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    3 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 50% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    the first year after the effective date of the elementary
    opt-in.
        (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    4 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 25% of the calculated excess
    shall be paid to the optional elementary unit district in
    the first year after the effective date of the elementary
    opt-in.
        (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    5 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit
    district is not eligible for any additional incentives due
    to the elementary opt-in.
    (6.5) For the first year after the annexation of territory
detached from another school district whereby the enrollment of
the annexing district increases by 90% or more as a result of
the annexation, a computation shall be made totaling the
audited fund balances of the district gaining territory and the
audited fund balances of the district losing territory in the
educational fund, working cash fund, operations and
maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the year ending
June 30 prior to the date that the change of boundaries
attributable to the annexation is allowed by the affirmative
decision of the regional board of school trustees under Section
7-6 of this Code, notwithstanding any action for administrative
review of the decision. The annexing district as constituted
after the annexation shall be paid supplementary State aid
equal to the difference between the deficit of whichever
district included in this calculation as constituted prior to
the annexation had the smallest deficit and the deficit of each
other district included in this calculation as constituted
prior to the annexation, multiplied by the ratio of equalized
assessed value of the territory detached to the total equalized
assessed value of the district losing territory. The regional
superintendent of schools for the educational service region in
which a district losing territory is located prior to the
annexation shall certify to the State Board of Education the
value of all taxable property in the district losing territory
and the value of all taxable property in the territory being
detached, as last equalized or assessed by the Department of
Revenue prior to the annexation. To be eligible for
supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
Section 7-14A of this Code must show that fund balances were
transferred from the district losing territory to the district
gaining territory in the annexation. The changes to this
Section made by this amendatory Act of the 95th General
Assembly are intended to be retroactive and applicable to any
annexation taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For
annexations that are eligible for payments under this paragraph
(6.5) and that are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but
before the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th
General Assembly, the required payment under this paragraph
(6.5) shall be paid in the fiscal year of the effective date of
this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly.
    (7) For purposes of any calculation required under
paragraph (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), or (6), or (6.5) of this
subsection (c), a district with a combined fund balance that is
positive shall be considered to have a deficit of zero. For
purposes of determining each district's audited fund balances
in its educational fund, working cash fund, operations and
maintenance fund, and transportation fund for the specified
year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3),
(4), (5), and (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c), the
balance of each fund shall be deemed decreased by an amount
equal to the amount of the annual property tax theretofore
levied in the fund by the district for collection and payment
to the district during the calendar year in which the June 30
fell, but only to the extent that the tax so levied in the fund
actually was received by the district on or before or comprised
a part of the fund on such June 30. For purposes of determining
each district's audited fund balances, a calculation shall be
made for each fund to determine the average for the 3 years
prior to the specified year ending June 30, as provided in
paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), and (6), and (6.5) of this
subsection (c), of the district's expenditures in the
categories "purchased services", "supplies and materials", and
"capital outlay", as those categories are defined in rules of
the State Board of Education. If this 3-year average is less
than the district's expenditures in these categories for the
specified year ending June 30, as provided in paragraphs (1),
(2), (3), (4), (5), and (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c),
then the 3-year average shall be used in calculating the
amounts payable under this Section in place of the amounts
shown in these categories for the specified year ending June
30, as provided in paragraphs (1), (2), (3), (4), (5), and (6),
and (6.5) of this subsection (c). Any deficit because of State
aid not yet received may not be considered in determining the
June 30 deficits. The same basis of accounting shall be used by
all previously existing districts and by all annexing or
annexed districts, as constituted prior to the annexation, in
making any computation required under paragraphs (1), (2), (3),
(4), (5), and (6), and (6.5) of this subsection (c).
    (8) The supplementary State aid payments under this
subsection (c) shall be treated as separate from all other
payments made pursuant to Section 18-8.05 of this Code.
    (d)(1) Following the formation of a combined school
district, as defined in Section 11E-20 of this Code, a new
elementary district or districts and a new high school district
formed through a school district conversion, as defined in
subsection (b) of Section 11E-15 of this Code, a new partial
elementary unit district, as defined in Section 11E-30 of this
Code, or a new elementary district or districts formed through
a multi-unit conversion, as defined in subsection (b) of
Section 11E-30 of this Code, or the annexation of all of the
territory of one or more entire school districts by one or more
other school districts, as defined in Article 7 of this Code, a
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid for the

 
number of school years determined under the following table to
each new or annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for
each certified employee who is employed by the district on a
full-time basis for the regular term of the school year:
 
Reorganized District's RankReorganized District's Rank
by type of district (unit,in Average Daily Attendance
high school, elementary)By Quintile
in Equalized Assessed Value
Per Pupil by Quintile
3rd, 4th,
1st2ndor 5th
QuintileQuintileQuintile
    1st Quintile1 year1 year1 year
    2nd Quintile1 year2 years2 years
    3rd Quintile2 years3 years3 years
    4th Quintile2 years3 years3 years
    5th Quintile2 years3 years3 years
The State Board of Education shall make a one-time calculation
of a reorganized district's quintile ranks. The average daily
attendance used in this calculation shall be the best 3 months'
average daily attendance for the district's first year. The
equalized assessed value per pupil shall be the district's real
property equalized assessed value used in calculating the
district's first-year general State aid claim, under Section
18-8.05 of this Code, divided by the best 3 months' average
daily attendance.
    No annexing or resulting school district shall be entitled
to supplementary State aid under this subsection (d) unless the
district acquires at least 30% of the average daily attendance
of the district from which the territory is being detached or
divided.
    If a district results from multiple reorganizations that
would otherwise qualify the district for multiple payments
under this subsection (d) in any year, then the district shall
receive a single payment only for that year based solely on the
most recent reorganization.
    (2) For an elementary opt-in, as defined in subsection (d)
of Section 11E-30 of this Code, the full-time certified staff
incentive shall be computed in accordance with paragraph (1) of
this subsection (d), equal to the sum of $4,000 for each
certified employee of the elementary district that opts-in who
is employed by the optional elementary unit district on a
full-time basis for the regular term of the school year. The
calculation from this paragraph (2) must be paid as follows:
        (A) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    one year after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 100% of the amount calculated in
    this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary
    unit district for the number of years calculated in
    paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional
    elementary unit district's original effective date,
    starting in the second year after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (B) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    2 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 75% of the amount calculated in
    this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary
    unit district for the number of years calculated in
    paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional
    elementary unit district's original effective date,
    starting in the second year after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (C) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    3 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 50% of the amount calculated in
    this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary
    unit district for the number of years calculated in
    paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional
    elementary unit district's original effective date,
    starting in the second year after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (D) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    4 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, 25% of the amount calculated in
    this paragraph (2) shall be paid to the optional elementary
    unit district for the number of years calculated in
    paragraph (1) of this subsection (d) at the optional
    elementary unit district's original effective date,
    starting in the second year after the effective date of the
    elementary opt-in.
        (E) If the effective date for the elementary opt-in is
    5 years after the effective date for the optional
    elementary unit district, the optional elementary unit
    district is not eligible for any additional incentives due
    to the elementary opt-in.
    (2.5) (a-5) Following the formation of a cooperative high
school by 2 or more school districts under Section 10-22.22c of
this Code, a supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be
paid for 3 school years to the cooperative high school equal to
the sum of $4,000 for each certified employee who is employed
by the cooperative high school on a full-time basis for the
regular term of any such school year. If a cooperative high
school results from multiple agreements that would otherwise
qualify the cooperative high school for multiple payments under
this Section in any year, the cooperative high school shall
receive a single payment for that year based solely on the most
recent agreement.
    (2.10) Following the annexation of territory detached from
another school district whereby the enrollment of the annexing
district increases 90% or more as a result of the annexation, a
supplementary State aid reimbursement shall be paid to the
annexing district equal to the sum of $4,000 for each certified
employee who is employed by the annexing district on a
full-time basis and shall be calculated in accordance with
subsection (a) of this Section. To be eligible for
supplementary State aid reimbursement under this Section, the
intergovernmental agreement to be submitted pursuant to
Section 7-14A of this Code must show that certified staff
members were transferred from the control of the district
losing territory to the control of the district gaining
territory in the annexation. The changes to this Section made
by this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly are
intended to be retroactive and applicable to any annexation
taking effect on or after July 1, 2004. For annexations that
are eligible for payments under this paragraph (2.10) and that
are effective on or after July 1, 2004, but before the
effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General
Assembly, the first required yearly payment under this
paragraph (2.10) shall be paid in the second fiscal year after
the effective date of this amendatory Act of the 95th General
Assembly. Any subsequent required yearly payments shall be paid
in subsequent fiscal years until the payment obligation under
this paragraph (2.10) is complete.
    (3) The supplementary State aid reimbursement payable
under this subsection (d) shall be separate from and in
addition to all other payments made to the district pursuant to
any other Section of this Article.
    (4) During May of each school year for which a
supplementary State aid reimbursement is to be paid to a new or
annexing school district or cooperative high school pursuant to
this subsection (d), the school board or governing board shall
certify to the State Board of Education, on forms furnished to
the school board or governing board by the State Board of
Education for purposes of this subsection (d), the number of
certified employees for which the district or cooperative high
school is entitled to reimbursement under this Section,
together with the names, certificate numbers, and positions
held by the certified employees.
    (5) Upon certification by the State Board of Education to
the State Comptroller of the amount of the supplementary State
aid reimbursement to which a school district or cooperative
high school is entitled under this subsection (d), the State
Comptroller shall draw his or her warrant upon the State
Treasurer for the payment thereof to the school district or
cooperative high school and shall promptly transmit the payment
to the school district or cooperative high school through the
appropriate school treasurer.
(Source: P.A. 94-1019, eff. 7-10-06; incorporates P.A. 94-902,
eff. 7-1-06; revised 9-13-06.)
 
    (105 ILCS 5/14-13.01)  (from Ch. 122, par. 14-13.01)
    Sec. 14-13.01. Reimbursement payable by State; Amounts.
Reimbursement for furnishing special educational facilities in
a recognized school to the type of children defined in Section
14-1.02 shall be paid to the school districts in accordance
with Section 14-12.01 for each school year ending June 30 by
the State Comptroller out of any money in the treasury
appropriated for such purposes on the presentation of vouchers
by the State Board of Education.
    The reimbursement shall be limited to funds expended for
construction and maintenance of special education facilities
designed and utilized to house instructional programs,
diagnostic services, other special education services for
children with disabilities and reimbursement as provided in
Section 14-13.01. There shall be no reimbursement for
construction and maintenance of any administrative facility
separated from special education facilities designed and
utilized to house instructional programs, diagnostic services
and other special education services for children with
disabilities.
    (a) For children who have not been identified as eligible
for special education and for eligible children with physical
disabilities, including all eligible children whose placement
has been determined under Section 14-8.02 in hospital or home
instruction, 1/2 of the teacher's salary but not more than
$1,000 annually per child or $8,000 per teacher for the
1985-1986 school year through the 2005-2006 school year and
$1,000 per child or $9,000 per teacher for the 2006-2007 school
year and for each school year and thereafter, whichever is
less. Children to be included in any reimbursement under this
paragraph must regularly receive a minimum of one hour of
instruction each school day, or in lieu thereof of a minimum of
5 hours of instruction in each school week in order to qualify
for full reimbursement under this Section. If the attending
physician for such a child has certified that the child should
not receive as many as 5 hours of instruction in a school week,
however, reimbursement under this paragraph on account of that
child shall be computed proportionate to the actual hours of
instruction per week for that child divided by 5.
    (b) For children described in Section 14-1.02, 4/5 of the
cost of transportation for each such child, whom the State
Superintendent of Education determined in advance requires
special transportation service in order to take advantage of
special educational facilities. Transportation costs shall be
determined in the same fashion as provided in Section 29-5. For
purposes of this subsection (b), the dates for processing
claims specified in Section 29-5 shall apply.
    (c) For each professional worker excluding those included
in subparagraphs (a), (d), (e), and (f) of this Section, the
annual sum of $8,000 for the 1985-1986 school year through the
2005-2006 school year and $9,000 for the 2006-2007 school year
and for each school year and thereafter.
    (d) For one full time qualified director of the special
education program of each school district which maintains a
fully approved program of special education the annual sum of
$8,000 for the 1985-1986 school year through the 2005-2006
school year and $9,000 for the 2006-2007 school year and for
each school year and thereafter. Districts participating in a
joint agreement special education program shall not receive
such reimbursement if reimbursement is made for a director of
the joint agreement program.
    (e) For each school psychologist as defined in Section
14-1.09 the annual sum of $8,000 for the 1985-1986 school year
through the 2005-2006 school year and $9,000 for the 2006-2007
school year and for each school year and thereafter.
    (f) For each qualified teacher working in a fully approved
program for children of preschool age who are deaf or
hard-of-hearing the annual sum of $8,000 for the 1985-1986
school year through the 2005-2006 school year and $9,000 for
the 2006-2007 school year and for each school year and
thereafter.
    (g) For readers, working with blind or partially seeing
children 1/2 of their salary but not more than $400 annually
per child. Readers may be employed to assist such children and
shall not be required to be certified but prior to employment
shall meet standards set up by the State Board of Education.
    (h) For necessary non-certified employees working in any
class or program for children defined in this Article, 1/2 of
the salary paid or $2,800 annually per employee through the
2005-2006 school year and $3,500 per employee for the 2006-2007
school year and for each school year thereafter, whichever is
less.
    The State Board of Education shall set standards and
prescribe rules for determining the allocation of
reimbursement under this section on less than a full time basis
and for less than a school year.
    When any school district eligible for reimbursement under
this Section operates a school or program approved by the State
Superintendent of Education for a number of days in excess of
the adopted school calendar but not to exceed 235 school days,
such reimbursement shall be increased by 1/180 of the amount or
rate paid hereunder for each day such school is operated in
excess of 180 days per calendar year.
    Notwithstanding any other provision of law, any school
district receiving a payment under this Section or under
Section 14-7.02, 14-7.02b, or 29-5 of this Code may classify
all or a portion of the funds that it receives in a particular
fiscal year or from general State aid pursuant to Section
18-8.05 of this Code as funds received in connection with any
funding program for which it is entitled to receive funds from
the State in that fiscal year (including, without limitation,
any funding program referenced in this Section), regardless of
the source or timing of the receipt. The district may not
classify more funds as funds received in connection with the
funding program than the district is entitled to receive in
that fiscal year for that program. Any classification by a
district must be made by a resolution of its board of
education. The resolution must identify the amount of any
payments or general State aid to be classified under this
paragraph and must specify the funding program to which the
funds are to be treated as received in connection therewith.
This resolution is controlling as to the classification of
funds referenced therein. A certified copy of the resolution
must be sent to the State Superintendent of Education. The
resolution shall still take effect even though a copy of the
resolution has not been sent to the State Superintendent of
Education in a timely manner. No classification under this
paragraph by a district shall affect the total amount or timing
of money the district is entitled to receive under this Code.
No classification under this paragraph by a district shall in
any way relieve the district from or affect any requirements
that otherwise would apply with respect to that funding
program, including any accounting of funds by source, reporting
expenditures by original source and purpose, reporting
requirements, or requirements of providing services.
(Source: P.A. 95-415, eff. 8-24-07.)
 
    (105 ILCS 5/18-8.05)
    Sec. 18-8.05. Basis for apportionment of general State
financial aid and supplemental general State aid to the common
schools for the 1998-1999 and subsequent school years.
 
(A) General Provisions.
    (1) The provisions of this Section apply to the 1998-1999
and subsequent school years. The system of general State
financial aid provided for in this Section is designed to
assure that, through a combination of State financial aid and
required local resources, the financial support provided each
pupil in Average Daily Attendance equals or exceeds a
prescribed per pupil Foundation Level. This formula approach
imputes a level of per pupil Available Local Resources and
provides for the basis to calculate a per pupil level of
general State financial aid that, when added to Available Local
Resources, equals or exceeds the Foundation Level. The amount
of per pupil general State financial aid for school districts,
in general, varies in inverse relation to Available Local
Resources. Per pupil amounts are based upon each school
district's Average Daily Attendance as that term is defined in
this Section.
    (2) In addition to general State financial aid, school
districts with specified levels or concentrations of pupils
from low income households are eligible to receive supplemental
general State financial aid grants as provided pursuant to
subsection (H). The supplemental State aid grants provided for
school districts under subsection (H) shall be appropriated for
distribution to school districts as part of the same line item
in which the general State financial aid of school districts is
appropriated under this Section.
    (3) To receive financial assistance under this Section,
school districts are required to file claims with the State
Board of Education, subject to the following requirements:
        (a) Any school district which fails for any given
    school year to maintain school as required by law, or to
    maintain a recognized school is not eligible to file for
    such school year any claim upon the Common School Fund. In
    case of nonrecognition of one or more attendance centers in
    a school district otherwise operating recognized schools,
    the claim of the district shall be reduced in the
    proportion which the Average Daily Attendance in the
    attendance center or centers bear to the Average Daily
    Attendance in the school district. A "recognized school"
    means any public school which meets the standards as
    established for recognition by the State Board of
    Education. A school district or attendance center not
    having recognition status at the end of a school term is
    entitled to receive State aid payments due upon a legal
    claim which was filed while it was recognized.
        (b) School district claims filed under this Section are
    subject to Sections 18-9 and 18-12, except as otherwise
    provided in this Section.
        (c) If a school district operates a full year school
    under Section 10-19.1, the general State aid to the school
    district shall be determined by the State Board of
    Education in accordance with this Section as near as may be
    applicable.
        (d) (Blank).
    (4) Except as provided in subsections (H) and (L), the
board of any district receiving any of the grants provided for
in this Section may apply those funds to any fund so received
for which that board is authorized to make expenditures by law.
    School districts are not required to exert a minimum
Operating Tax Rate in order to qualify for assistance under
this Section.
    (5) As used in this Section the following terms, when
capitalized, shall have the meaning ascribed herein:
        (a) "Average Daily Attendance": A count of pupil
    attendance in school, averaged as provided for in
    subsection (C) and utilized in deriving per pupil financial
    support levels.
        (b) "Available Local Resources": A computation of
    local financial support, calculated on the basis of Average
    Daily Attendance and derived as provided pursuant to
    subsection (D).
        (c) "Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes":
    Funds paid to local school districts pursuant to "An Act in
    relation to the abolition of ad valorem personal property
    tax and the replacement of revenues lost thereby, and
    amending and repealing certain Acts and parts of Acts in
    connection therewith", certified August 14, 1979, as
    amended (Public Act 81-1st S.S.-1).
        (d) "Foundation Level": A prescribed level of per pupil
    financial support as provided for in subsection (B).
        (e) "Operating Tax Rate": All school district property
    taxes extended for all purposes, except Bond and Interest,
    Summer School, Rent, Capital Improvement, and Vocational
    Education Building purposes.
 
(B) Foundation Level.
    (1) The Foundation Level is a figure established by the
State representing the minimum level of per pupil financial
support that should be available to provide for the basic
education of each pupil in Average Daily Attendance. As set
forth in this Section, each school district is assumed to exert
a sufficient local taxing effort such that, in combination with
the aggregate of general State financial aid provided the
district, an aggregate of State and local resources are
available to meet the basic education needs of pupils in the
district.
    (2) For the 1998-1999 school year, the Foundation Level of
support is $4,225. For the 1999-2000 school year, the
Foundation Level of support is $4,325. For the 2000-2001 school
year, the Foundation Level of support is $4,425. For the
2001-2002 school year and 2002-2003 school year, the Foundation
Level of support is $4,560. For the 2003-2004 school year, the
Foundation Level of support is $4,810. For the 2004-2005 school
year, the Foundation Level of support is $4,964. For the
2005-2006 school year, the Foundation Level of support is
$5,164. For the 2006-2007 school year, the Foundation Level of
support is $5,334.
    (3) For the 2007-2008 2006-2007 school year and each school
year thereafter, the Foundation Level of support is $5,734
$5,334 or such greater amount as may be established by law by
the General Assembly.
 
(C) Average Daily Attendance.
    (1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant
to subsection (E), an Average Daily Attendance figure shall be
utilized. The Average Daily Attendance figure for formula
calculation purposes shall be the monthly average of the actual
number of pupils in attendance of each school district, as
further averaged for the best 3 months of pupil attendance for
each school district. In compiling the figures for the number
of pupils in attendance, school districts and the State Board
of Education shall, for purposes of general State aid funding,
conform attendance figures to the requirements of subsection
(F).
    (2) The Average Daily Attendance figures utilized in
subsection (E) shall be the requisite attendance data for the
school year immediately preceding the school year for which
general State aid is being calculated or the average of the
attendance data for the 3 preceding school years, whichever is
greater. The Average Daily Attendance figures utilized in
subsection (H) shall be the requisite attendance data for the
school year immediately preceding the school year for which
general State aid is being calculated.
 
(D) Available Local Resources.
    (1) For purposes of calculating general State aid pursuant
to subsection (E), a representation of Available Local
Resources per pupil, as that term is defined and determined in
this subsection, shall be utilized. Available Local Resources
per pupil shall include a calculated dollar amount representing
local school district revenues from local property taxes and
from Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes, expressed
on the basis of pupils in Average Daily Attendance. Calculation
of Available Local Resources shall exclude any tax amnesty
funds received as a result of Public Act 93-26.
    (2) In determining a school district's revenue from local
property taxes, the State Board of Education shall utilize the
equalized assessed valuation of all taxable property of each
school district as of September 30 of the previous year. The
equalized assessed valuation utilized shall be obtained and
determined as provided in subsection (G).
    (3) For school districts maintaining grades kindergarten
through 12, local property tax revenues per pupil shall be
calculated as the product of the applicable equalized assessed
valuation for the district multiplied by 3.00%, and divided by
the district's Average Daily Attendance figure. For school
districts maintaining grades kindergarten through 8, local
property tax revenues per pupil shall be calculated as the
product of the applicable equalized assessed valuation for the
district multiplied by 2.30%, and divided by the district's
Average Daily Attendance figure. For school districts
maintaining grades 9 through 12, local property tax revenues
per pupil shall be the applicable equalized assessed valuation
of the district multiplied by 1.05%, and divided by the
district's Average Daily Attendance figure.
    For partial elementary unit districts created pursuant to
Article 11E of this Code, local property tax revenues per pupil
shall be calculated as the product of the equalized assessed
valuation for property within the elementary and high school
classification of the partial elementary unit district
multiplied by 2.06% and divided by the Average Daily Attendance
figure for grades kindergarten through 8, plus the product of
the equalized assessed valuation for property within the high
school only classification of the partial elementary unit
district multiplied by 0.94% and divided by the Average Daily
Attendance figure for grades 9 through 12.
    (4) The Corporate Personal Property Replacement Taxes paid
to each school district during the calendar year 2 years before
the calendar year in which a school year begins, divided by the
Average Daily Attendance figure for that district, shall be
added to the local property tax revenues per pupil as derived
by the application of the immediately preceding paragraph (3).
The sum of these per pupil figures for each school district
shall constitute Available Local Resources as that term is
utilized in subsection (E) in the calculation of general State
aid.
 
(E) Computation of General State Aid.
    (1) For each school year, the amount of general State aid
allotted to a school district shall be computed by the State
Board of Education as provided in this subsection.
    (2) For any school district for which Available Local
Resources per pupil is less than the product of 0.93 times the
Foundation Level, general State aid for that district shall be
calculated as an amount equal to the Foundation Level minus
Available Local Resources, multiplied by the Average Daily
Attendance of the school district.
    (3) For any school district for which Available Local
Resources per pupil is equal to or greater than the product of
0.93 times the Foundation Level and less than the product of
1.75 times the Foundation Level, the general State aid per
pupil shall be a decimal proportion of the Foundation Level
derived using a linear algorithm. Under this linear algorithm,
the calculated general State aid per pupil shall decline in
direct linear fashion from 0.07 times the Foundation Level for
a school district with Available Local Resources equal to the
product of 0.93 times the Foundation Level, to 0.05 times the
Foundation Level for a school district with Available Local
Resources equal to the product of 1.75 times the Foundation
Level. The allocation of general State aid for school districts
subject to this paragraph 3 shall be the calculated general
State aid per pupil figure multiplied by the Average Daily
Attendance of the school district.
    (4) For any school district for which Available Local
Resources per pupil equals or exceeds the product of 1.75 times
the Foundation Level, the general State aid for the school
district shall be calculated as the product of $218 multiplied
by the Average Daily Attendance of the school district.
    (5) The amount of general State aid allocated to a school
district for the 1999-2000 school year meeting the requirements
set forth in paragraph (4) of subsection (G) shall be increased
by an amount equal to the general State aid that would have
been received by the district for the 1998-1999 school year by
utilizing the Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed
Valuation as calculated in paragraph (4) of subsection (G) less
the general State aid allotted for the 1998-1999 school year.
This amount shall be deemed a one time increase, and shall not
affect any future general State aid allocations.
 
(F) Compilation of Average Daily Attendance.
    (1) Each school district shall, by July 1 of each year,
submit to the State Board of Education, on forms prescribed by
the State Board of Education, attendance figures for the school
year that began in the preceding calendar year. The attendance
information so transmitted shall identify the average daily
attendance figures for each month of the school year. Beginning
with the general State aid claim form for the 2002-2003 school
year, districts shall calculate Average Daily Attendance as
provided in subdivisions (a), (b), and (c) of this paragraph
(1).
        (a) In districts that do not hold year-round classes,
    days of attendance in August shall be added to the month of
    September and any days of attendance in June shall be added
    to the month of May.
        (b) In districts in which all buildings hold year-round
    classes, days of attendance in July and August shall be
    added to the month of September and any days of attendance
    in June shall be added to the month of May.
        (c) In districts in which some buildings, but not all,
    hold year-round classes, for the non-year-round buildings,
    days of attendance in August shall be added to the month of
    September and any days of attendance in June shall be added
    to the month of May. The average daily attendance for the
    year-round buildings shall be computed as provided in
    subdivision (b) of this paragraph (1). To calculate the
    Average Daily Attendance for the district, the average
    daily attendance for the year-round buildings shall be
    multiplied by the days in session for the non-year-round
    buildings for each month and added to the monthly
    attendance of the non-year-round buildings.
    Except as otherwise provided in this Section, days of
attendance by pupils shall be counted only for sessions of not
less than 5 clock hours of school work per day under direct
supervision of: (i) teachers, or (ii) non-teaching personnel or
volunteer personnel when engaging in non-teaching duties and
supervising in those instances specified in subsection (a) of
Section 10-22.34 and paragraph 10 of Section 34-18, with pupils
of legal school age and in kindergarten and grades 1 through
12.
    Days of attendance by tuition pupils shall be accredited
only to the districts that pay the tuition to a recognized
school.
    (2) Days of attendance by pupils of less than 5 clock hours
of school shall be subject to the following provisions in the
compilation of Average Daily Attendance.
        (a) Pupils regularly enrolled in a public school for
    only a part of the school day may be counted on the basis
    of 1/6 day for every class hour of instruction of 40
    minutes or more attended pursuant to such enrollment,
    unless a pupil is enrolled in a block-schedule format of 80
    minutes or more of instruction, in which case the pupil may
    be counted on the basis of the proportion of minutes of
    school work completed each day to the minimum number of
    minutes that school work is required to be held that day.
        (b) Days of attendance may be less than 5 clock hours
    on the opening and closing of the school term, and upon the
    first day of pupil attendance, if preceded by a day or days
    utilized as an institute or teachers' workshop.
        (c) A session of 4 or more clock hours may be counted
    as a day of attendance upon certification by the regional
    superintendent, and approved by the State Superintendent
    of Education to the extent that the district has been
    forced to use daily multiple sessions.
        (d) A session of 3 or more clock hours may be counted
    as a day of attendance (1) when the remainder of the school
    day or at least 2 hours in the evening of that day is
    utilized for an in-service training program for teachers,
    up to a maximum of 5 days per school year of which a
    maximum of 4 days of such 5 days may be used for
    parent-teacher conferences, provided a district conducts
    an in-service training program for teachers which has been
    approved by the State Superintendent of Education; or, in
    lieu of 4 such days, 2 full days may be used, in which
    event each such day may be counted as a day of attendance;
    and (2) when days in addition to those provided in item (1)
    are scheduled by a school pursuant to its school
    improvement plan adopted under Article 34 or its revised or
    amended school improvement plan adopted under Article 2,
    provided that (i) such sessions of 3 or more clock hours
    are scheduled to occur at regular intervals, (ii) the
    remainder of the school days in which such sessions occur
    are utilized for in-service training programs or other
    staff development activities for teachers, and (iii) a
    sufficient number of minutes of school work under the
    direct supervision of teachers are added to the school days
    between such regularly scheduled sessions to accumulate
    not less than the number of minutes by which such sessions
    of 3 or more clock hours fall short of 5 clock hours. Any
    full days used for the purposes of this paragraph shall not
    be considered for computing average daily attendance. Days
    scheduled for in-service training programs, staff
    development activities, or parent-teacher conferences may
    be scheduled separately for different grade levels and
    different attendance centers of the district.
        (e) A session of not less than one clock hour of
    teaching hospitalized or homebound pupils on-site or by
    telephone to the classroom may be counted as 1/2 day of
    attendance, however these pupils must receive 4 or more
    clock hours of instruction to be counted for a full day of
    attendance.
        (f) A session of at least 4 clock hours may be counted
    as a day of attendance for first grade pupils, and pupils
    in full day kindergartens, and a session of 2 or more hours
    may be counted as 1/2 day of attendance by pupils in
    kindergartens which provide only 1/2 day of attendance.
        (g) For children with disabilities who are below the
    age of 6 years and who cannot attend 2 or more clock hours
    because of their disability or immaturity, a session of not
    less than one clock hour may be counted as 1/2 day of
    attendance; however for such children whose educational
    needs so require a session of 4 or more clock hours may be
    counted as a full day of attendance.
        (h) A recognized kindergarten which provides for only
    1/2 day of attendance by each pupil shall not have more
    than 1/2 day of attendance counted in any one day. However,
    kindergartens may count 2 1/2 days of attendance in any 5
    consecutive school days. When a pupil attends such a
    kindergarten for 2 half days on any one school day, the
    pupil shall have the following day as a day absent from
    school, unless the school district obtains permission in
    writing from the State Superintendent of Education.
    Attendance at kindergartens which provide for a full day of
    attendance by each pupil shall be counted the same as
    attendance by first grade pupils. Only the first year of
    attendance in one kindergarten shall be counted, except in
    case of children who entered the kindergarten in their
    fifth year whose educational development requires a second
    year of kindergarten as determined under the rules and
    regulations of the State Board of Education.
        (i) On the days when the Prairie State Achievement
    Examination is administered under subsection (c) of
    Section 2-3.64 of this Code, the day of attendance for a
    pupil whose school day must be shortened to accommodate
    required testing procedures may be less than 5 clock hours
    and shall be counted towards the 176 days of actual pupil
    attendance required under Section 10-19 of this Code,
    provided that a sufficient number of minutes of school work
    in excess of 5 clock hours are first completed on other
    school days to compensate for the loss of school work on
    the examination days.
 
(G) Equalized Assessed Valuation Data.
    (1) For purposes of the calculation of Available Local
Resources required pursuant to subsection (D), the State Board
of Education shall secure from the Department of Revenue the
value as equalized or assessed by the Department of Revenue of
all taxable property of every school district, together with
(i) the applicable tax rate used in extending taxes for the
funds of the district as of September 30 of the previous year
and (ii) the limiting rate for all school districts subject to
property tax extension limitations as imposed under the
Property Tax Extension Limitation Law.
    The Department of Revenue shall add to the equalized
assessed value of all taxable property of each school district
situated entirely or partially within a county that is or was
subject to the alternative general homestead exemption
provisions of Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code (a) an
amount equal to the total amount by which the homestead
exemption allowed under Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code
for real property situated in that school district exceeds the
total amount that would have been allowed in that school
district if the maximum reduction under Section 15-176 was (i)
$4,500 in Cook County or $3,500 in all other counties in tax
year 2003 or (ii) $5,000 in all counties in tax year 2004 and
thereafter and (b) an amount equal to the aggregate amount for
the taxable year of all additional exemptions under Section
15-175 of the Property Tax Code for owners with a household
income of $30,000 or less. The county clerk of any county that
is or was subject to the alternative general homestead
exemption provisions of Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code
shall annually calculate and certify to the Department of
Revenue for each school district all homestead exemption
amounts under Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code and all
amounts of additional exemptions under Section 15-175 of the
Property Tax Code for owners with a household income of $30,000
or less. It is the intent of this paragraph that if the general
homestead exemption for a parcel of property is determined
under Section 15-176 of the Property Tax Code rather than
Section 15-175, then the calculation of Available Local
Resources shall not be affected by the difference, if any,
between the amount of the general homestead exemption allowed
for that parcel of property under Section 15-176 of the
Property Tax Code and the amount that would have been allowed
had the general homestead exemption for that parcel of property
been determined under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax Code.
It is further the intent of this paragraph that if additional
exemptions are allowed under Section 15-175 of the Property Tax
Code for owners with a household income of less than $30,000,
then the calculation of Available Local Resources shall not be
affected by the difference, if any, because of those additional
exemptions.
    This equalized assessed valuation, as adjusted further by
the requirements of this subsection, shall be utilized in the
calculation of Available Local Resources.
    (2) The equalized assessed valuation in paragraph (1) shall
be adjusted, as applicable, in the following manner:
        (a) For the purposes of calculating State aid under
    this Section, with respect to any part of a school district
    within a redevelopment project area in respect to which a
    municipality has adopted tax increment allocation
    financing pursuant to the Tax Increment Allocation
    Redevelopment Act, Sections 11-74.4-1 through 11-74.4-11
    of the Illinois Municipal Code or the Industrial Jobs
    Recovery Law, Sections 11-74.6-1 through 11-74.6-50 of the
    Illinois Municipal Code, no part of the current equalized
    assessed valuation of real property located in any such
    project area which is attributable to an increase above the
    total initial equalized assessed valuation of such
    property shall be used as part of the equalized assessed
    valuation of the district, until such time as all
    redevelopment project costs have been paid, as provided in
    Section 11-74.4-8 of the Tax Increment Allocation
    Redevelopment Act or in Section 11-74.6-35 of the
    Industrial Jobs Recovery Law. For the purpose of the
    equalized assessed valuation of the district, the total
    initial equalized assessed valuation or the current
    equalized assessed valuation, whichever is lower, shall be
    used until such time as all redevelopment project costs
    have been paid.
        (b) The real property equalized assessed valuation for
    a school district shall be adjusted by subtracting from the
    real property value as equalized or assessed by the
    Department of Revenue for the district an amount computed
    by dividing the amount of any abatement of taxes under
    Section 18-170 of the Property Tax Code by 3.00% for a
    district maintaining grades kindergarten through 12, by
    2.30% for a district maintaining grades kindergarten
    through 8, or by 1.05% for a district maintaining grades 9
    through 12 and adjusted by an amount computed by dividing
    the amount of any abatement of taxes under subsection (a)
    of Section 18-165 of the Property Tax Code by the same
    percentage rates for district type as specified in this
    subparagraph (b).
    (3) For the 1999-2000 school year and each school year
thereafter, if a school district meets all of the criteria of
this subsection (G)(3), the school district's Available Local
Resources shall be calculated under subsection (D) using the
district's Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation
as calculated under this subsection (G)(3).
    For purposes of this subsection (G)(3) the following terms
shall have the following meanings:
        "Budget Year": The school year for which general State
    aid is calculated and awarded under subsection (E).
        "Base Tax Year": The property tax levy year used to
    calculate the Budget Year allocation of general State aid.
        "Preceding Tax Year": The property tax levy year
    immediately preceding the Base Tax Year.
        "Base Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of the
    equalized assessed valuation utilized by the County Clerk
    in the Base Tax Year multiplied by the limiting rate as
    calculated by the County Clerk and defined in the Property
    Tax Extension Limitation Law.
        "Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension": The product of
    the equalized assessed valuation utilized by the County
    Clerk in the Preceding Tax Year multiplied by the Operating
    Tax Rate as defined in subsection (A).
        "Extension Limitation Ratio": A numerical ratio,
    certified by the County Clerk, in which the numerator is
    the Base Tax Year's Tax Extension and the denominator is
    the Preceding Tax Year's Tax Extension.
        "Operating Tax Rate": The operating tax rate as defined
    in subsection (A).
    If a school district is subject to property tax extension
limitations as imposed under the Property Tax Extension
Limitation Law, the State Board of Education shall calculate
the Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of that
district. For the 1999-2000 school year, the Extension
Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a school district as
calculated by the State Board of Education shall be equal to
the product of the district's 1996 Equalized Assessed Valuation
and the district's Extension Limitation Ratio. For the
2000-2001 school year and each school year thereafter, the
Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of a school
district as calculated by the State Board of Education shall be
equal to the product of the Equalized Assessed Valuation last
used in the calculation of general State aid and the district's
Extension Limitation Ratio. If the Extension Limitation
Equalized Assessed Valuation of a school district as calculated
under this subsection (G)(3) is less than the district's
equalized assessed valuation as calculated pursuant to
subsections (G)(1) and (G)(2), then for purposes of calculating
the district's general State aid for the Budget Year pursuant
to subsection (E), that Extension Limitation Equalized
Assessed Valuation shall be utilized to calculate the
district's Available Local Resources under subsection (D).
    Partial elementary unit districts created in accordance
with Article 11E of this Code shall not be eligible for the
adjustment in this subsection (G)(3) until the fifth year
following the effective date of the reorganization.
    (4) For the purposes of calculating general State aid for
the 1999-2000 school year only, if a school district
experienced a triennial reassessment on the equalized assessed
valuation used in calculating its general State financial aid
apportionment for the 1998-1999 school year, the State Board of
Education shall calculate the Extension Limitation Equalized
Assessed Valuation that would have been used to calculate the
district's 1998-1999 general State aid. This amount shall equal
the product of the equalized assessed valuation used to
calculate general State aid for the 1997-1998 school year and
the district's Extension Limitation Ratio. If the Extension
Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation of the school district
as calculated under this paragraph (4) is less than the
district's equalized assessed valuation utilized in
calculating the district's 1998-1999 general State aid
allocation, then for purposes of calculating the district's
general State aid pursuant to paragraph (5) of subsection (E),
that Extension Limitation Equalized Assessed Valuation shall
be utilized to calculate the district's Available Local
Resources.
    (5) For school districts having a majority of their
equalized assessed valuation in any county except Cook, DuPage,
Kane, Lake, McHenry, or Will, if the amount of general State
aid allocated to the school district for the 1999-2000 school
year under the provisions of subsection (E), (H), and (J) of
this Section is less than the amount of general State aid
allocated to the district for the 1998-1999 school year under
these subsections, then the general State aid of the district
for the 1999-2000 school year only shall be increased by the
difference between these amounts. The total payments made under
this paragraph (5) shall not exceed $14,000,000. Claims shall
be prorated if they exceed $14,000,000.
 
(H) Supplemental General State Aid.
    (1) In addition to the general State aid a school district
is allotted pursuant to subsection (E), qualifying school
districts shall receive a grant, paid in conjunction with a
district's payments of general State aid, for supplemental
general State aid based upon the concentration level of
children from low-income households within the school
district. Supplemental State aid grants provided for school
districts under this subsection shall be appropriated for
distribution to school districts as part of the same line item
in which the general State financial aid of school districts is
appropriated under this Section. If the appropriation in any
fiscal year for general State aid and supplemental general
State aid is insufficient to pay the amounts required under the
general State aid and supplemental general State aid
calculations, then the State Board of Education shall ensure
that each school district receives the full amount due for
general State aid and the remainder of the appropriation shall
be used for supplemental general State aid, which the State
Board of Education shall calculate and pay to eligible
districts on a prorated basis.
    (1.5) This paragraph (1.5) applies only to those school
years preceding the 2003-2004 school year. For purposes of this
subsection (H), the term "Low-Income Concentration Level"
shall be the low-income eligible pupil count from the most
recently available federal census divided by the Average Daily
Attendance of the school district. If, however, (i) the
percentage decrease from the 2 most recent federal censuses in
the low-income eligible pupil count of a high school district
with fewer than 400 students exceeds by 75% or more the
percentage change in the total low-income eligible pupil count
of contiguous elementary school districts, whose boundaries
are coterminous with the high school district, or (ii) a high
school district within 2 counties and serving 5 elementary
school districts, whose boundaries are coterminous with the
high school district, has a percentage decrease from the 2 most
recent federal censuses in the low-income eligible pupil count
and there is a percentage increase in the total low-income
eligible pupil count of a majority of the elementary school
districts in excess of 50% from the 2 most recent federal
censuses, then the high school district's low-income eligible
pupil count from the earlier federal census shall be the number
used as the low-income eligible pupil count for the high school
district, for purposes of this subsection (H). The changes made
to this paragraph (1) by Public Act 92-28 shall apply to
supplemental general State aid grants for school years
preceding the 2003-2004 school year that are paid in fiscal
year 1999 or thereafter and to any State aid payments made in
fiscal year 1994 through fiscal year 1998 pursuant to
subsection 1(n) of Section 18-8 of this Code (which was
repealed on July 1, 1998), and any high school district that is
affected by Public Act 92-28 is entitled to a recomputation of
its supplemental general State aid grant or State aid paid in
any of those fiscal years. This recomputation shall not be
affected by any other funding.
    (1.10) This paragraph (1.10) applies to the 2003-2004
school year and each school year thereafter. For purposes of
this subsection (H), the term "Low-Income Concentration Level"
shall, for each fiscal year, be the low-income eligible pupil
count as of July 1 of the immediately preceding fiscal year (as
determined by the Department of Human Services based on the
number of pupils who are eligible for at least one of the
following low income programs: Medicaid, KidCare, TANF, or Food
Stamps, excluding pupils who are eligible for services provided
by the Department of Children and Family Services, averaged
over the 2 immediately preceding fiscal years for fiscal year
2004 and over the 3 immediately preceding fiscal years for each
fiscal year thereafter) divided by the Average Daily Attendance
of the school district.
    (2) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this
subsection (H) shall be provided as follows for the 1998-1999,
1999-2000, and 2000-2001 school years only:
        (a) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of at least 20% and less than 35%, the
    grant for any school year shall be $800 multiplied by the
    low income eligible pupil count.
        (b) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of at least 35% and less than 50%, the
    grant for the 1998-1999 school year shall be $1,100
    multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count.
        (c) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of at least 50% and less than 60%, the
    grant for the 1998-99 school year shall be $1,500
    multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count.
        (d) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of 60% or more, the grant for the
    1998-99 school year shall be $1,900 multiplied by the low
    income eligible pupil count.
        (e) For the 1999-2000 school year, the per pupil amount
    specified in subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d) immediately
    above shall be increased to $1,243, $1,600, and $2,000,
    respectively.
        (f) For the 2000-2001 school year, the per pupil
    amounts specified in subparagraphs (b), (c), and (d)
    immediately above shall be $1,273, $1,640, and $2,050,
    respectively.
    (2.5) Supplemental general State aid pursuant to this
subsection (H) shall be provided as follows for the 2002-2003
school year:
        (a) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of less than 10%, the grant for each
    school year shall be $355 multiplied by the low income
    eligible pupil count.
        (b) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of at least 10% and less than 20%, the
    grant for each school year shall be $675 multiplied by the
    low income eligible pupil count.
        (c) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of at least 20% and less than 35%, the
    grant for each school year shall be $1,330 multiplied by
    the low income eligible pupil count.
        (d) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of at least 35% and less than 50%, the
    grant for each school year shall be $1,362 multiplied by
    the low income eligible pupil count.
        (e) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of at least 50% and less than 60%, the
    grant for each school year shall be $1,680 multiplied by
    the low income eligible pupil count.
        (f) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of 60% or more, the grant for each
    school year shall be $2,080 multiplied by the low income
    eligible pupil count.
    (2.10) Except as otherwise provided, supplemental general
State aid pursuant to this subsection (H) shall be provided as
follows for the 2003-2004 school year and each school year
thereafter:
        (a) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level of 15% or less, the grant for each
    school year shall be $355 multiplied by the low income
    eligible pupil count.
        (b) For any school district with a Low Income
    Concentration Level greater than 15%, the grant for each
    school year shall be $294.25 added to the product of $2,700
    and the square of the Low Income Concentration Level, all
    multiplied by the low income eligible pupil count.
    For the 2003-2004 school year and each school year through
the 2007-2008 school year , 2004-2005 school year, 2005-2006
school year, and 2006-2007 school year only, the grant shall be
no less than the grant for the 2002-2003 school year. For the
2008-2009 2007-2008 school year only, the grant shall be no
less than the grant for the 2002-2003 school year multiplied by
0.66. For the 2009-2010 2008-2009 school year only, the grant
shall be no less than the grant for the 2002-2003 school year
multiplied by 0.33. Notwithstanding the provisions of this
paragraph to the contrary, if for any school year supplemental
general State aid grants are prorated as provided in paragraph
(1) of this subsection (H), then the grants under this
paragraph shall be prorated.
    For the 2003-2004 school year only, the grant shall be no
greater than the grant received during the 2002-2003 school
year added to the product of 0.25 multiplied by the difference
between the grant amount calculated under subsection (a) or (b)
of this paragraph (2.10), whichever is applicable, and the
grant received during the 2002-2003 school year. For the
2004-2005 school year only, the grant shall be no greater than
the grant received during the 2002-2003 school year added to
the product of 0.50 multiplied by the difference between the
grant amount calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this
paragraph (2.10), whichever is applicable, and the grant
received during the 2002-2003 school year. For the 2005-2006
school year only, the grant shall be no greater than the grant
received during the 2002-2003 school year added to the product
of 0.75 multiplied by the difference between the grant amount
calculated under subsection (a) or (b) of this paragraph
(2.10), whichever is applicable, and the grant received during
the 2002-2003 school year.
    (3) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of
more than 1,000 and less than 50,000 that qualify for
supplemental general State aid pursuant to this subsection
shall submit a plan to the State Board of Education prior to
October 30 of each year for the use of the funds resulting from
this grant of supplemental general State aid for the
improvement of instruction in which priority is given to
meeting the education needs of disadvantaged children. Such
plan shall be submitted in accordance with rules and
regulations promulgated by the State Board of Education.
    (4) School districts with an Average Daily Attendance of
50,000 or more that qualify for supplemental general State aid
pursuant to this subsection shall be required to distribute
from funds available pursuant to this Section, no less than
$261,000,000 in accordance with the following requirements:
        (a) The required amounts shall be distributed to the
    attendance centers within the district in proportion to the
    number of pupils enrolled at each attendance center who are
    eligible to receive free or reduced-price lunches or
    breakfasts under the federal Child Nutrition Act of 1966
    and under the National School Lunch Act during the
    immediately preceding school year.
        (b) The distribution of these portions of supplemental
    and general State aid among attendance centers according to
    these requirements shall not be compensated for or
    contravened by adjustments of the total of other funds
    appropriated to any attendance centers, and the Board of
    Education shall utilize funding from one or several sources
    in order to fully implement this provision annually prior
    to the opening of school.
        (c) Each attendance center shall be provided by the
    school district a distribution of noncategorical funds and
    other categorical funds to which an attendance center is
    entitled under law in order that the general State aid and
    supplemental general State aid provided by application of
    this subsection supplements rather than supplants the
    noncategorical funds and other categorical funds provided
    by the school district to the attendance centers.
        (d) Any funds made available under this subsection that
    by reason of the provisions of this subsection are not
    required to be allocated and provided to attendance centers
    may be used and appropriated by the board of the district
    for any lawful school purpose.
        (e) Funds received by an attendance center pursuant to
    this subsection shall be used by the attendance center at
    the discretion of the principal and local school council
    for programs to improve educational opportunities at
    qualifying schools through the following programs and
    services: early childhood education, reduced class size or
    improved adult to student classroom ratio, enrichment
    programs, remedial assistance, attendance improvement, and
    other educationally beneficial expenditures which
    supplement the regular and basic programs as determined by
    the State Board of Education. Funds provided shall not be
    expended for any political or lobbying purposes as defined
    by board rule.
        (f) Each district subject to the provisions of this
    subdivision (H)(4) shall submit an acceptable plan to meet
    the educational needs of disadvantaged children, in
    compliance with the requirements of this paragraph, to the
    State Board of Education prior to July 15 of each year.
    This plan shall be consistent with the decisions of local
    school councils concerning the school expenditure plans
    developed in accordance with part 4 of Section 34-2.3. The
    State Board shall approve or reject the plan within 60 days
    after its submission. If the plan is rejected, the district
    shall give written notice of intent to modify the plan
    within 15 days of the notification of rejection and then
    submit a modified plan within 30 days after the date of the
    written notice of intent to modify. Districts may amend
    approved plans pursuant to rules promulgated by the State
    Board of Education.
        Upon notification by the State Board of Education that
    the district has not submitted a plan prior to July 15 or a
    modified plan within the time period specified herein, the
    State aid funds affected by that plan or modified plan
    shall be withheld by the State Board of Education until a
    plan or modified plan is submitted.
        If the district fails to distribute State aid to
    attendance centers in accordance with an approved plan, the
    plan for the following year shall allocate funds, in
    addition to the funds otherwise required by this
    subsection, to those attendance centers which were
    underfunded during the previous year in amounts equal to
    such underfunding.
        For purposes of determining compliance with this
    subsection in relation to the requirements of attendance
    center funding, each district subject to the provisions of
    this subsection shall submit as a separate document by
    December 1 of each year a report of expenditure data for
    the prior year in addition to any modification of its
    current plan. If it is determined that there has been a
    failure to comply with the expenditure provisions of this
    subsection regarding contravention or supplanting, the
    State Superintendent of Education shall, within 60 days of
    receipt of the report, notify the district and any affected
    local school council. The district shall within 45 days of
    receipt of that notification inform the State
    Superintendent of Education of the remedial or corrective
    action to be taken, whether by amendment of the current
    plan, if feasible, or by adjustment in the plan for the
    following year. Failure to provide the expenditure report
    or the notification of remedial or corrective action in a
    timely manner shall result in a withholding of the affected
    funds.
        The State Board of Education shall promulgate rules and
    regulations to implement the provisions of this
    subsection. No funds shall be released under this
    subdivision (H)(4) to any district that has not submitted a
    plan that has been approved by the State Board of
    Education.
 
(I) (Blank).
 
(J) Supplementary Grants in Aid.
    (1) Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section,
the amount of the aggregate general State aid in combination
with supplemental general State aid under this Section for
which each school district is eligible shall be no less than
the amount of the aggregate general State aid entitlement that
was received by the district under Section 18-8 (exclusive of
amounts received under subsections 5(p) and 5(p-5) of that
Section) for the 1997-98 school year, pursuant to the
provisions of that Section as it was then in effect. If a
school district qualifies to receive a supplementary payment
made under this subsection (J), the amount of the aggregate
general State aid in combination with supplemental general
State aid under this Section which that district is eligible to
receive for each school year shall be no less than the amount
of the aggregate general State aid entitlement that was
received by the district under Section 18-8 (exclusive of
amounts received under subsections 5(p) and 5(p-5) of that
Section) for the 1997-1998 school year, pursuant to the
provisions of that Section as it was then in effect.
    (2) If, as provided in paragraph (1) of this subsection
(J), a school district is to receive aggregate general State
aid in combination with supplemental general State aid under
this Section for the 1998-99 school year and any subsequent
school year that in any such school year is less than the
amount of the aggregate general State aid entitlement that the
district received for the 1997-98 school year, the school
district shall also receive, from a separate appropriation made
for purposes of this subsection (J), a supplementary payment
that is equal to the amount of the difference in the aggregate
State aid figures as described in paragraph (1).
    (3) (Blank).
 
(K) Grants to Laboratory and Alternative Schools.
    In calculating the amount to be paid to the governing board
of a public university that operates a laboratory school under
this Section or to any alternative school that is operated by a
regional superintendent of schools, the State Board of
Education shall require by rule such reporting requirements as
it deems necessary.
    As used in this Section, "laboratory school" means a public
school which is created and operated by a public university and
approved by the State Board of Education. The governing board
of a public university which receives funds from the State
Board under this subsection (K) may not increase the number of
students enrolled in its laboratory school from a single
district, if that district is already sending 50 or more
students, except under a mutual agreement between the school
board of a student's district of residence and the university
which operates the laboratory school. A laboratory school may
not have more than 1,000 students, excluding students with
disabilities in a special education program.
    As used in this Section, "alternative school" means a
public school which is created and operated by a Regional
Superintendent of Schools and approved by the State Board of
Education. Such alternative schools may offer courses of
instruction for which credit is given in regular school
programs, courses to prepare students for the high school
equivalency testing program or vocational and occupational
training. A regional superintendent of schools may contract
with a school district or a public community college district
to operate an alternative school. An alternative school serving
more than one educational service region may be established by
the regional superintendents of schools of the affected
educational service regions. An alternative school serving
more than one educational service region may be operated under
such terms as the regional superintendents of schools of those
educational service regions may agree.
    Each laboratory and alternative school shall file, on forms
provided by the State Superintendent of Education, an annual
State aid claim which states the Average Daily Attendance of
the school's students by month. The best 3 months' Average
Daily Attendance shall be computed for each school. The general
State aid entitlement shall be computed by multiplying the
applicable Average Daily Attendance by the Foundation Level as
determined under this Section.
 
(L) Payments, Additional Grants in Aid and Other Requirements.
    (1) For a school district operating under the financial
supervision of an Authority created under Article 34A, the
general State aid otherwise payable to that district under this
Section, but not the supplemental general State aid, shall be
reduced by an amount equal to the budget for the operations of
the Authority as certified by the Authority to the State Board
of Education, and an amount equal to such reduction shall be
paid to the Authority created for such district for its
operating expenses in the manner provided in Section 18-11. The
remainder of general State school aid for any such district
shall be paid in accordance with Article 34A when that Article
provides for a disposition other than that provided by this
Article.
    (2) (Blank).
    (3) Summer school. Summer school payments shall be made as
provided in Section 18-4.3.
 
(M) Education Funding Advisory Board.
    The Education Funding Advisory Board, hereinafter in this
subsection (M) referred to as the "Board", is hereby created.
The Board shall consist of 5 members who are appointed by the
Governor, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate. The
members appointed shall include representatives of education,
business, and the general public. One of the members so
appointed shall be designated by the Governor at the time the
appointment is made as the chairperson of the Board. The
initial members of the Board may be appointed any time after
the effective date of this amendatory Act of 1997. The regular
term of each member of the Board shall be for 4 years from the
third Monday of January of the year in which the term of the
member's appointment is to commence, except that of the 5
initial members appointed to serve on the Board, the member who
is appointed as the chairperson shall serve for a term that
commences on the date of his or her appointment and expires on
the third Monday of January, 2002, and the remaining 4 members,
by lots drawn at the first meeting of the Board that is held
after all 5 members are appointed, shall determine 2 of their
number to serve for terms that commence on the date of their
respective appointments and expire on the third Monday of
January, 2001, and 2 of their number to serve for terms that
commence on the date of their respective appointments and
expire on the third Monday of January, 2000. All members
appointed to serve on the Board shall serve until their
respective successors are appointed and confirmed. Vacancies
shall be filled in the same manner as original appointments. If
a vacancy in membership occurs at a time when the Senate is not
in session, the Governor shall make a temporary appointment
until the next meeting of the Senate, when he or she shall
appoint, by and with the advice and consent of the Senate, a
person to fill that membership for the unexpired term. If the
Senate is not in session when the initial appointments are
made, those appointments shall be made as in the case of
vacancies.
    The Education Funding Advisory Board shall be deemed
established, and the initial members appointed by the Governor
to serve as members of the Board shall take office, on the date
that the Governor makes his or her appointment of the fifth
initial member of the Board, whether those initial members are
then serving pursuant to appointment and confirmation or
pursuant to temporary appointments that are made by the
Governor as in the case of vacancies.
    The State Board of Education shall provide such staff
assistance to the Education Funding Advisory Board as is
reasonably required for the proper performance by the Board of
its responsibilities.
    For school years after the 2000-2001 school year, the
Education Funding Advisory Board, in consultation with the
State Board of Education, shall make recommendations as
provided in this subsection (M) to the General Assembly for the
foundation level under subdivision (B)(3) of this Section and
for the supplemental general State aid grant level under
subsection (H) of this Section for districts with high
concentrations of children from poverty. The recommended
foundation level shall be determined based on a methodology
which incorporates the basic education expenditures of
low-spending schools exhibiting high academic performance. The
Education Funding Advisory Board shall make such
recommendations to the General Assembly on January 1 of odd
numbered years, beginning January 1, 2001.
 
(N) (Blank).
 
(O) References.
    (1) References in other laws to the various subdivisions of
Section 18-8 as that Section existed before its repeal and
replacement by this Section 18-8.05 shall be deemed to refer to
the corresponding provisions of this Section 18-8.05, to the
extent that those references remain applicable.
    (2) References in other laws to State Chapter 1 funds shall
be deemed to refer to the supplemental general State aid
provided under subsection (H) of this Section.
 
(P) Public Act 93-838 and Public Act 93-808 make inconsistent
changes to this Section. Under Section 6 of the Statute on
Statutes there is an irreconcilable conflict between Public Act
93-808 and Public Act 93-838. Public Act 93-838, being the last
acted upon, is controlling. The text of Public Act 93-838 is
the law regardless of the text of Public Act 93-808.
(Source: P.A. 93-21, eff. 7-1-03; 93-715, eff. 7-12-04; 93-808,
eff. 7-26-04; 93-838, eff. 7-30-04; 93-875, eff. 8-6-04; 94-69,
eff. 7-1-05; 94-438, eff. 8-4-05; 94-835, eff. 6-6-06; 94-1019,
eff. 7-10-06; 94-1105, eff. 6-1-07; revised 2-18-07.)
 
    (105 ILCS 5/21-29 new)
    Sec. 21-29. Salary Incentive Program for Hard-to-Staff
Schools.
    (a) The Salary Incentive Program for Hard-to-Staff Schools
is established to provide categorical funding for monetary
incentives and bonuses for teachers and school administrators
who are employed by school districts designated as
hard-to-staff by the State Board of Education. The State Board
of Education shall allocate and distribute to qualifying school
districts an amount as annually appropriated by the General
Assembly for the Salary Incentive Program for Hard-to-Staff
Schools. The State Board of Education's annual budget must set
out by separate line item the appropriation for the program.
    (b) Unless otherwise provided by appropriation, each
school district's annual allocation under the Salary Incentive
Program for Hard-to-Staff Schools shall be the sum of the
following incentives and bonuses:
        (1) An annual payment of $3,000 to be paid to each
    certificated teacher employed as a school teacher by a
    school district. The school district shall distribute this
    payment to each eligible teacher as a single payment or in
    not more than 3 payments.
        (2) An annual payment of $5,000 to each certificated
    principal that is employed as a school principal by a
    school district. The school district shall distribute this
    payment to each eligible principal as a single payment or
    in not more than 3 payments.
    (c) Each regional superintendent of schools shall provide
information about the Salary Incentive Program for
Hard-to-Staff Schools to each individual seeking to register or
renew a certificate.
 
    Section 5-23. The Hospital Licensing Act is amended by
changing Section 8 as follows:
 
    (210 ILCS 85/8)  (from Ch. 111 1/2, par. 149)
    Sec. 8. Facility plan review; fees.
    (a) Before commencing construction of new facilities or
specified types of alteration or additions to an existing
hospital involving major construction, as defined by rule by
the Department, with an estimated cost greater than $100,000,
architectural plans and specifications therefor shall be
submitted by the licensee to the Department for review and
approval. A hospital may submit architectural drawings and
specifications for other construction projects for Department
review according to subsection (b) that shall not be subject to
fees under subsection (d). The Department must give a hospital
that is planning to submit a construction project for review
the opportunity to discuss its plans and specifications with
the Department before the hospital formally submits the plans
and specifications for Department review. Review of drawings
and specifications shall be conducted by an employee of the
Department meeting the qualifications established by the
Department of Central Management Services class specifications
for such an individual's position or by a person contracting
with the Department who meets those class specifications. Final
approval of the plans and specifications for compliance with
design and construction standards shall be obtained from the
Department before the alteration, addition, or new
construction is begun. Subject to this Section 8, and prior to
January 1, 2012, the Department shall consider the re-licensing
of an existing hospital structure according to the standards
for an existing hospital, as set forth in the Department's
rules. Re-licensing under this provision shall occur only if
that facility operated as a licensed hospital on July 1, 2005,
has had no intervening use as other than a hospital, and exists
in a county with a population of less than 20,000 that does not
have another licensed hospital on the effective date of this
amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly.
    (b) The Department shall inform an applicant in writing
within 10 working days after receiving drawings and
specifications and the required fee, if any, from the applicant
whether the applicant's submission is complete or incomplete.
Failure to provide the applicant with this notice within 10
working days shall result in the submission being deemed
complete for purposes of initiating the 60-day review period
under this Section. If the submission is incomplete, the
Department shall inform the applicant of the deficiencies with
the submission in writing. If the submission is complete and
the required fee, if any, has been paid, the Department shall
approve or disapprove drawings and specifications submitted to
the Department no later than 60 days following receipt by the
Department. The drawings and specifications shall be of
sufficient detail, as provided by Department rule, to enable
the Department to render a determination of compliance with
design and construction standards under this Act. If the
Department finds that the drawings are not of sufficient detail
for it to render a determination of compliance, the plans shall
be determined to be incomplete and shall not be considered for
purposes of initiating the 60 day review period. If a
submission of drawings and specifications is incomplete, the
applicant may submit additional information. The 60-day review
period shall not commence until the Department determines that
a submission of drawings and specifications is complete or the
submission is deemed complete. If the Department has not
approved or disapproved the drawings and specifications within
60 days, the construction, major alteration, or addition shall
be deemed approved. If the drawings and specifications are
disapproved, the Department shall state in writing, with
specificity, the reasons for the disapproval. The entity
submitting the drawings and specifications may submit
additional information in response to the written comments from
the Department or request a reconsideration of the disapproval.
A final decision of approval or disapproval shall be made
within 45 days of the receipt of the additional information or
reconsideration request. If denied, the Department shall state
the specific reasons for the denial and the applicant may elect
to seek dispute resolution pursuant to Section 25 of the
Illinois Building Commission Act, which the Department must
participate in.
    (c) The Department shall provide written approval for
occupancy pursuant to subsection (g) and shall not issue a
violation to a facility as a result of a licensure or complaint
survey based upon the facility's physical structure if:
        (1) the Department reviewed and approved or deemed
    approved the drawing and specifications for compliance
    with design and construction standards;
        (2) the construction, major alteration, or addition
    was built as submitted;
        (3) the law or rules have not been amended since the
    original approval; and
        (4) the conditions at the facility indicate that there
    is a reasonable degree of safety provided for the patients.
    (c-5) The Department shall not issue a violation to a
facility if the inspected aspects of the facility were
previously found to be in compliance with applicable standards,
the relevant law or rules have not been amended, conditions at
the facility reasonably protect the safety of its patients, and
alterations or new hazards have not been identified.
    (d) The Department shall charge the following fees in
connection with its reviews conducted before June 30, 2004
under this Section:
        (1) (Blank).
        (2) (Blank).
        (3) If the estimated dollar value of the major
    construction is greater than $500,000, the fee shall be
    established by the Department pursuant to rules that
    reflect the reasonable and direct cost of the Department in
    conducting the architectural reviews required under this
    Section. The estimated dollar value of the major
    construction subject to review under this Section shall be
    annually readjusted to reflect the increase in
    construction costs due to inflation.
    The fees provided in this subsection (d) shall not apply to
major construction projects involving facility changes that
are required by Department rule amendments or to projects
related to homeland security.
    The fees provided in this subsection (d) shall also not
apply to major construction projects if 51% or more of the
estimated cost of the project is attributed to capital
equipment. For major construction projects where 51% or more of
the estimated cost of the project is attributed to capital
equipment, the Department shall by rule establish a fee that is
reasonably related to the cost of reviewing the project.
    Disproportionate share hospitals and rural hospitals shall
only pay one-half of the fees required in this subsection (d).
For the purposes of this subsection (d), (i) "disproportionate
share hospital" means a hospital described in items (1) through
(5) of subsection (b) of Section 5-5.02 of the Illinois Public
Aid Code and (ii) "rural hospital" means a hospital that is (A)
located outside a metropolitan statistical area or (B) located
15 miles or less from a county that is outside a metropolitan
statistical area and is licensed to perform medical/surgical or
obstetrical services and has a combined total bed capacity of
75 or fewer beds in these 2 service categories as of July 14,
1993, as determined by the Department.
    The Department shall not commence the facility plan review
process under this Section until the applicable fee has been
paid.
    (e) All fees received by the Department under this Section
shall be deposited into the Health Facility Plan Review Fund, a
special fund created in the State treasury. All fees paid by
hospitals under subsection (d) shall be used only to cover the
direct and reasonable costs relating to the Department's review
of hospital projects under this Section. Moneys shall be
appropriated from that Fund to the Department only to pay the
costs of conducting reviews under this Section. None of the
moneys in the Health Facility Plan Review Fund shall be used to
reduce the amount of General Revenue Fund moneys appropriated
to the Department for facility plan reviews conducted pursuant
to this Section.
    (f) (Blank).
    (g) The Department shall conduct an on-site inspection of
the completed project no later than 15 business days after
notification from the applicant that the project has been
completed and all certifications required by the Department
have been received and accepted by the Department. The
Department may extend this deadline only if a federally
mandated survey time frame takes precedence. The Department
shall provide written approval for occupancy to the applicant
within 5 working days of the Department's final inspection,
provided the applicant has demonstrated substantial compliance
as defined by Department rule. Occupancy of new major
construction is prohibited until Department approval is
received, unless the Department has not acted within the time
frames provided in this subsection (g), in which case the
construction shall be deemed approved. Occupancy shall be
authorized after any required health inspection by the
Department has been conducted.
    (h) The Department shall establish, by rule, a procedure to
conduct interim on-site review of large or complex construction
projects.
    (i) The Department shall establish, by rule, an expedited
process for emergency repairs or replacement of like equipment.
    (j) Nothing in this Section shall be construed to apply to
maintenance, upkeep, or renovation that does not affect the
structural integrity of the building, does not add beds or
services over the number for which the facility is licensed,
and provides a reasonable degree of safety for the patients.
(Source: P.A. 92-563, eff. 6-24-02; 92-803, eff. 8-16-02;
93-41, eff. 6-27-03.)
 
    Section 5-25. The Illinois Public Aid Code is amended by
changing Sections 5-5.4, 5A-8, 5B-8, 5C-2, and 12-10.7 and by
adding Section 12-10.8 as follows:
 
    (305 ILCS 5/5-5.4)  (from Ch. 23, par. 5-5.4)
    Sec. 5-5.4. Standards of Payment - Department of Healthcare
and Family Services. The Department of Healthcare and Family
Services shall develop standards of payment of skilled nursing
and intermediate care services in facilities providing such
services under this Article which:
    (1) Provide for the determination of a facility's payment
for skilled nursing and intermediate care services on a
prospective basis. The amount of the payment rate for all
nursing facilities certified by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities, Long Term Care for Under
Age 22 facilities, Skilled Nursing facilities, or Intermediate
Care facilities under the medical assistance program shall be
prospectively established annually on the basis of historical,
financial, and statistical data reflecting actual costs from
prior years, which shall be applied to the current rate year
and updated for inflation, except that the capital cost element
for newly constructed facilities shall be based upon projected
budgets. The annually established payment rate shall take
effect on July 1 in 1984 and subsequent years. No rate increase
and no update for inflation shall be provided on or after July
1, 1994 and before July 1, 2008, unless specifically provided
for in this Section. The changes made by Public Act 93-841
extending the duration of the prohibition against a rate
increase or update for inflation are effective retroactive to
July 1, 2004.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities or Long Term Care for Under
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on July 1, 1998
shall include an increase of 3%. For facilities licensed by the
Department of Public Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as
Skilled Nursing facilities or Intermediate Care facilities,
the rates taking effect on July 1, 1998 shall include an
increase of 3% plus $1.10 per resident-day, as defined by the
Department. For facilities licensed by the Department of Public
Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care
Facilities for the Developmentally Disabled or Long Term Care
for Under Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on January
1, 2006 shall include an increase of 3%.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities or Long Term Care for Under
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on July 1, 1999
shall include an increase of 1.6% plus $3.00 per resident-day,
as defined by the Department. For facilities licensed by the
Department of Public Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as
Skilled Nursing facilities or Intermediate Care facilities,
the rates taking effect on July 1, 1999 shall include an
increase of 1.6% and, for services provided on or after October
1, 1999, shall be increased by $4.00 per resident-day, as
defined by the Department.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities or Long Term Care for Under
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on July 1, 2000
shall include an increase of 2.5% per resident-day, as defined
by the Department. For facilities licensed by the Department of
Public Health under the Nursing Home Care Act as Skilled
Nursing facilities or Intermediate Care facilities, the rates
taking effect on July 1, 2000 shall include an increase of 2.5%
per resident-day, as defined by the Department.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities
or intermediate care facilities, a new payment methodology must
be implemented for the nursing component of the rate effective
July 1, 2003. The Department of Public Aid (now Healthcare and
Family Services) shall develop the new payment methodology
using the Minimum Data Set (MDS) as the instrument to collect
information concerning nursing home resident condition
necessary to compute the rate. The Department shall develop the
new payment methodology to meet the unique needs of Illinois
nursing home residents while remaining subject to the
appropriations provided by the General Assembly. A transition
period from the payment methodology in effect on June 30, 2003
to the payment methodology in effect on July 1, 2003 shall be
provided for a period not exceeding 3 years and 184 days after
implementation of the new payment methodology as follows:
        (A) For a facility that would receive a lower nursing
    component rate per patient day under the new system than
    the facility received effective on the date immediately
    preceding the date that the Department implements the new
    payment methodology, the nursing component rate per
    patient day for the facility shall be held at the level in
    effect on the date immediately preceding the date that the
    Department implements the new payment methodology until a
    higher nursing component rate of reimbursement is achieved
    by that facility.
        (B) For a facility that would receive a higher nursing
    component rate per patient day under the payment
    methodology in effect on July 1, 2003 than the facility
    received effective on the date immediately preceding the
    date that the Department implements the new payment
    methodology, the nursing component rate per patient day for
    the facility shall be adjusted.
        (C) Notwithstanding paragraphs (A) and (B), the
    nursing component rate per patient day for the facility
    shall be adjusted subject to appropriations provided by the
    General Assembly.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities or Long Term Care for Under
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on March 1, 2001
shall include a statewide increase of 7.85%, as defined by the
Department.
    Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or
intermediate care facilities, the numerator of the ratio used
by the Department of Healthcare and Family Services to compute
the rate payable under this Section using the Minimum Data Set
(MDS) methodology shall incorporate the following annual
amounts as the additional funds appropriated to the Department
specifically to pay for rates based on the MDS nursing
component methodology in excess of the funding in effect on
December 31, 2006:
        (i) For rates taking effect January 1, 2007,
    $60,000,000.
        (ii) For rates taking effect January 1, 2008,
    $110,000,000.
    Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or
intermediate care facilities, the support component of the
rates taking effect on January 1, 2008 shall be computed using
the most recent cost reports on file with the Department of
Healthcare and Family Services no later than April 1, 2005,
updated for inflation to January 1, 2006.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities or Long Term Care for Under
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on April 1, 2002
shall include a statewide increase of 2.0%, as defined by the
Department. This increase terminates on July 1, 2002; beginning
July 1, 2002 these rates are reduced to the level of the rates
in effect on March 31, 2002, as defined by the Department.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities
or intermediate care facilities, the rates taking effect on
July 1, 2001 shall be computed using the most recent cost
reports on file with the Department of Public Aid no later than
April 1, 2000, updated for inflation to January 1, 2001. For
rates effective July 1, 2001 only, rates shall be the greater
of the rate computed for July 1, 2001 or the rate effective on
June 30, 2001.
    Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or
intermediate care facilities, the Illinois Department shall
determine by rule the rates taking effect on July 1, 2002,
which shall be 5.9% less than the rates in effect on June 30,
2002.
    Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or
intermediate care facilities, if the payment methodologies
required under Section 5A-12 and the waiver granted under 42
CFR 433.68 are approved by the United States Centers for
Medicare and Medicaid Services, the rates taking effect on July
1, 2004 shall be 3.0% greater than the rates in effect on June
30, 2004. These rates shall take effect only upon approval and
implementation of the payment methodologies required under
Section 5A-12.
    Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section, for
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or
intermediate care facilities, the rates taking effect on
January 1, 2005 shall be 3% more than the rates in effect on
December 31, 2004.
    Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section, for
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under
the Nursing Home Care Act as intermediate care facilities that
are federally defined as Institutions for Mental Disease, a
socio-development component rate equal to 6.6% of the
facility's nursing component rate as of January 1, 2006 shall
be established and paid effective July 1, 2006. The
socio-development component of the rate shall be increased by a
factor of 2.53 on the first day of the month that begins at
least 45 days after the effective date of this amendatory Act
of the 95th General Assembly. The Illinois Department may by
rule adjust these socio-development component rates, but in no
case may such rates be diminished.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities or as long-term care
facilities for residents under 22 years of age, the rates
taking effect on July 1, 2003 shall include a statewide
increase of 4%, as defined by the Department.
    For facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health
under the Nursing Home Care Act as Intermediate Care for the
Developmentally Disabled facilities or Long Term Care for Under
Age 22 facilities, the rates taking effect on the first day of
the month that begins at least 45 days after the effective date
of this amendatory Act of the 95th General Assembly shall
include a statewide increase of 2.5%, as defined by the
Department.
    Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section, for
facilities licensed by the Department of Public Health under
the Nursing Home Care Act as skilled nursing facilities or
intermediate care facilities, effective January 1, 2005,
facility rates shall be increased by the difference between (i)
a facility's per diem property, liability, and malpractice
insurance costs as reported in the cost report filed with the
Department of Public Aid and used to establish rates effective
July 1, 2001 and (ii) those same costs as reported in the
facility's 2002 cost report. These costs shall be passed
through to the facility without caps or limitations, except for
adjustments required under normal auditing procedures.
    Rates established effective each July 1 shall govern
payment for services rendered throughout that fiscal year,
except that rates established on July 1, 1996 shall be
increased by 6.8% for services provided on or after January 1,
1997. Such rates will be based upon the rates calculated for
the year beginning July 1, 1990, and for subsequent years
thereafter until June 30, 2001 shall be based on the facility
cost reports for the facility fiscal year ending at any point
in time during the previous calendar year, updated to the
midpoint of the rate year. The cost report shall be on file
with the Department no later than April 1 of the current rate
year. Should the cost report not be on file by April 1, the
Department shall base the rate on the latest cost report filed
by each skilled care facility and intermediate care facility,
updated to the midpoint of the current rate year. In
determining rates for services rendered on and after July 1,
1985, fixed time shall not be computed at less than zero. The
Department shall not make any alterations of regulations which
would reduce any component of the Medicaid rate to a level
below what that component would have been utilizing in the rate
effective on July 1, 1984.
    (2) Shall take into account the actual costs incurred by
facilities in providing services for recipients of skilled
nursing and intermediate care services under the medical
assistance program.
    (3) Shall take into account the medical and psycho-social
characteristics and needs of the patients.
    (4) Shall take into account the actual costs incurred by
facilities in meeting licensing and certification standards
imposed and prescribed by the State of Illinois, any of its
political subdivisions or municipalities and by the U.S.
Department of Health and Human Services pursuant to Title XIX
of the Social Security Act.
    The Department of Healthcare and Family Services shall
develop precise standards for payments to reimburse nursing
facilities for any utilization of appropriate rehabilitative
personnel for the provision of rehabilitative services which is
authorized by federal regulations, including reimbursement for
services provided by qualified therapists or qualified
assistants, and which is in accordance with accepted
professional practices. Reimbursement also may be made for
utilization of other supportive personnel under appropriate
supervision.
(Source: P.A. 94-48, eff. 7-1-05; 94-85, eff. 6-28-05; 94-697,
eff. 11-21-05; 94-838, eff. 6-6-06; 94-964, eff. 6-28-06;
95-12, eff. 7-2-07.)
 
    (305 ILCS 5/5A-8)  (from Ch. 23, par. 5A-8)
    Sec. 5A-8. Hospital Provider Fund.
    (a) There is created in the State Treasury the Hospital
Provider Fund. Interest earned by the Fund shall be credited to
the Fund. The Fund shall not be used to replace any moneys
appropriated to the Medicaid program by the General Assembly.
    (b) The Fund is created for the purpose of receiving moneys
in accordance with Section 5A-6 and disbursing moneys only for
the following purposes, notwithstanding any other provision of
law:
        (1) For making payments to hospitals as required under
    Articles V, VI, and XIV of this Code and under the
    Children's Health Insurance Program Act.
        (2) For the reimbursement of moneys collected by the
    Illinois Department from hospitals or hospital providers
    through error or mistake in performing the activities
    authorized under this Article and Article V of this Code.
        (3) For payment of administrative expenses incurred by
    the Illinois Department or its agent in performing the
    activities authorized by this Article.
        (4) For payments of any amounts which are reimbursable
    to the federal government for payments from this Fund which
    are required to be paid by State warrant.
        (5) For making transfers, as those transfers are
    authorized in the proceedings authorizing debt under the
    Short Term Borrowing Act, but transfers made under this
    paragraph (5) shall not exceed the principal amount of debt
    issued in anticipation of the receipt by the State of
    moneys to be deposited into the Fund.
        (6) For making transfers to any other fund in the State
    treasury, but transfers made under this paragraph (6) shall
    not exceed the amount transferred previously from that
    other fund into the Hospital Provider Fund.
        (7) For State fiscal years 2004 and 2005 for making
    transfers to the Health and Human Services Medicaid Trust
    Fund, including 20% of the moneys received from hospital
    providers under Section 5A-4 and transferred into the
    Hospital Provider Fund under Section 5A-6. For State fiscal
    year 2006 for making transfers to the Health and Human
    Services Medicaid Trust Fund of up to $130,000,000 per year
    of the moneys received from hospital providers under
    Section 5A-4 and transferred into the Hospital Provider
    Fund under Section 5A-6. Transfers under this paragraph
    shall be made within 7 days after the payments have been
    received pursuant to the schedule of payments provided in
    subsection (a) of Section 5A-4.
        (7.5) For State fiscal year years 2007 and 2008 for
    making transfers of the moneys received from hospital
    providers under Section 5A-4 and transferred into the
    Hospital Provider Fund under Section 5A-6 to the designated
    funds not exceeding the following amounts in that any State
    fiscal year:
        Health and Human Services
            Medicaid Trust Fund................. $20,000,000
        Long-Term Care Provider Fund............ $30,000,000
        General Revenue Fund................... $80,000,000.
        Transfers under this paragraph shall be made within 7
    days after the payments have been received pursuant to the
    schedule of payments provided in subsection (a) of Section
    5A-4.
        (7.8) For State fiscal year 2008, for making transfers
    of the moneys received from hospital providers under
    Section 5A-4 and transferred into the Hospital Provider
    Fund under Section 5A-6 to the designated funds not
    exceeding the following amounts in that State fiscal year:
        Health and Human Services
            Medicaid Trust Fund..................$40,000,000
        Long-Term Care Provider Fund..............$60,000,000
        General Revenue Fund...................$160,000,000.
        Transfers under this paragraph shall be made within 7
    days after the payments have been received pursuant to the
    schedule of payments provided in subsection (a) of Section
    5A-4.
        (8) For making refunds to hospital providers pursuant
    to Section 5A-10.
    Disbursements from the Fund, other than transfers
authorized under paragraphs (5) and (6) of this subsection,
shall be by warrants drawn by the State Comptroller upon
receipt of vouchers duly executed and certified by the Illinois
Department.
    (c) The Fund shall consist of the following:
        (1) All moneys collected or received by the Illinois
    Department from the hospital provider assessment imposed
    by this Article.
        (2) All federal matching funds received by the Illinois
    Department as a result of expenditures made by the Illinois
    Department that are attributable to moneys deposited in the
    Fund.
        (3) Any interest or penalty levied in conjunction with
    the administration of this Article.
        (4) Moneys transferred from another fund in the State
    treasury.
        (5) All other moneys received for the Fund from any
    other source, including interest earned thereon.
    (d) (Blank).
(Source: P.A. 93-659, eff. 2-3-04; 94-242, eff. 7-18-05;
94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (305 ILCS 5/5B-8)  (from Ch. 23, par. 5B-8)
    Sec. 5B-8. Long-Term Care Provider Fund.
    (a) There is created in the State Treasury the Long-Term
Care Provider Fund. Interest earned by the Fund shall be
credited to the Fund. The Fund shall not be used to replace any
moneys appropriated to the Medicaid program by the General
Assembly.
    (b) The Fund is created for the purpose of receiving and
disbursing moneys in accordance with this Article.
Disbursements from the Fund shall be made only as follows:
        (1) For payments to skilled or intermediate nursing
    facilities, including county nursing facilities but
    excluding State-operated facilities, under Title XIX of
    the Social Security Act and Article V of this Code.
        (2) For the reimbursement of moneys collected by the
    Illinois Department through error or mistake, and for
    making required payments under Section 5-4.38(a)(1) if
    there are no moneys available for such payments in the
    Medicaid Long Term Care Provider Participation Fee Trust
    Fund.
        (3) For payment of administrative expenses incurred by
    the Illinois Department or its agent in performing the
    activities authorized by this Article.
        (3.5) For reimbursement of expenses incurred by
    long-term care facilities, and payment of administrative
    expenses incurred by the Department of Public Health, in
    relation to the conduct and analysis of background checks
    for identified offenders under the Nursing Home Care Act.
        (4) For payments of any amounts that are reimbursable
    to the federal government for payments from this Fund that
    are required to be paid by State warrant.
        (5) For making transfers to the General Obligation Bond
    Retirement and Interest Fund, as those transfers are
    authorized in the proceedings authorizing debt under the
    Short Term Borrowing Act, but transfers made under this
    paragraph (5) shall not exceed the principal amount of debt
    issued in anticipation of the receipt by the State of
    moneys to be deposited into the Fund.
    Disbursements from the Fund, other than transfers to the
General Obligation Bond Retirement and Interest Fund, shall be
by warrants drawn by the State Comptroller upon receipt of
vouchers duly executed and certified by the Illinois
Department.
    (c) The Fund shall consist of the following:
        (1) All moneys collected or received by the Illinois
    Department from the long-term care provider assessment
    imposed by this Article.
        (2) All federal matching funds received by the Illinois
    Department as a result of expenditures made by the Illinois
    Department that are attributable to moneys deposited in the
    Fund.
        (3) Any interest or penalty levied in conjunction with
    the administration of this Article.
        (4) Any balance in the Medicaid Long Term Care Provider
    Participation Fee Fund in the State Treasury. The balance
    shall be transferred to the Fund upon certification by the
    Illinois Department to the State Comptroller that all of
    the disbursements required by Section 5-4.31(b) of this
    Code have been made.
        (5) All other monies received for the Fund from any
    other source, including interest earned thereon.
(Source: P.A. 89-626, eff. 8-9-96.)
 
    (305 ILCS 5/5C-2)  (from Ch. 23, par. 5C-2)
    Sec. 5C-2. Assessment; no local authorization to tax.
    (a) For the privilege of engaging in the occupation of
developmentally disabled care provider, an assessment is
imposed upon each developmentally disabled care provider in an
amount equal to 6%, or the maximum allowed under federal
regulation, whichever is less, of its adjusted gross
developmentally disabled care revenue for the prior State
fiscal year. Notwithstanding any provision of any other Act to
the contrary, this assessment shall be construed as a tax, but
may not be added to the charges of an individual's nursing home
care that is paid for in whole, or in part, by a federal,
State, or combined federal-state medical care program, except
those individuals receiving Medicare Part B benefits solely.
    (b) Nothing in this amendatory Act of 1995 shall be
construed to authorize any home rule unit or other unit of
local government to license for revenue or impose a tax or
assessment upon a developmentally disabled care provider or the
occupation of developmentally disabled care provider, or a tax
or assessment measured by the income or earnings of a
developmentally disabled care provider.
(Source: P.A. 88-88; 89-21, eff. 7-1-95.)
 
    (305 ILCS 5/12-10.7)
    Sec. 12-10.7. The Health and Human Services Medicaid Trust
Fund.
    (a) The Health and Human Services Medicaid Trust Fund shall
consist of (i) moneys appropriated or transferred into the
Fund, pursuant to statute, (ii) federal financial
participation moneys received pursuant to expenditures from
the Fund, and (iii) the interest earned on moneys in the Fund.
    (b) Subject to appropriation, the moneys in the Fund shall
be used by a State agency for such purposes as that agency may,
by the appropriation language, be directed.
    (c) In addition to any other transfers that may be provided
for by law, on July 1, 2007, or as soon thereafter as
practical, the State Comptroller shall direct and the State
Treasurer shall transfer the sum of $3,500,000 from the Health
and Human Services Medicaid Trust Fund to the Human Services
Priority Capital Program Fund.
(Source: P.A. 93-841, eff. 7-30-04.)
 
    (305 ILCS 5/12-10.8 new)
    Sec. 12-10.8. Mental health contracts. Subject to
appropriations available for these purposes, including,
without limitation, the FY08 appropriations to the Department
for federally defined Institutions for Mental Disease, the
Department of Healthcare and Family Services shall enter into a
contract for $1,000,000 with the provider of community mental
health services that has more than 700 beds at over 30 service
locations in multiple counties for purposes of supporting the
implementation of time-limited resident review and rapid
reintegration targeted to residents of federally defined
Institutions for Mental Disease.
 
    Section 5-30. The Illinois Affordable Housing Act is
amended by changing Section 8 as follows:
 
    (310 ILCS 65/8)  (from Ch. 67 1/2, par. 1258)
    Sec. 8. Uses of Trust Fund.
    (a) Subject to annual appropriation to the Funding Agent
and subject to the prior dedication, allocation, transfer and
use of Trust Fund Moneys as provided in Sections 8(b), 8(c) and
9 of this Act, the Trust Fund may be used to make grants,
mortgages, or other loans to acquire, construct, rehabilitate,
develop, operate, insure, and retain affordable single-family
and multi-family housing in this State for low-income and very
low-income households. The majority of monies appropriated to
the Trust Fund in any given year are to be used for affordable
housing for very low-income households. For the fiscal years
2007 and 2008 year beginning July 1, 2006 only, the Department
of Human Services is authorized to receive appropriations and
spend moneys from the Illinois Affordable Housing Trust Fund
for the purpose of developing and coordinating public and
private resources targeted to meet the affordable housing needs
of low-income, very low-income, and special needs households in
the State of Illinois.
    (b) For each fiscal year commencing with fiscal year 1994,
the Program Administrator shall certify from time to time to
the Funding Agent, the Comptroller and the State Treasurer
amounts, up to an aggregate in any fiscal year of $10,000,000,
of Trust Fund Moneys expected to be used or pledged by the
Program Administrator during the fiscal year for the purposes
and uses specified in Sections 8(c) and 9 of this Act. Subject
to annual appropriation, upon receipt of such certification,
the Funding Agent and the Comptroller shall dedicate and the
State Treasurer shall transfer not less often than monthly to
the Program Administrator or its designated payee, without
requisition or further request therefor, all amounts
accumulated in the Trust Fund within the State Treasury and not
already transferred to the Loan Commitment Account prior to the
Funding Agent's receipt of such certification, until the
Program Administrator has received the aggregate amount
certified by the Program Administrator, to be used solely for
the purposes and uses authorized and provided in Sections 8(c)
and 9 of this Act. Neither the Comptroller nor the Treasurer
shall transfer, dedicate or allocate any of the Trust Fund
Moneys transferred or certified for transfer by the Program
Administrator as provided above to any other fund, nor shall
the Governor authorize any such transfer, dedication or
allocation, nor shall any of the Trust Fund Moneys so
dedicated, allocated or transferred be used, temporarily or
otherwise, for interfund borrowing, or be otherwise used or
appropriated, except as expressly authorized and provided in
Sections 8(c) and 9 of this Act for the purposes and subject to
the priorities, limitations and conditions provided for
therein until such obligations, uses and dedications as therein
provided, have been satisfied.
    (c) Notwithstanding Section 5(b) of this Act, any Trust
Fund Moneys transferred to the Program Administrator pursuant
to Section 8(b) of this Act, or otherwise obtained, paid to or
held by or for the Program Administrator, or pledged pursuant
to resolution of the Program Administrator, for Affordable
Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes under the Illinois
Housing Development Act, and all proceeds, payments and
receipts from investments or use of such moneys, including any
residual or additional funds or moneys generated or obtained in
connection with any of the foregoing, may be held, pledged,
applied or dedicated by the Program Administrator as follows:
        (1) as required by the terms of any pledge of or
    resolution of the Program Administrator authorized under
    Section 9 of this Act in connection with Affordable Housing
    Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes issued pursuant to the
    Illinois Housing Development Act;
        (2) to or for costs of issuance and administration and
    the payments of any principal, interest, premium or other
    amounts or expenses incurred or accrued in connection with
    Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes,
    including rate protection contracts and credit support
    arrangements pertaining thereto, and, provided such
    expenses, fees and charges are obligations, whether
    recourse or nonrecourse, and whether financed with or paid
    from the proceeds of Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund
    Bonds or Notes, of the developers, mortgagors or other
    users, the Program Administrator's expenses and servicing,
    administration and origination fees and charges in
    connection with any loans, mortgages, or developments
    funded or financed or expected to be funded or financed, in
    whole or in part, from the issuance of Affordable Housing
    Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes;
        (3) to or for costs of issuance and administration and
    the payments of principal, interest, premium, loan fees,
    and other amounts or other obligations of the Program
    Administrator, including rate protection contracts and
    credit support arrangements pertaining thereto, for loans,
    commercial paper or other notes or bonds issued by the
    Program Administrator pursuant to the Illinois Housing
    Development Act, provided that the proceeds of such loans,
    commercial paper or other notes or bonds are paid or
    expended in connection with, or refund or repay, loans,
    commercial paper or other notes or bonds issued or made in
    connection with bridge loans or loans for the construction,
    renovation, redevelopment, restructuring, reorganization
    of Affordable Housing and related expenses, including
    development costs, technical assistance, or other amounts
    to construct, preserve, improve, renovate, rehabilitate,
    refinance, or assist Affordable Housing, including
    financially troubled Affordable Housing, permanent or
    other financing for which has been funded or financed or is
    expected to be funded or financed in whole or in part by
    the Program Administrator through the issuance of or use of
    proceeds from Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds
    or Notes;
        (4) to or for direct expenditures or reimbursement for
    development costs, technical assistance, or other amounts
    to construct, preserve, improve, renovate, rehabilitate,
    refinance, or assist Affordable Housing, including
    financially troubled Affordable Housing, permanent or
    other financing for which has been funded or financed or is
    expected to be funded or financed in whole or in part by
    the Program Administrator through the issuance of or use of
    proceeds from Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds
    or Notes; and
        (5) for deposit into any residual, sinking, reserve or
    revolving fund or pool established by the Program
    Administrator, whether or not pledged to secure Affordable
    Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes, to support or be
    utilized for the issuance, redemption, or payment of the
    principal, interest, premium or other amounts payable on or
    with respect to any existing, additional or future
    Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes, or to
    or for any other expenditure authorized by this Section
    8(c).
    (d) All or a portion of the Trust Fund Moneys on deposit or
to be deposited in the Trust Fund not already certified for
transfer or transferred to the Program Administrator pursuant
to Section 8(b) of this Act may be used to secure the repayment
of Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes, or
otherwise to supplement or support Affordable Housing funded or
financed or intended to be funded or financed, in whole or in
part, by Affordable Housing Program Trust Fund Bonds or Notes.
    (e) Assisted housing may include housing for special needs
populations such as the homeless, single-parent families, the
elderly, or the physically and mentally disabled. The Trust
Fund shall be used to implement a demonstration congregate
housing project for any such special needs population.
    (f) Grants from the Trust Fund may include, but are not
limited to, rental assistance and security deposit subsidies
for low and very low-income households.
    (g) The Trust Fund may be used to pay actual and reasonable
costs for Commission members to attend Commission meetings, and
any litigation costs and expenses, including legal fees,
incurred by the Program Administrator in any litigation related
to this Act or its action as Program Administrator.
    (h) The Trust Fund may be used to make grants for (1) the
provision of technical assistance, (2) outreach, and (3)
building an organization's capacity to develop affordable
housing projects.
    (i) Amounts on deposit in the Trust Fund may be used to
reimburse the Program Administrator and the Funding Agent for
costs incurred in the performance of their duties under this
Act, excluding costs and fees of the Program Administrator
associated with the Program Escrow to the extent withheld
pursuant to paragraph (8) of subsection (b) of Section 5.
(Source: P.A. 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    Section 5-40. The Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute
Resolution Act is amended by changing Section 10 as follows:
 
    (710 ILCS 40/10)
    Sec. 10. Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute Resolution
Fund. The Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute Resolution Fund
is created as a special fund in the State Treasury. The Supreme
Court may designate an amount to be included in the filing fees
collected by the clerks of the Appellate Court for the funding
of alternative dispute resolution programs in the reviewing
courts. The portion of the filing fees designated for
alternative dispute resolution programs in the reviewing
courts shall be remitted within one month after receipt to the
State Treasurer for deposit in the Reviewing Court Alternative
Dispute Resolution Fund. All money in the Reviewing Court
Alternative Dispute Resolution Fund shall be maintained in
separate accounts for each Appellate Court district that has
established approved alternative dispute resolution programs
pursuant to Supreme Court rule and used, subject to
appropriation, by the Supreme Court solely for the purpose of
funding alternative dispute resolution programs in the
reviewing courts. Notwithstanding any other provision of this
Section, the Reviewing Court Alternative Dispute Resolution
Fund may be used for any other purpose authorized by the
Supreme Court.
(Source: P.A. 93-801, eff. 7-22-04.)
 
    Section 5-45. The Pretrial Services Act is amended by
changing Section 33 as follows:
 
    (725 ILCS 185/33)  (from Ch. 38, par. 333)
    Sec. 33. The Supreme Court shall pay from funds
appropriated to it for this purpose 100% of all approved costs
for pretrial services, including pretrial services officers,
necessary support personnel, travel costs reasonably related
to the delivery of pretrial services, space costs, equipment,
telecommunications, postage, commodities, printing and
contractual services. Costs shall be reimbursed monthly, based
on a plan and budget approved by the Supreme Court. No
department may be reimbursed for costs which exceed or are not
provided for in the approved plan and budget. The For State
fiscal years 2004, 2005, and 2006, and 2007 only, the Mandatory
Arbitration Fund may be used to reimburse approved costs for
pretrial services.
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91,
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06; revised 8-3-06.)
 
    Section 5-50. The Probation and Probation Officers Act is
amended by changing Sections 15 and 15.1 as follows:
 
    (730 ILCS 110/15)  (from Ch. 38, par. 204-7)
    Sec. 15. (1) The Supreme Court of Illinois may establish a
Division of Probation Services whose purpose shall be the
development, establishment, promulgation, and enforcement of
uniform standards for probation services in this State, and to
otherwise carry out the intent of this Act. The Division may:
        (a) establish qualifications for chief probation
    officers and other probation and court services personnel
    as to hiring, promotion, and training.
        (b) make available, on a timely basis, lists of those
    applicants whose qualifications meet the regulations
    referred to herein, including on said lists all candidates
    found qualified.
        (c) establish a means of verifying the conditions for
    reimbursement under this Act and develop criteria for
    approved costs for reimbursement.
        (d) develop standards and approve employee
    compensation schedules for probation and court services
    departments.
        (e) employ sufficient personnel in the Division to
    carry out the functions of the Division.
        (f) establish a system of training and establish
    standards for personnel orientation and training.
        (g) develop standards for a system of record keeping
    for cases and programs, gather statistics, establish a
    system of uniform forms, and develop research for planning
    of Probation Services.
        (h) develop standards to assure adequate support
    personnel, office space, equipment and supplies, travel
    expenses, and other essential items necessary for
    Probation and Court Services Departments to carry out their
    duties.
        (i) review and approve annual plans submitted by
    Probation and Court Services Departments.
        (j) monitor and evaluate all programs operated by
    Probation and Court Services Departments, and may include
    in the program evaluation criteria such factors as the
    percentage of Probation sentences for felons convicted of
    Probationable offenses.
        (k) seek the cooperation of local and State government
    and private agencies to improve the quality of probation
    and court services.
        (l) where appropriate, establish programs and
    corresponding standards designed to generally improve the
    quality of probation and court services and reduce the rate
    of adult or juvenile offenders committed to the Department
    of Corrections.
        (m) establish such other standards and regulations and
    do all acts necessary to carry out the intent and purposes
    of this Act.
    The Division shall establish a model list of structured
intermediate sanctions that may be imposed by a probation
agency for violations of terms and conditions of a sentence of
probation, conditional discharge, or supervision.
    The State of Illinois shall provide for the costs of
personnel, travel, equipment, telecommunications, postage,
commodities, printing, space, contractual services and other
related costs necessary to carry out the intent of this Act.
    (2) (a) The chief judge of each circuit shall provide
full-time probation services for all counties within the
circuit, in a manner consistent with the annual probation plan,
the standards, policies, and regulations established by the
Supreme Court. A probation district of two or more counties
within a circuit may be created for the purposes of providing
full-time probation services. Every county or group of counties
within a circuit shall maintain a probation department which
shall be under the authority of the Chief Judge of the circuit
or some other judge designated by the Chief Judge. The Chief
Judge, through the Probation and Court Services Department
shall submit annual plans to the Division for probation and
related services.
    (b) The Chief Judge of each circuit shall appoint the Chief
Probation Officer and all other probation officers for his or
her circuit from lists of qualified applicants supplied by the
Supreme Court. Candidates for chief managing officer and other
probation officer positions must apply with both the Chief
Judge of the circuit and the Supreme Court.
    (3) A Probation and Court Service Department shall apply to
the Supreme Court for funds for basic services, and may apply
for funds for new and expanded programs or Individualized
Services and Programs. Costs shall be reimbursed monthly based
on a plan and budget approved by the Supreme Court. No
Department may be reimbursed for costs which exceed or are not
provided for in the approved annual plan and budget. After the
effective date of this amendatory Act of 1985, each county must
provide basic services in accordance with the annual plan and
standards created by the division. No department may receive
funds for new or expanded programs or individualized services
and programs unless they are in compliance with standards as
enumerated in paragraph (h) of subsection (1) of this Section,
the annual plan, and standards for basic services.
    (4) The Division shall reimburse the county or counties for
probation services as follows:
        (a) 100% of the salary of all chief managing officers
    designated as such by the Chief Judge and the division.
        (b) 100% of the salary for all probation officer and
    supervisor positions approved for reimbursement by the
    division after April 1, 1984, to meet workload standards
    and to implement intensive sanction and probation
    supervision programs and other basic services as defined in
    this Act.
        (c) 100% of the salary for all secure detention
    personnel and non-secure group home personnel approved for
    reimbursement after December 1, 1990. For all such
    positions approved for reimbursement before December 1,
    1990, the counties shall be reimbursed $1,250 per month
    beginning July 1, 1995, and an additional $250 per month
    beginning each July 1st thereafter until the positions
    receive 100% salary reimbursement. Allocation of such
    positions will be based on comparative need considering
    capacity, staff/resident ratio, physical plant and
    program.
        (d) $1,000 per month for salaries for the remaining
    probation officer positions engaged in basic services and
    new or expanded services. All such positions shall be
    approved by the division in accordance with this Act and
    division standards.
        (e) 100% of the travel expenses in accordance with
    Division standards for all Probation positions approved
    under paragraph (b) of subsection 4 of this Section.
        (f) If the amount of funds reimbursed to the county
    under paragraphs (a) through (e) of subsection 4 of this
    Section on an annual basis is less than the amount the
    county had received during the 12 month period immediately
    prior to the effective date of this amendatory Act of 1985,
    then the Division shall reimburse the amount of the
    difference to the county. The effect of paragraph (b) of
    subsection 7 of this Section shall be considered in
    implementing this supplemental reimbursement provision.
    (5) The Division shall provide funds beginning on April 1,
1987 for the counties to provide Individualized Services and
Programs as provided in Section 16 of this Act.
    (6) A Probation and Court Services Department in order to
be eligible for the reimbursement must submit to the Supreme
Court an application containing such information and in such a
form and by such dates as the Supreme Court may require.
Departments to be eligible for funding must satisfy the
following conditions:
        (a) The Department shall have on file with the Supreme
    Court an annual Probation plan for continuing, improved,
    and new Probation and Court Services Programs approved by
    the Supreme Court or its designee. This plan shall indicate
    the manner in which Probation and Court Services will be
    delivered and improved, consistent with the minimum
    standards and regulations for Probation and Court
    Services, as established by the Supreme Court. In counties
    with more than one Probation and Court Services Department
    eligible to receive funds, all Departments within that
    county must submit plans which are approved by the Supreme
    Court.
        (b) The annual probation plan shall seek to generally
    improve the quality of probation services and to reduce the
    commitment of adult offenders to the Department of
    Corrections and to reduce the commitment of juvenile
    offenders to the Department of Juvenile Justice and shall
    require, when appropriate, coordination with the
    Department of Corrections, the Department of Juvenile
    Justice, and the Department of Children and Family Services
    in the development and use of community resources,
    information systems, case review and permanency planning
    systems to avoid the duplication of services.
        (c) The Department shall be in compliance with
    standards developed by the Supreme Court for basic, new and
    expanded services, training, personnel hiring and
    promotion.
        (d) The Department shall in its annual plan indicate
    the manner in which it will support the rights of crime
    victims and in which manner it will implement Article I,
    Section 8.1 of the Illinois Constitution and in what manner
    it will coordinate crime victims' support services with
    other criminal justice agencies within its jurisdiction,
    including but not limited to, the State's Attorney, the
    Sheriff and any municipal police department.
    (7) No statement shall be verified by the Supreme Court or
its designee or vouchered by the Comptroller unless each of the
following conditions have been met:
        (a) The probation officer is a full-time employee
    appointed by the Chief Judge to provide probation services.
        (b) The probation officer, in order to be eligible for
    State reimbursement, is receiving a salary of at least
    $17,000 per year.
        (c) The probation officer is appointed or was
    reappointed in accordance with minimum qualifications or
    criteria established by the Supreme Court; however, all
    probation officers appointed prior to January 1, 1978,
    shall be exempted from the minimum requirements
    established by the Supreme Court. Payments shall be made to
    counties employing these exempted probation officers as
    long as they are employed in the position held on the
    effective date of this amendatory Act of 1985. Promotions
    shall be governed by minimum qualifications established by
    the Supreme Court.
        (d) The Department has an established compensation
    schedule approved by the Supreme Court. The compensation
    schedule shall include salary ranges with necessary
    increments to compensate each employee. The increments
    shall, within the salary ranges, be based on such factors
    as bona fide occupational qualifications, performance, and
    length of service. Each position in the Department shall be
    placed on the compensation schedule according to job duties
    and responsibilities of such position. The policy and
    procedures of the compensation schedule shall be made
    available to each employee.
    (8) In order to obtain full reimbursement of all approved
costs, each Department must continue to employ at least the
same number of probation officers and probation managers as
were authorized for employment for the fiscal year which
includes January 1, 1985. This number shall be designated as
the base amount of the Department. No positions approved by the
Division under paragraph (b) of subsection 4 will be included
in the base amount. In the event that the Department employs
fewer Probation officers and Probation managers than the base
amount for a period of 90 days, funding received by the
Department under subsection 4 of this Section may be reduced on
a monthly basis by the amount of the current salaries of any
positions below the base amount.
    (9) Before the 15th day of each month, the treasurer of any
county which has a Probation and Court Services Department, or
the treasurer of the most populous county, in the case of a
Probation or Court Services Department funded by more than one
county, shall submit an itemized statement of all approved
costs incurred in the delivery of Basic Probation and Court
Services under this Act to the Supreme Court. The treasurer may
also submit an itemized statement of all approved costs
incurred in the delivery of new and expanded Probation and
Court Services as well as Individualized Services and Programs.
The Supreme Court or its designee shall verify compliance with
this Section and shall examine and audit the monthly statement
and, upon finding them to be correct, shall forward them to the
Comptroller for payment to the county treasurer. In the case of
payment to a treasurer of a county which is the most populous
of counties sharing the salary and expenses of a Probation and
Court Services Department, the treasurer shall divide the money
between the counties in a manner that reflects each county's
share of the cost incurred by the Department.
    (10) The county treasurer must certify that funds received
under this Section shall be used solely to maintain and improve
Probation and Court Services. The county or circuit shall
remain in compliance with all standards, policies and
regulations established by the Supreme Court. If at any time
the Supreme Court determines that a county or circuit is not in
compliance, the Supreme Court shall immediately notify the
Chief Judge, county board chairman and the Director of Court
Services Chief Probation Officer. If after 90 days of written
notice the noncompliance still exists, the Supreme Court shall
be required to reduce the amount of monthly reimbursement by
10%. An additional 10% reduction of monthly reimbursement shall
occur for each consecutive month of noncompliance. Except as
provided in subsection 5 of Section 15, funding to counties
shall commence on April 1, 1986. Funds received under this Act
shall be used to provide for Probation Department expenses
including those required under Section 13 of this Act. The For
State fiscal years 2004, 2005, 2006, and 2007 only, the
Mandatory Arbitration Fund may be used to provide for Probation
Department expenses, including those required under Section 13
of this Act.
    (11) The respective counties shall be responsible for
capital and space costs, fringe benefits, clerical costs,
equipment, telecommunications, postage, commodities and
printing.
    (12) For purposes of this Act only, probation officers
shall be considered peace officers. In the exercise of their
official duties, probation officers, sheriffs, and police
officers may, anywhere within the State, arrest any probationer
who is in violation of any of the conditions of his or her
probation, conditional discharge, or supervision, and it shall
be the duty of the officer making the arrest to take the
probationer before the Court having jurisdiction over the
probationer for further order.
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-576, eff. 1-1-04; 93-839,
eff. 7-30-04; 94-91, eff. 7-1-05; 94-696, eff. 6-1-06; 94-839,
eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    (730 ILCS 110/15.1)  (from Ch. 38, par. 204-7.1)
    Sec. 15.1. Probation and Court Services Fund.
    (a) The county treasurer in each county shall establish a
probation and court services fund consisting of fees collected
pursuant to subsection (i) of Section 5-6-3 and subsection (i)
of Section 5-6-3.1 of the Unified Code of Corrections,
subsection (10) of Section 5-615 and subsection (5) of Section
5-715 of the Juvenile Court Act of 1987, and paragraph 14.3 of
subsection (b) of Section 110-10 of the Code of Criminal
Procedure of 1963. The county treasurer shall disburse monies
from the fund only at the direction of the chief judge of the
circuit court in such circuit where the county is located. The
county treasurer of each county shall, on or before January 10
of each year, submit an annual report to the Supreme Court.
    (b) Monies in the probation and court services fund shall
be appropriated by the county board to be used within the
county or jurisdiction where collected in accordance with
policies and guidelines approved by the Supreme Court for the
costs of operating the probation and court services department
or departments; however, except as provided in subparagraph
(g), monies in the probation and court services fund shall not
be used for the payment of salaries of probation and court
services personnel.
    (c) Monies expended from the probation and court services
fund shall be used to supplement, not supplant, county
appropriations for probation and court services.
    (d) Interest earned on monies deposited in a probation and
court services fund may be used by the county for its ordinary
and contingent expenditures.
    (e) The county board may appropriate moneys from the
probation and court services fund, upon the direction of the
chief judge, to support programs that are part of the continuum
of juvenile delinquency intervention programs which are or may
be developed within the county. The grants from the probation
and court services fund shall be for no more than one year and
may be used for any expenses attributable to the program
including administration and oversight of the program by the
probation department.
    (f) The county board may appropriate moneys from the
probation and court services fund, upon the direction of the
chief judge, to support practices endorsed or required under
the Sex Offender Management Board Act, including but not
limited to sex offender evaluation, treatment, and monitoring
programs that are or may be developed within the county.
    (g) For the State Fiscal Years 2005, 2006, and 2007 only,
the Administrative Office of the Illinois Courts may permit a
county or circuit to use its probation and court services fund
for the payment of salaries of probation officers and other
court services personnel whose salaries are reimbursed under
this Act if the State's FY2005, FY2006, or FY2007 appropriation
to the Supreme Court for reimbursement to counties for
probation salaries and services is less than the amount
appropriated to the Supreme Court for these purposes for State
Fiscal Year 2004. The Administrative Office of the Illinois
Courts shall take into account each county's or circuit's
probation fee collections and expenditures when apportioning
the total reimbursement for each county or circuit.
    (h) The Administrative Office of the Illinois Courts may
permit a county or circuit to use its probation and court
services fund for the payment of salaries of probation officers
and other court services personnel whose salaries are
reimbursed under this Act in any State fiscal year that the
appropriation for reimbursement to counties for probation
salaries and services is less than the amount appropriated to
the Supreme Court for these purposes for State Fiscal Year
2002. The Administrative Office of the Illinois Courts shall
take into account each county's or circuit's probation fee
collections and expenditures when appropriating the total
reimbursement for each county or circuit. Any amount
appropriated to the Supreme Court in any State fiscal year for
the purpose of reimbursing Cook County for the salaries and
operations of the Cook County Juvenile Temporary Detention
Center shall not be counted in the total appropriation to the
Supreme Court in that State fiscal year for reimbursement to
counties for probation salaries and services, for the purposes
of this paragraph (h).
(Source: P.A. 93-616, eff. 1-1-04; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91,
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    Section 5-55. The Code of Civil Procedure is amended by
changing Section 2-1009A as follows:
 
    (735 ILCS 5/2-1009A)  (from Ch. 110, par. 2-1009A)
    Sec. 2-1009A. Filing Fees. In each county authorized by the
Supreme Court to utilize mandatory arbitration, the clerk of
the circuit court shall charge and collect, in addition to any
other fees, an arbitration fee of $8, except in counties with
3,000,000 or more inhabitants the fee shall be $10, at the time
of filing the first pleading, paper or other appearance filed
by each party in all civil cases, but no additional fee shall
be required if more than one party is represented in a single
pleading, paper or other appearance. Arbitration fees received
by the clerk of the circuit court pursuant to this Section
shall be remitted within one month after receipt to the State
Treasurer for deposit into the Mandatory Arbitration Fund, a
special fund in the State treasury for the purpose of funding
mandatory arbitration programs and such other alternative
dispute resolution programs as may be authorized by circuit
court rule for operation in counties that have implemented
mandatory arbitration, with a separate account being
maintained for each county. Notwithstanding any other
provision of this Section to the contrary, and for State fiscal
years 2004, 2005, 2006, and 2007 only, the Mandatory
Arbitration Fund may be used for any other purpose authorized
by the Supreme Court.
(Source: P.A. 93-25, eff. 6-20-03; 93-839, eff. 7-30-04; 94-91,
eff. 7-1-05; 94-839, eff. 6-6-06.)
 
    Section 5-60. The Residential Real Property Disclosure Act
is amended by adding Section 80 as follows:
 
    (765 ILCS 77/80 new)
    Sec. 80. Predatory Lending Database Program Fund. The
Predatory Lending Database Program Fund is created as a special
fund in the State treasury. Subject to appropriation, moneys in
the Fund shall be appropriated to the Illinois Housing
Development Authority for the purpose of making grants for
HUD-certified counseling agencies participating in the
Predatory Lending Database Program to assist with
implementation and development of the Predatory Lending
Database Program.
 
    Section 5-65. The Business Corporation Act of 1983 is
amended by changing Sections 15.90 and 16.05 as follows:
 
    (805 ILCS 5/15.90)  (from Ch. 32, par. 15.90)
    Sec. 15.90. Statute of limitations.
    (a) Except as otherwise provided in this Section and
notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in any other
Section of this Act, no domestic corporation or foreign
corporation shall be obligated to pay any annual franchise tax,
fee, or penalty or interest thereon imposed under this Act, nor
shall any administrative or judicial sanction (including
dissolution) be imposed or enforced nor access to the courts of
this State be denied based upon nonpayment thereof more than 7
years after the date of filing the annual report with respect
to the period during which the obligation for the tax, fee,
penalty or interest arose, unless (1) within that 7 year period
the Secretary of State sends a written notice to the
corporation to the effect that (A) administrative or judicial
action to dissolve the corporation or revoke its certificate of
authority for nonpayment of a tax, fee, penalty or interest has
been commenced; or (B) the corporation has submitted a report
but has failed to pay a tax, fee, penalty or interest required
to be paid therewith; or (C) a report with respect to an event
or action giving rise to an obligation to pay a tax, fee,
penalty or interest is required but has not been filed, or has
been filed and is in error or incomplete; or (2) the annual
report by the corporation was filed with fraudulent intent to
evade taxes payable under this Act. A corporation nonetheless
shall be required to pay all taxes that would have been payable
during the most recent 7 year period due to a previously
unreported increase in paid-in capital that occurred prior to
that 7 year period and interest and penalties thereon for that
period, except that, from February 1, 2008 through March 15,
2008, with respect to any corporation that participates in the
Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007, the
corporation shall be only required to pay all taxes that would
have been payable during the most recent 4 year period due to a
previously unreported increase in paid-in capital that
occurred prior to that 7 year period.
    (b) If within 2 years following a change in control of a
corporation the corporation voluntarily pays in good faith all
known obligations of the corporation imposed by this Article 15
with respect to reports that were required to have been filed
since the beginning of the 7 year period ending on the
effective date of the change in control, no action shall be
taken to enforce or collect obligations of that corporation
imposed by this Article 15 with respect to reports that were
required to have been filed prior to that 7 year period
regardless of whether the limitation period set forth in
subsection (a) is otherwise applicable. For purposes of this
subsection (b), a change in control means a transaction, or a
series of transactions consummated within a period of 180
consecutive days, as a result of which a person which owned
less than 10% of the shares having the power to elect directors
of the corporation acquires shares such that the person becomes
the holder of 80% or more of the shares having such power. For
purposes of this subsection (b) a person means any natural
person, corporation, partnership, trust or other entity
together with all other persons controlled by, controlling or
under common control with such person.
    (c) Except as otherwise provided in this Section and
notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in any other
Section of this Act, no foreign corporation that has not
previously obtained a certificate of authority under this Act
shall, upon voluntary application for a certificate of
authority filed with the Secretary of State prior to January 1,
2001, be obligated to pay any tax, fee, penalty, or interest
imposed under this Act, nor shall any administrative or
judicial sanction be imposed or enforced based upon nonpayment
thereof with respect to a period during which the obligation
arose that is prior to January 1, 1993 unless (1) prior to
receipt of the application for a certificate of authority the
Secretary of State had sent written notice to the corporation
regarding its failure to obtain a certificate of authority, (2)
the corporation had submitted an application for a certificate
of authority previously but had failed to pay any tax, fee,
penalty or interest to be paid therewith, or (3) the
application for a certificate of authority was submitted by the
corporation with fraudulent intent to evade taxes payable under
this Act. A corporation nonetheless shall be required to pay
all taxes and fees due under this Act that would have been
payable since January 1, 1993 as a result of commencing the
transaction of its business in this State and interest thereon
for that period.
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
 
    (805 ILCS 5/16.05)  (from Ch. 32, par. 16.05)
    Sec. 16.05. Penalties and interest imposed upon
corporations.
    (a) Each corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or
refuses to file any annual report or report of cumulative
changes in paid-in capital and pay any franchise tax due
pursuant to the report prior to the first day of its
anniversary month or, in the case of a corporation which has
established an extended filing month, the extended filing month
of the corporation shall pay a penalty of 10% of the amount of
any delinquent franchise tax due for the report. From February
1, 2008 through March 15, 2008, no No penalty shall be imposed
with respect to any amount of delinquent franchise tax paid
pursuant to the Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of
2007.
    (b) Each corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or
refuses to file a report of issuance of shares or increase in
paid-in capital within the time prescribed by this Act is
subject to a penalty on any obligation occurring prior to
January 1, 1991, and interest on those obligations on or after
January 1, 1991, for each calendar month or part of month that
it is delinquent in the amount of 2% 1% of the amount of
license fees and franchise taxes provided by this Act to be
paid on account of the issuance of shares or increase in
paid-in capital. From February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008,
no No penalty shall be imposed, or interest charged, with
respect to any amount of delinquent license fees and franchise
taxes paid pursuant to the Franchise Tax and License Fee
Amnesty Act of 2007.
    (c) Each corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or
refuses to file a report of cumulative changes in paid-in
capital or report following merger within the time prescribed
by this Act is subject to interest on or after January 1, 1992,
for each calendar month or part of month that it is delinquent,
in the amount of 2% 1% of the amount of franchise taxes
provided by this Act to be paid on account of the issuance of
shares or increase in paid-in capital disclosed on the report
of cumulative changes in paid-in capital or report following
merger, or $1, whichever is greater. From February 1, 2008
through March 15, 2008, no No interest shall be charged with
respect to any amount of delinquent franchise tax paid pursuant
to the Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
    (d) If the annual franchise tax, or the supplemental annual
franchise tax for any 12-month period commencing July 1, 1968,
or July 1 of any subsequent year through June 30, 1983,
assessed in accordance with this Act, is not paid by July 31,
it is delinquent, and there is added a penalty prior to January
1, 1991, and interest on and after January 1, 1991, of 2% 1%
for each month or part of month that it is delinquent
commencing with the month of August, or $1, whichever is
greater. From February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008, no No
penalty shall be imposed, or interest charged, with respect to
any amount of delinquent franchise taxes paid pursuant to the
Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
    (e) If the supplemental annual franchise tax assessed in
accordance with the provisions of this Act for the 12-month
period commencing July 1, 1967, is not paid by September 30,
1967, it is delinquent, and there is added a penalty prior to
January 1, 1991, and interest on and after January 1, 1991, of
2% 1% for each month or part of month that it is delinquent
commencing with the month of October, 1967. From February 1,
2008 through March 15, 2008, no No penalty shall be imposed, or
interest charged, with respect to any amount of delinquent
franchise taxes paid pursuant to the Franchise Tax and License
Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
    (f) If any annual franchise tax for any period beginning on
or after July 1, 1983, is not paid by the time period herein
prescribed, it is delinquent and there is added a penalty prior
to January 1, 1991, and interest on and after January 1, 1991,
of 2% 1% for each month or part of a month that it is delinquent
commencing with the anniversary month or in the case of a
corporation that has established an extended filing month, the
extended filing month, or $1, whichever is greater. From
February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008, no No penalty shall be
imposed, or interest charged, with respect to any amount of
delinquent franchise taxes paid pursuant to the Franchise Tax
and License Fee Amnesty Act of 2007.
    (g) Any corporation, domestic or foreign, failing to pay
the prescribed fee for assumed corporate name renewal when due
and payable shall be given notice of nonpayment by the
Secretary of State by regular mail; and if the fee together
with a penalty fee of $5 is not paid within 90 days after the
notice is mailed, the right to use the assumed name shall
cease.
    (h) Any corporation which (i) puts forth any sign or
advertisement, assuming any name other than that by which it is
incorporated or otherwise authorized by law to act or (ii)
violates Section 3.25, shall be guilty of a Class C misdemeanor
and shall be deemed guilty of an additional offense for each
day it shall continue to so offend.
    (i) Each corporation, domestic or foreign, that fails or
refuses (1) to file in the office of the recorder within the
time prescribed by this Act any document required by this Act
to be so filed, or (2) to answer truthfully and fully within
the time prescribed by this Act interrogatories propounded by
the Secretary of State in accordance with this Act, or (3) to
perform any other act required by this Act to be performed by
the corporation, is guilty of a Class C misdemeanor.
    (j) Each corporation that fails or refuses to file articles
of revocation of dissolution within the time prescribed by this
Act is subject to a penalty for each calendar month or part of
the month that it is delinquent in the amount of $50.
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
 
    Section 5-70. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Act
of 2007 is amended by changing Section 5-10 and by adding
Section 5-6 as follows:
 
    (805 ILCS 8/5-6 new)
    Sec. 5-6. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty
Administration Fund. The Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty
Administration Fund is created as a special fund in the State
treasury. The Fund shall consist of any fund transfers, fees,
or moneys from other sources received for the purpose of
funding the administration of this Act. All moneys in the
Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty Administration Fund shall
be used, subject to appropriation, by the Secretary for any
costs associated with the administration of this Act.
 
    (805 ILCS 8/5-10)
    Sec. 5-10. Amnesty program. The Secretary shall establish
an amnesty program for all taxpayers owing any franchise tax or
license fee imposed by Article XV of the Business Corporation
Act of 1983. The amnesty program shall be for a period from
February 1, 2008 through March 15, 2008. The amnesty program
shall provide that, upon payment by a taxpayer of all franchise
taxes and license fees due from that taxpayer to the State of
Illinois for any taxable period, the Secretary shall abate and
not seek to collect any interest or penalties that may be
applicable, and the Secretary shall not seek civil or criminal
prosecution for any taxpayer for the period of time for which
amnesty has been granted to the taxpayer. Failure to pay all
taxes due to the State for a taxable period shall not
invalidate any amnesty granted under this Act with respect to
the taxes paid pursuant to the amnesty program. Amnesty shall
be granted only if all amnesty conditions are satisfied by the
taxpayer. Amnesty shall not be granted to taxpayers who are a
party to any criminal investigation or to any civil or criminal
litigation that is pending in any circuit court or appellate
court or the Supreme Court of this State for nonpayment,
delinquency, or fraud in relation to any franchise tax or
license fee imposed by Article XV of the Business Corporation
Act of 1983. Voluntary payments made under this Act shall be
made by cash, check, guaranteed remittance, or ACH debit. The
Secretary shall adopt rules as necessary to implement the
provisions of this Act. Except as otherwise provided in this
Section, all money collected under this Act that would
otherwise be deposited into the General Revenue Fund shall be
deposited into the General Revenue Fund. Two percent of all
money collected under this Act shall be deposited by the State
Treasurer into the Franchise Tax and License Fee Amnesty
Administration Department of Business Services Special
Operations Fund and, subject to appropriation, shall be used by
the Secretary to cover costs associated with the administration
of this Act.
(Source: P.A. 95-233, eff. 8-16-07.)
 
ARTICLE 99. EFFECTIVE DATE.

 
    Section 99-99. Effective date. This Act takes effect upon
becoming law.